ee3193beff7e1f316719347d1e53779b0553a67b
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.80"
49 .set version "4.80"
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54
55 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57 . provided in the xfpt library.
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59
60 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
61
62 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
63
64 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
66
67 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
68 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
69
70 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
73 . --- index entry.
74
75 .macro option
76 .arg 5
77 .oindex "&%$5%&"
78 .endarg
79 .arg -5
80 .oindex "&%$1%&"
81 .endarg
82 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
84 .endtable
85 .endmacro
86
87 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
90
91 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
92 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
93 .endmacro
94
95 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
98
99 .macro irow
100 .arg 4
101 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
102 .endarg
103 .arg -4
104 .arg 3
105 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
106 .endarg
107 .arg -3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
109 .endarg
110 .endarg
111 .endmacro
112
113 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116 . --- ID that ties them together.
117
118 .macro cindex
119 &<indexterm role="concept">&
120 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
121 .arg 2
122 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
123 .endarg
124 &</indexterm>&
125 .endmacro
126
127 .macro scindex
128 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
130 .arg 3
131 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
132 .endarg
133 &</indexterm>&
134 .endmacro
135
136 .macro ecindex
137 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
138 .endmacro
139
140 .macro oindex
141 &<indexterm role="option">&
142 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
143 .arg 2
144 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
145 .endarg
146 &</indexterm>&
147 .endmacro
148
149 .macro vindex
150 &<indexterm role="variable">&
151 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
152 .arg 2
153 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
154 .endarg
155 &</indexterm>&
156 .endmacro
157
158 .macro index
159 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
160 .endmacro
161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
162
163
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
166 . output formats.
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168
169 .literal xml
170 <bookinfo>
171 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173 <date>17 May 2012</date>
174 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176 <revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.80</revnumber>
178 <date>17 May 2012</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180 </revision></revhistory>
181 <copyright><year>2012</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
182 </bookinfo>
183 .literal off
184
185
186 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191
192 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
193 .literal xml
194
195 <indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
198 </indexterm>
199 <indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
203 </indexterm>
204 <indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
207 </indexterm>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
211 </indexterm>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
215 </indexterm>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
219 </indexterm>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
224 </indexterm>
225 <indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
228 </indexterm>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
232 </indexterm>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
236 </indexterm>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
240 </indexterm>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
245 </indexterm>
246 <indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
249 </indexterm>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
253 </indexterm>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
257 </indexterm>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
261 </indexterm>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
265 </indexterm>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
269 </indexterm>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
273 </indexterm>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
277 </indexterm>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
281 </indexterm>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
285 </indexterm>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
289 </indexterm>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
293 </indexterm>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
297 </indexterm>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
302 </indexterm>
303 <indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
306 </indexterm>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
310 </indexterm>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
314 </indexterm>
315
316 .literal off
317
318
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
322 . chapter "Introduction"
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324
325 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
329
330 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
337
338 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
341
342 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
345
346 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
351
352 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
357
358 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
362 contributors.
363
364
365 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
367
368 .new
369 .cindex "documentation"
370 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373 capable of showing a change indicator.
374 .wen
375
376 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
383 very wide interest.
384
385 .cindex "books about Exim"
386 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
390
391 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
395
396 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398 Debian-specific features in the file
399 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
401 information.
402
403 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
405 .cindex "change log"
406 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
411
412 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
416
417 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
419
420 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
423 directory are:
424
425 .table2 100pt
426 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
433 .endtable
434
435 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438
439
440
441 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
442 .cindex "web site"
443 .cindex "FTP site"
444 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
450
451 .cindex "wiki"
452 .cindex "FAQ"
453 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
458
459 .cindex Bugzilla
460 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
463
464
465
466 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
469
470 .table2 140pt
471 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
475 .endtable
476
477 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
482 via this web page:
483 .display
484 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
485 .endd
486 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
487 lists.
488
489 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490 .cindex "training courses"
491 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
495
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "FTP site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510 .display
511 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
512 .endd
513 This is mirrored by
514 .display
515 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
516 .endd
517 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520
521 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
525 .display
526 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
528 .endd
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
532
533 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
535 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
539 in:
540 .display
541 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
543 .endd
544 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
547
548 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
552 .display
553 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 .endd
558 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
560
561
562 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
563 .ilist
564 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
565 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
571 .next
572 .cindex "domainless addresses"
573 .cindex "address" "without domain"
574 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
578 arrival.
579 .next
580 .cindex "transport" "external"
581 .cindex "external transports"
582 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
588 .next
589 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
592 other means.
593 .next
594 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598 a number of common scanners are provided.
599 .endlist
600
601
602 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
608
609
610 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
619 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
622
623 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
627
628
629
630 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631 .cindex "terminology definitions"
632 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635 below) by a blank line.
636
637 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644 rise to further bounce messages.
645
646 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
649 otherwise.
650
651 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
654 until a later time.
655
656 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
659
660 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
661 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
662 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
668
669 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
671 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
675 line.
676
677 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
678 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
679 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
682
683 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
689
690 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
691 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
692 message's envelope.
693
694 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
695 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
699
700 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
705
706 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
712
713
714
715
716
717
718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720
721 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722 .cindex "incorporated code"
723 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
724 .cindex "PCRE"
725 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
726
727 .ilist
728 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
734 .next
735 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740 following statements:
741
742 .blockquote
743 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
744
745 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
748 version.
749 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753 restrictions applied to it).
754 .endblockquote
755 .next
756 .cindex "SPA authentication"
757 .cindex "Samba project"
758 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
762 under the Gnu GPL.
763 .next
764 .cindex "Cyrus"
765 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770 conditions expressed therein.
771
772 .blockquote
773 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
774
775 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
777 are met:
778
779 .olist
780 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
782 .next
783 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
786 distribution.
787 .next
788 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791 details, please contact
792 .display
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
795 5000 Forbes Avenue
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
799 .endd
800 .next
801 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
802 acknowledgment:
803
804 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
806
807 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
814 .endlist
815 .endblockquote
816
817 .next
818 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
819 .cindex "X-windows"
820 .cindex "Athena"
821 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
825
826 .blockquote
827 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
829
830 All Rights Reserved
831
832 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838 software without specific, written prior permission.
839
840 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
846 SOFTWARE.
847 .endblockquote
848
849 .next
850 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
853 .endlist
854
855
856
857
858
859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
861
862 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
864
865
866 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867 .cindex "design philosophy"
868 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
874
875
876 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
878 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
883
884 .ilist
885 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
894 error code.
895 .next
896 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
898 .next
899 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
903 .next
904 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
909 .next
910 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
913 .next
914 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916 runs at the start of every delivery process.
917 .endlist
918
919
920
921 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
922 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
923 .cindex "Sieve filter"
924 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929 of filtering are available:
930
931 .ilist
932 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
933 by RFC 3028.
934 .next
935 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
937 .endlist
938
939 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
940
941
942
943 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945 .cindex "format" "of message id"
946 .cindex "id of message"
947 .cindex "base62"
948 .cindex "base36"
949 .cindex "Darwin"
950 .cindex "Cygwin"
951 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958 not always case-sensitive.
959
960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
966 somewhat eccentric:
967
968 .ilist
969 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972 way of representing the date and time of day).
973 .next
974 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975 received the message.
976 .next
977 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
978 .olist
979 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
984 .next
985 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
987 (1/100) of a second.
988 .endlist
989 .endlist
990
991 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
996
997
998 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999 .cindex "receiving mail"
1000 .cindex "message" "reception"
1001 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004 there are several possibilities:
1005
1006 .ilist
1007 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1010 .next
1011 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1017 .next
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1023 .next
1024 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1028 .endlist
1029
1030
1031 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043 users to change sender addresses.
1044
1045 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1052
1053 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058 message is received.
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1072
1073 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082 affect file system performance.
1083
1084 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1089
1090 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1102
1103
1104
1105 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106 .cindex "message" "life of"
1107 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1108 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1114
1115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1120 to be sent.
1121
1122 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1127
1128 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1129 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1138 systems.
1139
1140 .cindex "journal file"
1141 .cindex "file" "journal"
1142 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1150
1151 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155 deliveries caused by crashes.
1156
1157
1158
1159 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1168
1169 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177 the driver's features in general.
1178
1179 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1183 to be bounced.
1184
1185 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1191
1192 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1198
1199 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1202 configuration.
1203
1204 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212 configured to fail the address.
1213
1214 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1220
1221 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226 the address is bounced.
1227
1228
1229
1230 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1232 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1238
1239 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252 .cindex "router" "running details"
1253 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1255 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1259 the following:
1260
1261 .ilist
1262 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264 original address ceases,
1265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1270 end of routing.
1271
1272 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1277 .next
1278 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1283 .next
1284 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1289 .next
1290 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1293 .next
1294 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1298 .next
1299 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1301 .endlist
1302
1303 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1308
1309 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313 facility for this purpose.
1314
1315
1316 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317 .cindex "case of local parts"
1318 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324 routed addresses are shown.
1325
1326
1327
1328 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1334
1335 .ilist
1336 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341 of any other conditions.
1342 .next
1343 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1346 address.
1347 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1351 .next
1352 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1357 .next
1358 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1360 .next
1361 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1363 .next
1364 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365 of domains that it defines.
1366 .next
1367 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1377 .next
1378 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1380 .vindex "&$home$&"
1381 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385 remaining preconditions.
1386 .next
1387 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391 could lead to confusion.
1392 .next
1393 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394 set of addresses that it defines.
1395 .next
1396 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397 specified files is tested.
1398 .next
1399 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1403 .endlist
1404
1405
1406 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1413
1414
1415
1416 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1419
1420 .ilist
1421 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1426 filtering'&.
1427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1429
1430 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1436 filter.
1437 .next
1438 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442 processed entirely independently of each other.
1443 .next
1444 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1453 .next
1454 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461 addresses to the same domain.
1462 .next
1463 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1471 .next
1472 .cindex "queue runner"
1473 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1482 .next
1483 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1489 .next
1490 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493 messages to other addresses.
1494 .next
1495 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1498 &'deferred'&.
1499 .next
1500 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1503 .endlist
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511 .cindex "queue runner"
1512 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519 passed its retry time.
1520 You can run several queue runners at once.
1521
1522 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1527 as permanent.
1528
1529
1530
1531 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1540 also apply.
1541
1542 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1545 deferred,
1546 .cindex "hints database"
1547 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1551 one connection.
1552
1553
1554
1555 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1566
1567 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1570 automatically.
1571
1572 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1579 of the list.
1580
1581
1582
1583 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1598
1599 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1601
1602 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1606
1607 .table2 140pt
1608 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1610 documented"
1611 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1615 instructions"
1616 .endtable
1617
1618 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619 following subdirectories are created:
1620
1621 .table2 140pt
1622 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1629 .endtable
1630
1631 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633 that may be useful to some sites.
1634
1635
1636 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1642 system.
1643 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647 overridden if necessary.
1648
1649
1650 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1651 .cindex "PCRE library"
1652 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1653 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1654 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1655 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1656 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1657 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1658 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1659 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1660 If your operating system has no
1661 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1662 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1663 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1664
1665 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1666 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1667 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1668 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1669 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1670 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1671 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1672
1673 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1674 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1675 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1677 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1678 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1679 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1680 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1681
1682 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1683 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1684 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1685 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1686 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1687 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1688 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1689 Berkeley DB library.
1690
1691 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1692 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1693 possibilities:
1694
1695 .olist
1696 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1697 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1698 .next
1699 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1700 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1701 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1702 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1703 file name is used unmodified.
1704 .next
1705 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1706 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1707 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1708 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1709 .next
1710 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1711 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1712 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1713 .next
1714 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1715 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1716 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1717 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1718 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1719 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1720 .next
1721 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1722 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1723 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1724 operates on a single file.
1725 .endlist
1726
1727 .cindex "USE_DB"
1728 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1729 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1730 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1731 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1732 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1733 .code
1734 USE_DB=yes
1735 .endd
1736 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1737 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1738
1739 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1740 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1741 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1742 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1743 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1744 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1745
1746 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1747 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1748 in one of these lines:
1749 .code
1750 DBMLIB = -ldb
1751 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1752 .endd
1753 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1754 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1755 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1756 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1757 this example:
1758 .code
1759 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1760 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1761 .endd
1762 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1763 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1764
1765
1766
1767 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1768 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1769 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1770 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1771 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1772 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1773 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1775 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1776 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1777 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1778 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1779
1780 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1781 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1782 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1783 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1784 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1785 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1786
1787 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1788 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1789 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1790 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1791 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1792 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1793 be logged.
1794
1795 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1796 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1797 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1798 facilities, you need to set
1799 .code
1800 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1801 .endd
1802 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1803 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1804
1805
1806 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1807 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1808 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1809 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1810 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1811 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1812 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1813
1814 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1815 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1816 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1817 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1818 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1819 do this.
1820
1821
1822
1823 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1824 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1825 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1826 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1827 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1828 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1829 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1830 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1831 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1832 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1833
1834 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1835 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1836 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1837 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1838 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1839 .code
1840 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1841 .endd
1842 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1843
1844
1845
1846 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1847 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1848 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1849 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1850 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1851 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1852 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1853 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1854 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1855 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1856 line option).
1857
1858 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1859 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1860 implementing SSL.
1861
1862 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1863 .code
1864 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1865 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1866 .endd
1867 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1868 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1869 .code
1870 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1871 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1872 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1873 .endd
1874 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1875 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1876 .code
1877 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1878 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1879 .endd
1880 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1881 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1882 .code
1883 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1884 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1885 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1886 .endd
1887 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1888 library and include files. For example:
1889 .code
1890 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1891 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1892 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1893 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1894 .endd
1895 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1896 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1897 .code
1898 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1899 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1900 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1901 .endd
1902
1903 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1904 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1905 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1906
1907
1908
1909
1910 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1911
1912 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1913 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1914 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1915 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1916 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1917 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1918 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1919 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1920 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1921 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1922 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1923 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1924 you might have
1925 .code
1926 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1927 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1928 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1929 .endd
1930 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1931 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1932 .code
1933 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1934 .endd
1935 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1936 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1937 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1938 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1939 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1940 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1941 further details.
1942
1943
1944 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1945 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1946 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1947 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1948 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1949 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1950 library files.
1951
1952 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1953 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1954 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1955 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1956 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1957 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1958 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1959 support has not been tested for some time.
1960
1961
1962
1963 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1964 .cindex "lookup modules"
1965 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1966 .cindex ".so building"
1967 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1968 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1969 on demand.
1970 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1971 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1972 dependencies.
1973 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1974
1975 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1976 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1977 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1978 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1979 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1980 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1981
1982 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1983 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1984 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1985 on demand:
1986 .code
1987 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
1988 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
1989 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
1990 .endd
1991
1992
1993 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1994 .cindex "build directory"
1995 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1996 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1997 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1998 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1999 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2000 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2001 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2002
2003 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2004 building process fails if it is set.
2005
2006 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2007 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2008 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2009 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2010 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2011 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2012 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2013 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2014
2015 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2016 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2017 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2018
2019
2020
2021 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2022 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2023 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2024 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2025 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2026 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2027 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2028 .code
2029 FULLECHO='' make -e
2030 .endd
2031 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2032 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2033 given in addition to the short output.
2034
2035
2036
2037 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2038 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2039 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2040 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2041 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2042 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2043 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2044 order:
2045 .display
2046 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2047 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2048 &_Local/Makefile_&
2049 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2050 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2051 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2052 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2053 .endd
2054 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2055 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2056 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2057 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2058 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2059 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2060 and are often not needed.
2061
2062 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2063 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2064 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2065 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2066 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2067 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2068 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2069 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2070 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2071
2072
2073 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2074 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2075 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2076 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2077 default values are.
2078
2079
2080 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2081 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2082 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2083 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2084 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2085 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2086 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2087 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2088 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2089 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2090 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2091 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2092 containing the lines
2093 .code
2094 CC=cc
2095 CFLAGS=-std1
2096 .endd
2097 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2098 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2099
2100 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2101 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2102 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2103
2104
2105 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2106 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2107 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2108 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2109 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2110 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2111 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2112 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2113 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2114 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2115 .code
2116 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2117 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2118 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2119 .endd
2120 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2121 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2122 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2123 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2124 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2125 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2126 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2127 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2128 errors.
2129
2130 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2131 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2132 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2133 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2134 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2135 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2136 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2137 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2138 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2139 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2140 syntax. For instance:
2141 .code
2142 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2143 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2144 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2145 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2146 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2147 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2148 .endd
2149
2150 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2151 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2152 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2153 .code
2154 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2155 .endd
2156 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2157 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2158
2159 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2160 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2161 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2162 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2163 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2164 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2165 .code
2166 X11=/usr/X11R6
2167 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2168 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2169 .endd
2170 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2171 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2172 .code
2173 X11=/usr/openwin
2174 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2175 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2176 .endd
2177 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2178 definition of all three of these variables into your
2179 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2180
2181 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2182 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2183 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2184 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2185 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2186
2187 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2188 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2189 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2190 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2191 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2192 libraries.
2193
2194 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2195 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2196 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2197 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2198 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2199
2200
2201 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2202 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2203 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2204 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2205 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2206 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2207 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2208 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2209
2210
2211
2212 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2213 .cindex "building Eximon"
2214 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2215 where the files that are involved are
2216 .display
2217 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2218 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2219 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2220 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2221 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2222 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2223 .endd
2224 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2225 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2226 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2227 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2228 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2229 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2230 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2231 .ecindex IIDbuex
2232
2233
2234 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2235 .cindex "installing Exim"
2236 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2237 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2238 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2239 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2240 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2241 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2242 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2243 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2244 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2245 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2246 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2247 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2248
2249 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2250 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2251 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2252 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2253 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2254 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2255 alternative files, no default is installed.
2256
2257 .cindex "system aliases file"
2258 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2259 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2260 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2261 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2262 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2263 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2264 and outputs a comment to the user.
2265
2266 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2267 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2268 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2269 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2270 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2271
2272 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2273 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2274 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2275 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2276 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2277 over SMTP.
2278
2279 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2280 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2281 command such as
2282 .code
2283 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2284 .endd
2285 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2286 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2287 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2288 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2289 but this usage is deprecated.
2290
2291 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2292 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2293 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2294 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2295 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2296 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2297
2298 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2299 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2300 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2301 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2302 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2303 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2304 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2305
2306 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2307 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2308 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2309 command:
2310 .code
2311 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2312 .endd
2313 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2314 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2315 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2316 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2317 command:
2318 .code
2319 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2320 .endd
2321 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2322 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2323
2324 .ilist
2325 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2326 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2327 .next
2328 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2329 installed binary.
2330 .endlist
2331
2332 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2333 .code
2334 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2335 .endd
2336 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2337 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2338 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2341 .endd
2342
2343
2344
2345 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2346 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2347 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2348 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2349 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2350 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2351
2352 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2353 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2354 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2355
2356
2357
2358 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2359 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2360 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2361 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2362 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2363 necessary.
2364
2365
2366
2367
2368 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2369 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2370 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2371 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2372 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2373 .code
2374 exim -bV
2375 .endd
2376 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2377 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2378 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2379 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2380 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2381 example,
2382 .display
2383 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2384 .endd
2385 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2386 .display
2387 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2388 .endd
2389 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2390 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2391 user agent. For example:
2392 .code
2393 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2394 From: user@your.domain.example
2395 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2396 Subject: Testing Exim
2397
2398 This is a test message.
2399 ^D
2400 .endd
2401 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2402 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2403 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2404
2405 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2406 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2407 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2408 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2409 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2410 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2413 .endd
2414 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2415 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2416 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2417 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2418 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2419
2420 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2421 .cindex "lock files"
2422 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2423 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2424 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2425 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2426 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2427 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2428 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2429 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2430 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2431 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2432 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2433 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2434
2435 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2436 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2437 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2438 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2439 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2440 incoming SMTP mail.
2441
2442 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2443 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2444 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2445 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2446 production version.
2447
2448
2449 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2450 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2451 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2452 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2453 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2454 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2455 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2456 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2457 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2458 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2459 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2460 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2461 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2462
2463 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2464 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2465 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2466 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2467 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2468 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2469 as follows:
2470 .code
2471 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2472 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2473 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2474 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2475 .endd
2476 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2477 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2478 favourite user agent.
2479
2480 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2481 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2482 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2483 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2484 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2485 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2486
2487
2488
2489 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2490 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2491 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2492 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2493 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2494 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2495 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2496 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2497 configuration file.
2498
2499
2500
2501
2502 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2503 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2504 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2505 .code
2506 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2507 .endd
2508 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2509 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2510 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2511 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2512 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2513 .code
2514 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2515 .endd
2516 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2517
2518 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2519 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2520 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2521
2522
2523
2524
2525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2527
2528 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2529 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2530 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2531 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2532 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2533 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2534 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2535 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2536 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2537
2538
2539 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2540 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2541 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2542 were present before any other options.
2543 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2544 standard output.
2545 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2546 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2547 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2548
2549 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2550 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2551 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2552 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2553 format.
2554
2555 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2556 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2557 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2558 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2559
2560 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2561 .cindex "queue runner"
2562 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2563 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2564 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2565
2566 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2567 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2568 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2569 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2570 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2571 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2572 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2573 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2574
2575
2576 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2577 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2578 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2579 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2580 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2581 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2582
2583 .ilist
2584 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2585 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2586 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2587 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2588 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2589 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2590
2591 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2592 .cindex "envelope sender"
2593 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2594 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2595 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2596 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2597 users to set envelope senders.
2598
2599 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2600 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2601 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2602 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2603 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2604
2605 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2606 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2607 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2608 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2609 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2610 that are available to trusted users.
2611 .next
2612 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2613 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2614 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2615 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2616 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2617
2618 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2619 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2620 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2621 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2622
2623 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2624 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2625 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2626 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2627
2628 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2629 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2630 false.
2631 .endlist
2632
2633
2634 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2635 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2636 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2637 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2638
2639
2640
2641
2642 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2643 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2644 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2645 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2646 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2647 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2648 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2649 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2650
2651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2652 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2653 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2654 . creates a man page for the options.
2655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2656
2657 .literal xml
2658 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2659 .literal off
2660
2661
2662 .vlist
2663 .vitem &%--%&
2664 .oindex "--"
2665 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2666 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2667 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2668 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2669
2670 .vitem &%--help%&
2671 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2672 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2673 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2674 no arguments.
2675
2676 .vitem &%--version%&
2677 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2678 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2679 displayed.
2680
2681 .new
2682 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2683 &%-Am%&
2684 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2685 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2686 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2687 ignored by Exim.
2688 .wen
2689
2690 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2691 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2692 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2693 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2694 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2695 clean; it ignores this option.
2696
2697 .vitem &%-bd%&
2698 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2699 .cindex "daemon"
2700 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2701 .cindex "queue runner"
2702 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2703 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2704 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2705
2706 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2707 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2708 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2709 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2710
2711 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2712 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2713 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2714 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2715
2716 When a listening daemon
2717 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2718 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2719 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2720 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2721 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2722 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2723 running as root.
2724
2725 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2726 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2727 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2728
2729 The SIGHUP signal
2730 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2731 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2732 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2733 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2734 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2735 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2736 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2737 because these are reread each time they are used.
2738
2739 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2740 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2741 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2742 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2743
2744 .vitem &%-be%&
2745 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2746 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2747 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2748 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2749 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2750 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2751 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2752
2753 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2754 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2755 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2756 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2757 test data. A line history is supported.
2758
2759 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2760 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2761 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2762 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2763 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2764 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2765 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2766
2767 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2768 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2769 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2770 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2771
2772 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2773 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2774 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2775 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2776 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2777 of a file. For example:
2778 .code
2779 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2780 .endd
2781 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2782 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2783 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2784 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2785 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2786 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2787 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2788 &%-be%&).
2789
2790 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2791 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2792 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2793 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2794 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2795 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2796 system filters are recognized.
2797
2798 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2799 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2800 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2801 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2802 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2803 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2804 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2805 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2806 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2807 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2808 supplied.
2809
2810 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2811 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2812 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2813 .code
2814 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2815 .endd
2816 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2817 variables that are used by the user filter.
2818
2819 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2820 .code
2821 # Exim filter
2822 # Sieve filter
2823 .endd
2824 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2825 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2826 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2827 redirection lists.
2828
2829 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2830 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2831 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2832 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2833
2834 When testing a filter file,
2835 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2836 .cindex "envelope sender"
2837 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2838 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2839 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2840 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2841 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2842 options).
2843
2844 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2845 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2846 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2847 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2848 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2849 &$qualify_domain$&.
2850
2851 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2852 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2853 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2854 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2855 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2856 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2857 actually being delivered.
2858
2859 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2860 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2861 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2862 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2863 prefix.
2864
2865 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2866 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2867 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2868 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2869 suffix.
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2873 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2874 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2875 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2876 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2877 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2878 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2879 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2880 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2881 after a full stop. For example:
2882 .code
2883 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2884 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2885 .endd
2886 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2887 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2888 conversion to the canonical form is
2889 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2890
2891 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2892 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2893 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2894 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2895 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2896
2897 &*Warning 1*&:
2898 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2899 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2900 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2901 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2902 connection.
2903
2904 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2905 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2906 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2907
2908 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2909 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2910 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2911 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2912 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2913 session were authenticated.
2914
2915 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2916 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2917 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2918
2919 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2920 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2921 specialized SMTP test program such as
2922 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2923
2924 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2925 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2926 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2927 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2928 updating the callout cache database.
2929
2930 .vitem &%-bi%&
2931 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2932 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2933 .cindex "building alias file"
2934 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2935 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2936 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2937 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2938 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2939 recognized.
2940
2941 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2942 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2943 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2944 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2945 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2946 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2947 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2948
2949 .new
2950 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2951 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2952 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2953 .cindex "querying exim information"
2954 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2955 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2956 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2957 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2958 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2959
2960 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2961 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2962 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2963 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2964 recognised DSCP names.
2965
2966 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2967 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2968 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2969 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2970 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2971 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2972 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2973 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
2974 way to guarantee a correct response.
2975 .wen
2976
2977 .vitem &%-bm%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
2979 .cindex "local message reception"
2980 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2981 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2982 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2983 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2984 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2985 if no other conflicting option is present.
2986
2987 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2988 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2989 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2990 suppressing this for special cases.
2991
2992 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2993 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2994
2995 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2996 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2997 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2998
2999 The format
3000 .cindex "message" "format"
3001 .cindex "format" "message"
3002 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3003 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3004 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3005 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3006 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3007 .code
3008 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3009 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3010 .endd
3011 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3012 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3013 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3014 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3015 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3016
3017 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3018 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3019 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3020 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3021 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3022
3023 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3024 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3025 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3026 .cindex "malware scan test"
3027 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3028 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3029 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3030 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3031 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3032 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3033
3034 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3035 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3036 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3037 This option requires admin privileges.
3038
3039 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3040 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3041 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3042
3043 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3044 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3045 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3046 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3047 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3048 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3049 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3050 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3051 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3052
3053 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3054 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3055 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3056 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3057 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3058
3059 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3060 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3061 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3062 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3063
3064
3065 .vitem &%-bP%&
3066 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3067 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3068 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3069 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3070 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3071 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3072 arguments, for example:
3073 .code
3074 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3075 .endd
3076 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3077 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3078 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3079 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3080 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3081 users, the output is as in this example:
3082 .code
3083 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3084 .endd
3085 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3086 configuration file is output.
3087 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3088 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3089
3090 .new
3091 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3092 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3093 name will not be output.
3094 .wen
3095
3096 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3097 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3098 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3099 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3100 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3101 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3102 written directly into the spool directory.
3103
3104 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3105 .code
3106 exim -bP +local_domains
3107 .endd
3108 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3109 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3110
3111 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3112 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3113 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3114 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3115 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3116 that driver are output. For example:
3117 .code
3118 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3119 .endd
3120 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3121 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3122 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3123 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3124 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3125 &%authenticators%&.
3126
3127 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3128 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3129 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3130 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3131 The output format is one item per line.
3132
3133 .vitem &%-bp%&
3134 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3135 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3136 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3137 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3138 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3139 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3140 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3141 to allow any user to see the queue.
3142
3143 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3144 .code
3145 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3146 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3147 <other addresses>
3148 .endd
3149 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3150 .cindex "size" "of message"
3151 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3152 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3153 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3154 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3155 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3156 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3157 before the sender address.
3158
3159 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3160 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3161 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3162
3163 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3164 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3165 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3166 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3167 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3168 complete.
3169
3170
3171 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3172 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3173 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3174 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3175 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3176 of just &"D"&.
3177
3178
3179 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3180 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3181 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3182 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3183 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3184 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3185
3186
3187 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3188 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3189 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3190 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3191 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3192 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3193
3194 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3195 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3196 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3197
3198 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3199 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3200 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3201
3202
3203 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3204 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3205 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3206 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3207 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3208 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3209
3210
3211 .vitem &%-brt%&
3212 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3213 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3214 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3215 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3216 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3217 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3218 .code
3219 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3220 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3221 .endd
3222 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3223 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3224 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3225 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3226 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3227 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3228 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3229 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3230 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3231 .code
3232 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3233 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3234 .endd
3235
3236 .vitem &%-brw%&
3237 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3238 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3239 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3240 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3241 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3242 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3243 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3244 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3245
3246 .vitem &%-bS%&
3247 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3248 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3249 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3250 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3251 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3252 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3253 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3254 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3255 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3256 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3257
3258 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3259 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3260 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3261
3262 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3263 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3264 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3265 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3266
3267 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3268 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3269 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3270
3271 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3272 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3273 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3274 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3275 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3276
3277 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3278 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3279
3280 .vitem &%-bs%&
3281 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3282 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3283 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3284 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3285 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3286 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3287 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3288 messages to the MTA.
3289
3290 In
3291 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3292 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3293 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3294 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3295 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3296 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3297 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3298
3299 .cindex "inetd"
3300 The
3301 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3302 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3303 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3304 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3305 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3306 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3307 the listening daemon.
3308
3309 .vitem &%-bt%&
3310 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3311 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3312 .cindex "address" "testing"
3313 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3314 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3315 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3316 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3317 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3318
3319 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3320 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3321
3322 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3323 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3324 security issues.
3325
3326 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3327 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3328 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3329 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3330 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3331 program.
3332
3333 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3334 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3335 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3336 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3337
3338 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3339 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3340 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3341 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3342 always shown.
3343
3344 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3345 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3346 message,
3347 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3348 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3349 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3350 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3351 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3352 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3353 doing such tests.
3354
3355 .vitem &%-bV%&
3356 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3357 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3358 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3359 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3360 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3361 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3362 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3363
3364 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3365 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3366 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3367 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3368 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3369 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3370 dynamic testing facilities.
3371
3372 .vitem &%-bv%&
3373 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3374 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3375 .cindex "address" "verification"
3376 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3377 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3378 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3379 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3380 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3381 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3382
3383 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3384 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3385 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3386
3387 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3388 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3389
3390 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3391 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3392 security issues.
3393
3394 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3395 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3396 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3397 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3398 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3399
3400 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3401 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3402 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3403 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3404 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3405 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3406 to succeed.
3407
3408 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3409 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3410 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3411
3412 The
3413 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3414 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3415 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3416 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3417
3418 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3419 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3420 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3421 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3422
3423 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3424 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3425 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3426 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3427 might happen.
3428
3429 .vitem &%-bw%&
3430 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3431 .cindex "daemon"
3432 .cindex "inetd"
3433 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3434 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3435 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3436 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3437
3438 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3439 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3440 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3441 each port only when the first connection is received.
3442
3443 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3444 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3445
3446 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3447 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3448 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3449 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3450 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3451 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3452 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3453 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3454 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3455 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3456 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3457
3458 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3459 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3460 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3461 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3462 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3463 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3464 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3465 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3466 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3467
3468 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3469 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3470 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3471 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3472 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3473 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3474 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3475
3476 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3477 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3478 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3479 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3480 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3481 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3482 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3483
3484 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3485 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3486 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3487 configuration file.
3488
3489 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3490 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3491 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3492 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3493 specified by this option.
3494
3495
3496 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3497 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3498 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3499 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3500 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3501 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3502 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3503 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3504
3505 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3506 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3507 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3508 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3509 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3510 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3511 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3512
3513 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3514 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3515 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3516 synonymous:
3517 .code
3518 exim -DABC ...
3519 exim -DABC= ...
3520 .endd
3521 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3522 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3523 example:
3524 .code
3525 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3526 .endd
3527 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3528
3529
3530 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3531 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3532 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3533 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3534 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3535 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3536 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3537 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3538 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3539 return code.
3540
3541 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3542 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3543 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3544 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3545 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3546 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3547 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3548 are:
3549 .display
3550 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3551 &`auth `& authenticators
3552 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3553 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3554 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3555 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3556 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3557 &`filter `& filter handling
3558 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3559 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3560 &`ident `& ident lookup
3561 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3562 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3563 &`load `& system load checks
3564 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3565 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3566 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3567 &`memory `& memory handling
3568 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3569 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3570 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3571 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3572 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3573 &`retry `& retry handling
3574 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3575 &`route `& address routing
3576 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3577 &`tls `& TLS logic
3578 &`transport `& transports
3579 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3580 &`verify `& address verification logic
3581 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3582 .endd
3583 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3584 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3585 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3586 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3587 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3588 turn everything off.
3589
3590 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3591 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3592 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3593 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3594 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3595 rather than stderr.
3596
3597 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3598 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3599 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3600 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3601 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3602 run in parallel.
3603
3604 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3605 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3606 in processing.
3607
3608 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3609 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3610
3611 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3612 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3613 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3614 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3615 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3616 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3617
3618 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3619 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3620 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3621 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3622 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3623
3624 .vitem &%-E%&
3625 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3626 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3627 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3628 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3629 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3630 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3631 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3632 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3633 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3634
3635 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3636 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3637 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3638 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3639 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3640 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3641
3642 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3643 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3644 .cindex "sender" "name"
3645 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3646 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3647 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3648 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3649 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3650 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3651
3652 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3653 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3654 .cindex "sender" "address"
3655 .cindex "address" "sender"
3656 .cindex "trusted users"
3657 .cindex "envelope sender"
3658 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3659 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3660 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3661 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3662 users to use it.
3663
3664 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3665 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3666 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3667 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3668 domain.
3669
3670 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3671 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3672 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3673 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3674 examples of shell commands:
3675 .code
3676 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3677 exim -f "" user@domain
3678 .endd
3679 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3680 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3681 &%-bv%& options.
3682
3683 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3684 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3685 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3686 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3687
3688 White
3689 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3690 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3691 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3692 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3693 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3694 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3695
3696 .vitem &%-G%&
3697 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3698 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3699 .new
3700 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3701 .code
3702 control = suppress_local_fixups
3703 .endd
3704 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3705 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3706 in future.
3707
3708 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3709 this option.
3710 .wen
3711
3712 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3713 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3714 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3715 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3716 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3717 headers.)
3718
3719 .vitem &%-i%&
3720 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3721 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3722 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3723 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3724 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3725 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3726 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3727
3728 .new
3729 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3730 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3731 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3732 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3733 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3734 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3735 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3736 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3737
3738 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3739 .wen
3740
3741 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3742 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3743 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3744 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3745 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3746 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3747 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3748 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3749 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3750
3751 Retry
3752 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3753 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3754 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3755 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3756 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3757 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3758
3759 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3760 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3761 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3762 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3763
3764 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3765 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3766 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3767 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3768 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3769 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3770 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3771 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3772 can be used only by an admin user.
3773
3774 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3775 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3776 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3777 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3778 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3779 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3780 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3781 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3782 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3783 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3784 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3787 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3788 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3789 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3790 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3791
3792 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3793 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3794 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3795 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3796 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3797
3798 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3799 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3800 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3801 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3802 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3803 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3804 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3805 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3806
3807 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3808 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3809 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3810 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3811 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3812 connection.
3813
3814 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3818 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3821 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3822 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3823 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3824 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3825 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3826 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3827 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3828 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3829 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3830 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3831 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3832 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3833 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3834 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3835
3836 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3837 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3838 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3839 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3840 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3841 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3842 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3843 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3844 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3845 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3846
3847 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3848 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3849 .cindex "freezing messages"
3850 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3851 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3852 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3853 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3854 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3855 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3856 user.
3857
3858 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3859 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3860 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3861 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3862 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3863 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3864 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3865 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3866 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3867 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3868 user.
3869
3870 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3871 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3872 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3874 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3875 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3876 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3877
3878 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3879 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3880 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3881 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3882 .cindex "removing recipients"
3883 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3884 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3885 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3886 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3887 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3888 can be used only by an admin user.
3889
3890 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3891 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3892 .cindex "removing messages"
3893 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3894 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3895 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3896 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3897 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3898 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3899 placed on the queue.
3900
3901 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3902 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3903 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3904 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3905 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3906 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3907 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3908 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3909 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3910 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3911 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3912
3913 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3914 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3915 .cindex "thawing messages"
3916 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3917 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3918 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3919 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3920 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3921 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3922 by an admin user.
3923
3924 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3925 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3926 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3927 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3928 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3929 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3930
3931 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3932 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3933 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3934 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3935 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3936 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3937 only by an admin user.
3938
3939 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3940 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3941 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3942 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3943 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3944 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3945 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3946
3947 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3948 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3949 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3950 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3951 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3952 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3953
3954 .vitem &%-m%&
3955 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3956 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3957 treats it that way too.
3958
3959 .vitem &%-N%&
3960 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3961 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3962 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3963 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3964 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3965 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3966 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3967 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3968 than &"=>"&.
3969
3970 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3971 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3972 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3973 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3974 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3975 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3976 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3977 for that message.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-n%&
3980 .oindex "&%-n%&"
3981 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
3982 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
3983 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
3984
3985 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3986 .oindex "&%-O%&"
3987 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3988 Exim.
3989
3990 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3991 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
3992 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3993 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3994 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3995 description above.
3996
3997 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3998 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
3999 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4000 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4001 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4002 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4003 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4004 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4005
4006 .vitem &%-odb%&
4007 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4008 .cindex "background delivery"
4009 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4010 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4011 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4012 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4013 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4014 processes to finish.
4015
4016 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4017 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4018 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4019 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4020
4021 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4022 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4023 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4024 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4025
4026 .vitem &%-odf%&
4027 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4028 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4029 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4030 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4031 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4032 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4033 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4034
4035 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4036 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4037 during deliveries.
4038
4039 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4040 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4041
4042 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4043 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4044 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4045 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4046
4047
4048 .vitem &%-odi%&
4049 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4050 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4051 Sendmail.
4052
4053 .vitem &%-odq%&
4054 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4055 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4056 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4057 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4058 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4059 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4060 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4061 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4062 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4063 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4064 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4065 forces queueing.
4066
4067 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4068 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4069 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4070 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4071 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4072 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4073 configuration file is in effect.
4074
4075 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4076 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4077 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4078 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4079 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4080 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4081 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4082 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4083 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4084 &%-qq%& option.
4085
4086 .vitem &%-oee%&
4087 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4088 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4089 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4090 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4091 message.
4092
4093 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4094 Provided
4095 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4096 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4097 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
4098 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4099
4100 .vitem &%-oem%&
4101 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4102 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4103 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4104 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4105 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4106 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-oep%&
4109 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4112 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4113 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4114 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4115
4116 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4117 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4118 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4119 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4120 effect as &%-oep%&.
4121
4122 .vitem &%-oew%&
4123 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4126 effect as &%-oem%&.
4127
4128 .vitem &%-oi%&
4129 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4130 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4131 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4132 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4133 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4134 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4135 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4136
4137 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4138 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4139 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4140
4141 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4142 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4143 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4144 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4145 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4146 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4147 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4148 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4149
4150 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4151 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4152 .code
4153 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4154 .endd
4155 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4156 followed by a colon and the port number:
4157 .code
4158 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4159 .endd
4160 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4161 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4162 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4163 whichever one is last.
4164
4165 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4166 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4167 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4168 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4169 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4170 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4171 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4172 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4173
4174 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4175 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4176 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4177 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4178 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4179 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4180 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4181 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4182
4183 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4184 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4185 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4186 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4187 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4188 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4189 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4190 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4191 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4192 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4193
4194 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4195 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4196 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4197 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4198 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4199 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4200 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4201
4202 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4203 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4204 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4205 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4206 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4207 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4208 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4209 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4210 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4211 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4212 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4213 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4214
4215 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4216 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4217 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4219 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4220 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4221 uses the name it is given.
4222
4223 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4224 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4225 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4226 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4227 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4228 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4229 used, when there is no default.
4230
4231 .vitem &%-om%&
4232 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4233 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4234 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4235 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4236 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4237
4238 .vitem &%-oo%&
4239 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4240 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4241 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4242 whatever that means.
4243
4244 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4245 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4246 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4247 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4248 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4249 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4250 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4251 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4252 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4253
4254 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4255 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4256 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4257 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4258 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4259 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4260 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4261
4262 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4263 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4264 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4265 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4266 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4267 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4268 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4269 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4270
4271 .vitem &%-ov%&
4272 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4273 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4274
4275 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4276 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4277 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4278 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4279 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4280 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4281 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4282 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4283 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4284 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4285
4286 .vitem &%-pd%&
4287 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4288 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4289 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4290 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4291 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4292 needed.
4293
4294 .vitem &%-ps%&
4295 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4296 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4297 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4298 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4299 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4300 started.
4301
4302 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4303 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4304 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4305 .display
4306 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4307 .endd
4308 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4309 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4310 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4311 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4312 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4313
4314 .vitem &%-q%&
4315 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4316 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4317 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4318 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4319 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4320 and &%-S%& options).
4321
4322 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4323 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4324 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4325 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4326 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4327 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4328
4329 If
4330 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4331 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4332 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4333 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4334 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4335 proceeding.
4336
4337 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4338 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4339 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4340 this to be repeated periodically.
4341
4342 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4343 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4344 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4345 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4346
4347 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4348 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4349 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4350
4351 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4352 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4353 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4354 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4355
4356 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4357 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4358 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4359 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4360 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4361 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4362 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4363 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4364 transports are run.
4365
4366 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4367 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4368 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4369 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4370 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4371 delivered down a single SMTP
4372 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4374 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4375 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4376 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4377 intermittently.
4378
4379 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4380 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4381 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4382 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4383 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4384 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4385 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4386
4387 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4388 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4389 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4390 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4391 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4392 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4393 their retry times are tried.
4394
4395 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4396 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4397 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4398 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4399 frozen or not.
4400
4401 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4402 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4403 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4404 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4405 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4406 for later delivery.
4407
4408 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4409 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4410 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4411 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4412 starting message id. For example:
4413 .code
4414 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4415 .endd
4416 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4417 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4418 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4419 .code
4420 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4421 .endd
4422 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4423 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4424 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4425 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4426 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4427 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4428
4429 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4430 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4431 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4432 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4433 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4434 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4435 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4436 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4437 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4438 .code
4439 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4440 .endd
4441 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4442 process every 30 minutes.
4443
4444 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4445 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4448 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4449 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4450 compatibility.
4451
4452 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4453 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4454 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4455
4456 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4457 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4458 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4459 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4460 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4461 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4462 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4463 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4464 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4465
4466 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4467 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4468 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4469 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4470 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4471 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4472
4473 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4474 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4475 .code
4476 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4477 .endd
4478 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4479 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4480 applied to each queue run.
4481
4482 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4483 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4484 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4485 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4486 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4487 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4488 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4489 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4490 address will be skipped.
4491
4492 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4493 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4494 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4495 &'ff'& is present.
4496
4497 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4498 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4499 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4500 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4501 an arbitrary command instead.
4502
4503 .vitem &%-r%&
4504 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4505 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4506
4507 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4508 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4509 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4510 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4511 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4512 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4513 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4514 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4515
4516 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4517 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4518 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4519 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4520 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4521
4522 .vitem &%-t%&
4523 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4524 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4525 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4526 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4527 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4528 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4529 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4530 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4531 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4532 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4533
4534 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4535 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4536 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4537 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4538 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4539 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4540 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4541 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4542 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4543 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4544 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4545
4546 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4547 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4548 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4549 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4550 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4551 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4552
4553 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4554 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4555 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4556 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4557 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4558 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4559 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4560 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4561 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4562
4563 .vitem &%-ti%&
4564 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4565 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4566 compatibility with Sendmail.
4567
4568 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4569 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4570 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4571 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4572 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4573 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4574 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4575 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4576
4577
4578 .vitem &%-U%&
4579 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4580 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4581 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4582 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4583 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4584 set. Exim ignores this option.
4585
4586 .vitem &%-v%&
4587 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4588 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4589 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4590 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4591 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4592 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4593 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4594 unconditional.
4595
4596 .vitem &%-x%&
4597 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4598 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4599 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4600 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4601 this option.
4602
4603 .new
4604 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4605 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4606 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4607 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4608 .wen
4609 .endlist
4610
4611 .ecindex IIDclo1
4612 .ecindex IIDclo2
4613
4614
4615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4616 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4617 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4618 . creates a man page for the options.
4619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4620
4621 .literal xml
4622 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4623 .literal off
4624
4625
4626
4627
4628
4629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4631
4632
4633 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4634 "The runtime configuration file"
4635
4636 .cindex "run time configuration"
4637 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4638 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4639 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4640 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4641 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4642 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4643 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4644 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4645 control.
4646
4647 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4648 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4649 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4650 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4651 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4652 actually alter the string.
4653
4654 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4655 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4656 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4657 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4658 existing file in the list.
4659
4660 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4661 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4662 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4663 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4664 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4665 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4666 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4667 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4668 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4669 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4670 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4671
4672 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4673 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4674 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4675 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4676 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4677
4678 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4679 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4680 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4681 compromise the Exim user account.
4682
4683 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4684 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4685 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4686 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4687 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4688 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4689 configuration.
4690
4691
4692
4693 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4694 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4695 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4696 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4697 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4698 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4699 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4700 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4701 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4702 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4703 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4704
4705 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4706 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4707 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4708 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4709 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4710 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4711 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4712 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4713 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4714 &%-M%&).
4715
4716 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4717 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4718 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4719 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4720 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4721
4722 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4723 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4724 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4725 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4726 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4727 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4728
4729 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4730 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4731 necessarily be discarded.
4732 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4733 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4734 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4735 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4736 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4737 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4738
4739 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4740 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4741 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4742 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4743 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4744 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4745 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4746
4747 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4748 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4749 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4750
4751
4752
4753 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4754 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4755 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4756 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4757 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4758 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4759 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4760 optional parts are:
4761
4762 .ilist
4763 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4764 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4765 .next
4766 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4767 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4768 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4769 .next
4770 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4771 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4772 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4773 .next
4774 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4775 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4776 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4777 .next
4778 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4779 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4780 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4781 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4782 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4783 .next
4784 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4785 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4786 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4787 .next
4788 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4789 want to use this feature, you must set
4790 .code
4791 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4792 .endd
4793 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4794 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4795 .endlist
4796
4797 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4798 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4799 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4800 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4801
4802 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4803 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4804 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4805 and does not introduce a comment.
4806
4807 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4808 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4809 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4810 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4811 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4812
4813 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4814 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4815 change settings as required.
4816
4817 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4818 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4819 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4820 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4821 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4822 described.
4823
4824
4825
4826 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4827 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4828 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4829 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4830 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4831 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4832 using this syntax:
4833 .display
4834 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4835 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4836 .endd
4837 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4838 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4839 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4840 name is required.
4841
4842 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4843 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4844 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4845 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4846
4847 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4848 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4849 for example:
4850 .code
4851 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4852 .include /some/file
4853 .endd
4854 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4855 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4856 inclusion appears.
4857
4858
4859
4860 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4861 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4862 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4863 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4864 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4865 definition, and must be of the form
4866 .display
4867 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4868 .endd
4869 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4870 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4871 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4872 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4873 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4874
4875 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4876 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4877 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4878
4879 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4880 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4881 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4882 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4883 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4884 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4885 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4886 define
4887 .display
4888 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4889 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4890 .endd
4891 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4892 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4893 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4894 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4895 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4896 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4897
4898
4899 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4900 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4901 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4902 &'='&. For example:
4903 .code
4904 MAC = initial value
4905 ...
4906 MAC == updated value
4907 .endd
4908 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4909 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4910 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4911 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4912 .code
4913 MAC = initial value
4914 ...
4915 MAC == MAC and something added
4916 .endd
4917 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4918 from a number of other files.
4919
4920 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4921 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4922 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4923 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4924 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4925 file to be ignored.
4926
4927
4928
4929 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4930 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4931 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4932 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4933 .code
4934 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4935 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4936 .endd
4937 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4938 .code
4939 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4940 .endd
4941 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4942 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4943 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4944
4945
4946 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4947 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4948 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4949 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4950 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4951 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4952 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4953
4954 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4955 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4956 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4957 line. Thus:
4958 .code
4959 .ifdef AAA
4960 message_size_limit = 50M
4961 .else
4962 message_size_limit = 100M
4963 .endif
4964 .endd
4965 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4966 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4967 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4968 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4969
4970 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4971 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4972 in this line"& will always be true.
4973
4974 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4975 to clarify complicated nestings.
4976
4977
4978
4979 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4980 .cindex "common option syntax"
4981 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4982 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4983 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4984 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4985 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4986 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4987 space) and then the value. For example:
4988 .code
4989 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4990 .endd
4991 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4992 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4993 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4994 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4995 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4996 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4997 word &"hide"&. For example:
4998 .code
4999 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5000 .endd
5001 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5002 .code
5003 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5004 .endd
5005 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5006 all instances of the same driver.
5007
5008 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5009 that are found in option settings.
5010
5011
5012 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5013 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5014 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5015 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5016 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5017 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5018 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5019 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5020 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5021 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5022 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5023 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5024 .code
5025 queue_only
5026 queue_only = true
5027 .endd
5028 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5029 .code
5030 no_queue_only
5031 queue_only = false
5032 .endd
5033 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5034
5035
5036
5037
5038 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5039 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5040 .cindex "format" "integer"
5041 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5042 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5043 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5044 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5045 hexadecimal number.
5046
5047 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5048 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5049 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5050 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5051 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5052 used.
5053
5054
5055 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5056 .cindex "integer format"
5057 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5058 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5059 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5060 Such options are always output in octal.
5061
5062
5063 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5064 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5065 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5066 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5067 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5068
5069
5070
5071 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5072 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5073 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5074 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5075 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5076
5077 .table2 30pt
5078 .irow &%s%& seconds
5079 .irow &%m%& minutes
5080 .irow &%h%& hours
5081 .irow &%d%& days
5082 .irow &%w%& weeks
5083 .endtable
5084
5085 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5086 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5087 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5088
5089
5090
5091 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5092 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5093 .cindex "format" "string"
5094 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5095 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5096 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5097 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5098 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5099 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5100 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5101 therefore equivalent:
5102 .code
5103 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5104 trusted_users = uucp:\
5105 # This comment line is ignored
5106 mail
5107 .endd
5108 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5109 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5110 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5111 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5112 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5113
5114 .table2 100pt
5115 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5116 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5117 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5118 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5119 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5120 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5121 character"
5122 .endtable
5123
5124 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5125 character, that character replaces the pair.
5126
5127 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5128 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5129 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5130 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5131 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5132 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5133
5134
5135 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5136 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5137 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5138 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5139 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5140 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5141 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5142 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5143 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5144 within a quoted configuration string.
5145
5146
5147 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5148 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5149 .cindex "format" "user name"
5150 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5151 .cindex "format" "group name"
5152 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5153 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5154 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5155 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5156
5157
5158 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5159 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5160 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5161 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5162 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5163 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5164 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5165 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5166 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5167 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5168 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5169
5170 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5171 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5172 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5173 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5174 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5175 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5176 example, the list
5177 .code
5178 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5179 .endd
5180 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5181
5182 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5183 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5184 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5185 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5186
5187 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5188 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5189 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5190 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5191 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5192 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5193 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5194 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5195 .code
5196 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5197 .endd
5198 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5199 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5200 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5201
5202 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5203 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5204 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5205 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5206 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5207 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5208 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5209 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5210 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5211 .code
5212 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5213 .endd
5214 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5215 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5216 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5217 the value in quotes. For example:
5218 .code
5219 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5220 .endd
5221 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5222 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5223 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5224 enclosing an empty list item.
5225
5226
5227
5228 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5229 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5230 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5231 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5232 .code
5233 senders = user@domain :
5234 .endd
5235 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5236 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5237 items, the second of which is empty:
5238 .code
5239 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5240 .endd
5241 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5242 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5243 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5244 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5245 .code
5246 senders = :
5247 .endd
5248 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5249 is at the end of the list.
5250
5251
5252
5253
5254 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5255 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5256 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5257 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5258 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5259 a sequence of lines like this:
5260 .display
5261 <&'instance name'&>:
5262 <&'option'&>
5263 ...
5264 <&'option'&>
5265 .endd
5266 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5267 followed by three options settings:
5268 .code
5269 localuser:
5270 driver = accept
5271 check_local_user
5272 transport = local_delivery
5273 .endd
5274 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5275 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5276 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5277 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5278 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5279 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5280
5281 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5282 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5283
5284 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5285 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5286 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5287 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5288 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5289 server.
5290
5291 .cindex "generic options"
5292 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5293 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5294 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5295 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5296 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5297 .cindex "private options"
5298 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5299 they all have default values.
5300
5301 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5302 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5303 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5304
5305 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5306 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5307 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5308 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5309 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5310 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5311 configuration lines:
5312 .code
5313 remote_smtp:
5314 driver = smtp
5315 .endd
5316 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5317 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5318 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5319 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5320 thus:
5321 .code
5322 special_smtp:
5323 driver = smtp
5324 port = 1234
5325 command_timeout = 10s
5326 .endd
5327 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5328 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5329 lines.
5330
5331 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5332 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5333 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5334 option.
5335
5336
5337
5338
5339
5340
5341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5343
5344 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5345 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5346 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5347 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5348 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5349 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5350 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5351 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5352 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5353 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5354 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5355
5356
5357
5358 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5359 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5360 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5361 the line
5362 .code
5363 # primary_hostname =
5364 .endd
5365 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5366 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5367 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5368 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5369
5370 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5371 .code
5372 domainlist local_domains = @
5373 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5374 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5375 .endd
5376 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5377 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5378 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5379 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5380
5381 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5382 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5383 on the local host.
5384
5385 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5386 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5387 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5388 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5389 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5390 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5391
5392 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5393 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5394 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5395 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5396 domain is permitted.
5397
5398 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5399 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5400 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5401 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5402 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5403 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5404
5405 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5406 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5407 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5408
5409 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5410 .code
5411 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5412 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5413 .endd
5414 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5415 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5416 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5417 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5418 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5419 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5420 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5421 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5422 contents of a message to be checked.
5423
5424 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5425 .code
5426 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5427 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5428 .endd
5429 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5430 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5431 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5432 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5433
5434 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5435 .code
5436 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5437 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5438 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5439 .endd
5440 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5441 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5442 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5443 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5444 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5445 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5446 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5447
5448 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5449 .code
5450 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5451 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5452 .endd
5453 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5454 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5455 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5456 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5457 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5458 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5459 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5460 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5461 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5462 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5463 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5464 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5465 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5466 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5467 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5468 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5469
5470 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5471 .code
5472 # qualify_domain =
5473 # qualify_recipient =
5474 .endd
5475 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5476 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5477 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5478 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5479 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5480 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5481
5482 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5483 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5484 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5485 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5486 .code
5487 # allow_domain_literals
5488 .endd
5489 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5490 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5491 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5492 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5493 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5494 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5495
5496 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5497 .code
5498 never_users = root
5499 .endd
5500 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5501 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5502 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5503 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5504 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5505 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5506 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5507 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5508
5509 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5510 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5511 line,
5512 .code
5513 host_lookup = *
5514 .endd
5515 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5516 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5517 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5518 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5519 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5520 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5521 unreachable.
5522
5523 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5524 1413 (hence their names):
5525 .code
5526 rfc1413_hosts = *
5527 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5528 .endd
5529 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5530 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5531 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5532 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5533 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5534 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5535 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5536
5537 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5538 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5539 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5540 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5541 .code
5542 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5543 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5544 .endd
5545 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5546 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5547
5548 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5549 .code
5550 # percent_hack_domains =
5551 .endd
5552 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5553 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5554 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5555
5556 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5557 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5558 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5559 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5560 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5561 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5562 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5563 always bounce messages.
5564 .code
5565 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5566 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5567 .endd
5568 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5569 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5570 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5571 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5572 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5573
5574
5575
5576 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5577 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5578 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5579 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5580 It starts with the line
5581 .code
5582 begin acl
5583 .endd
5584 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5585 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5586 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5587
5588 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5589 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5590 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5591 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5592 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5593 result of the ACL processing.
5594 .code
5595 acl_check_rcpt:
5596 .endd
5597 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5598 ACL, and names it.
5599 .code
5600 accept hosts = :
5601 .endd
5602 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5603 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5604 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5605 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5606 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5607 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5608
5609 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5610 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5611 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5612 manner.
5613 .code
5614 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5615 domains = +local_domains
5616 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5617
5618 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5619 domains = !+local_domains
5620 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5621 .endd
5622 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5623 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5624 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5625 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5626 in Internet mail addresses.
5627
5628 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5629 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5630 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5631 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5632 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5633 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5634 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5635 policy of being as safe as possible.
5636
5637 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5638 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5639 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5640 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5641 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5642 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5643
5644 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5645 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5646 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5647 have to modify this rule.
5648
5649 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5650 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5651 common convention of local parts constructed as
5652 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5653 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5654 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5655 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5656 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5657 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5658
5659 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5660 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5661 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5662 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5663 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5664 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5665 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5666 .code
5667 accept local_parts = postmaster
5668 domains = +local_domains
5669 .endd
5670 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5671 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5672 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5673 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5674 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5675
5676 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5677 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5678 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5679 .code
5680 require verify = sender
5681 .endd
5682 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5683 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5684 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5685 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5686 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5687 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5688 discusses the details of address verification.
5689 .code
5690 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5691 control = submission
5692 .endd
5693 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5694 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5695 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5696 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5697 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5698 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5699 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5700 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5701 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5702 .code
5703 accept authenticated = *
5704 control = submission
5705 .endd
5706 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5707 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5708 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5709 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5710 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5711 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5712 .code
5713 require message = relay not permitted
5714 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5715 .endd
5716 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5717 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5718 .code
5719 require verify = recipient
5720 .endd
5721 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5722 fails, the address is rejected.
5723 .code
5724 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5725 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5726 # $dnslist_text
5727 # dnslists = black.list.example
5728 #
5729 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5730 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5731 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5732 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5733 .endd
5734 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5735 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5736 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5737 line.
5738 .code
5739 # require verify = csa
5740 .endd
5741 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5742 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5743 records.
5744 .code
5745 accept
5746 .endd
5747 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5748 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5749 .code
5750 acl_check_data:
5751 .endd
5752 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5753 of this ACL are commented out:
5754 .code
5755 # deny malware = *
5756 # message = This message contains a virus \
5757 # ($malware_name).
5758 .endd
5759 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5760 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5761 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5762 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5763 .code
5764 # warn spam = nobody
5765 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5766 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5767 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5768 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5769 .endd
5770 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5771 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5772 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5773 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5774 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5775 whatever the spam score.
5776 .code
5777 accept
5778 .endd
5779 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5780
5781
5782 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5783 .cindex "default" "routers"
5784 .cindex "routers" "default"
5785 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5786 by the line
5787 .code
5788 begin routers
5789 .endd
5790 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5791 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5792 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5793 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5794 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5795 .code
5796 # domain_literal:
5797 # driver = ipliteral
5798 # domains = !+local_domains
5799 # transport = remote_smtp
5800 .endd
5801 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5802 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5803 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5804 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5805 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5806 .code
5807 dnslookup:
5808 driver = dnslookup
5809 domains = ! +local_domains
5810 transport = remote_smtp
5811 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5812 no_more
5813 .endd
5814 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5815 domains. This is specified by the line
5816 .code
5817 domains = ! +local_domains
5818 .endd
5819 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5820 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5821 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5822 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5823 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5824 passed on to the following routers.
5825
5826 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5827 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5828 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5829 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5830 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5831
5832 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5833 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5834 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5835 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5836 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5837 the address fails and is bounced.
5838
5839 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5840 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5841 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5842 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5843 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5844 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5845 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5846 out.
5847 .code
5848 system_aliases:
5849 driver = redirect
5850 allow_fail
5851 allow_defer
5852 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5853 # user = exim
5854 file_transport = address_file
5855 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5856 .endd
5857 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5858 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5859 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5860 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5861 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5862 the next router.
5863
5864 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5865 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5866 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5867 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5868 .code
5869 userforward:
5870 driver = redirect
5871 check_local_user
5872 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5873 # local_part_suffix_optional
5874 file = $home/.forward
5875 # allow_filter
5876 no_verify
5877 no_expn
5878 check_ancestor
5879 file_transport = address_file
5880 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5881 reply_transport = address_reply
5882 .endd
5883 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5884 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5885 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5886 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5887 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5888 namely:
5889 .code
5890 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5891 # local_part_suffix_optional
5892 .endd
5893 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5894 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5895 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5896 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5897 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5898 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5899 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5900
5901 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5902 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5903 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5904 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5905
5906 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5907 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5908 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5909 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5910 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5911 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5912 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5913
5914 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5915 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5916 There are two reasons for doing this:
5917
5918 .olist
5919 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5920 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5921 unnecessary work.
5922 .next
5923 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5924 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5925 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5926 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5927 this time.
5928 .endlist
5929
5930 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5931 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5932 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5933 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5934
5935 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5936 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5937 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5938 .code
5939 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5940 .endd
5941 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5942 transport.
5943 .code
5944 localuser:
5945 driver = accept
5946 check_local_user
5947 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5948 # local_part_suffix_optional
5949 transport = local_delivery
5950 .endd
5951 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5952 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5953 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5954 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5955 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5956
5957
5958 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5959 .cindex "default" "transports"
5960 .cindex "transports" "default"
5961 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5962 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5963 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5964 .code
5965 begin transports
5966 .endd
5967 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5968 .code
5969 remote_smtp:
5970 driver = smtp
5971 .endd
5972 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5973 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5974 .code
5975 local_delivery:
5976 driver = appendfile
5977 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5978 delivery_date_add
5979 envelope_to_add
5980 return_path_add
5981 # group = mail
5982 # mode = 0660
5983 .endd
5984 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5985 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5986 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5987 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5988 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5989 show how this can be done.
5990
5991 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5992 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5993 similarly-named options above.
5994 .code
5995 address_pipe:
5996 driver = pipe
5997 return_output
5998 .endd
5999 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6000 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6001 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6002 sender.
6003 .code
6004 address_file:
6005 driver = appendfile
6006 delivery_date_add
6007 envelope_to_add
6008 return_path_add
6009 .endd
6010 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6011 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6012 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6013 .code
6014 address_reply:
6015 driver = autoreply
6016 .endd
6017 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6018 filter files.
6019
6020
6021
6022 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6023 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6024 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6025 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6026 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6027 introduced by the line
6028 .code
6029 begin retry
6030 .endd
6031 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6032 errors:
6033 .code
6034 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6035 .endd
6036 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6037 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6038 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6039 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6040
6041 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6042 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6043 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6044
6045
6046 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6047 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6048 .code
6049 begin rewrite
6050 .endd
6051 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6052 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6053
6054
6055
6056 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6057 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6058 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6059 .code
6060 begin authenticators
6061 .endd
6062 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6063 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6064 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6065 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6066 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6067 to support most MUA software.
6068
6069 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6070 .code
6071 #PLAIN:
6072 # driver = plaintext
6073 # server_set_id = $auth2
6074 # server_prompts = :
6075 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6076 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6077 .endd
6078 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6079 .code
6080 #LOGIN:
6081 # driver = plaintext
6082 # server_set_id = $auth1
6083 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6084 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6085 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6086 .endd
6087
6088 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6089 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6090 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6091 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6092 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6093 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6094 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6095 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6096
6097 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6098 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6099 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6100 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6101
6102 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6103 usercode and password are in different positions.
6104 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6105
6106 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6107
6108
6109
6110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6112
6113 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6114
6115 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6116 .cindex "PCRE"
6117 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6118 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6119 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6120 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6121 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6122 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6123
6124 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6125 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6126 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6127 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6128 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6129 case-insensitive.
6130
6131 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6132 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6133 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6134 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6135 .code
6136 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6137 .endd
6138 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6139 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6140 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6141 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6142 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6143 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6144 matched.
6145
6146 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6147 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6148 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6149 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6150 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6151 match anywhere in the subject string.
6152
6153 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6154 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6155 .code
6156 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6157 .endd
6158 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6159 You need to use:
6160 .code
6161 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6162 .endd
6163 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6164 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6165
6166
6167
6168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6170
6171 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6172 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6173 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6174 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6175 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6176 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6177
6178 .olist
6179 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6180 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6181 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6182 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6183 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6184 .next
6185 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6186 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6187 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6188 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6189 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6190 .endlist
6191
6192 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6193 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6194 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6195 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6196 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6197 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6198
6199 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6200 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6201 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6202 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6203 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6204 .code
6205 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6206 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6207 .endd
6208 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6209 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6210 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6211 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6212 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6213 .code
6214 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6215 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6216 .endd
6217 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6218 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6219
6220 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6221 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6222 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6223 .code
6224 domain1:
6225 domain2:
6226 .endd
6227 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6228 matches the list item.
6229
6230 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6231 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6232 .code
6233 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6234 .endd
6235 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6236 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6237 causes a second lookup to occur.
6238
6239 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6240 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6241 lookup is permitted.
6242
6243
6244 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6245 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6246 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6247 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6248
6249 .ilist
6250 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6251 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6252 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6253 .next
6254 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6255 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6256 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6257 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6258 .endlist
6259
6260 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6261 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6262 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6263 .code
6264 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6265 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6266 .endd
6267 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6268 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6269 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6270
6271
6272
6273
6274 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6275 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6276 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6277 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6278
6279 .ilist
6280 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6281 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6282 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6283 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6284 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6285 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6286 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6287 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6288 be found in several places:
6289 .display
6290 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6291 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6292 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6293 .endd
6294 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6295 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6296 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6297 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6298 .next
6299 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6300 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6301 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6302 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6303 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6304 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6305 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6306
6307 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6308 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6309 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6310 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6311 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6312 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6313 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6314 .next
6315 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6316 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6317 .cindex "sasldb2"
6318 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6319 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6320 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6321 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6322 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6323 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6324 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6325 .next
6326 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6327 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6328 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6329 .cindex "Courier"
6330 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6331 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6332 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6333 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6334 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6335 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6336 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6337 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6338 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6339 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6340 .next
6341 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6342 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6343 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6344 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6345 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6346 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6347 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6348 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6349 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6350 .next
6351 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6352 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6353 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6354 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6355 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6356 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6357 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6358 .code
6359 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6360 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6361 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6362 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6363 .endd
6364 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6365 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6366 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6367 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6368 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6369
6370 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6371 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6372 lookup types support only literal keys.
6373
6374 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6375 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6376 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6377 .next
6378 .cindex "linear search"
6379 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6380 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6381 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6382 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6383 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6384 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6385 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6386 in the file is used.
6387
6388 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6389 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6390 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6391 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6392 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6393 colon, for example:
6394 .code
6395 baduser: :fail:
6396 .endd
6397 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6398 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6399 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6400 wildcarding of any kind.
6401
6402 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6403 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6404 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6405 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6406 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6407 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6408 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6409 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6410 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6411
6412 .next
6413 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6414 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6415 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6416 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6417 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6418 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6419 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6420 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6421
6422 .next
6423 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6424 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6425 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6426 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6427 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6428 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6429 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6430 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6431 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6432
6433 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6434 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6435 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6436 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6437
6438 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6439 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6440
6441 .olist
6442 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6443 .code
6444 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6445 *fish data for anythingfish
6446 .endd
6447 .next
6448 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6449 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6450 .code
6451 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6452 .endd
6453 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6454 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6455 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6456 .code
6457 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6458 .endd
6459 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6460 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6461 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6462 .code
6463 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6464 .endd
6465
6466 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6467 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6468 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6469 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6470 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6471
6472 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6473 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6474 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6475 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6476 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6477
6478 .next
6479 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6480 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6481 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6482 example:
6483 .code
6484 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6485 .endd
6486 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6487 .endlist olist
6488
6489 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6490 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6491 be followed by optional colons.
6492
6493 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6494 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6495 lookup types support only literal keys.
6496 .endlist ilist
6497
6498
6499 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6500 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6501 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6502 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6503 many of them are given in later sections.
6504
6505 .ilist
6506 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6507 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6508 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6509 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6510 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6511 .next
6512 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6513 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6514 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6515 .next
6516 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6517 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6518 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6519 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6520 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6521 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6522 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6523 .next
6524 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6526 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6527 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6528 .next
6529 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6530 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6531 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6532 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6533 .next
6534 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6535 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6536 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6537 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6538 .next
6539 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6540 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6541 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6542 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6543 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6544 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6545 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6546 password value. For example:
6547 .code
6548 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6549 .endd
6550 .next
6551 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6552 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6553 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6554 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6555
6556 .next
6557 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6558 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6559 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6560 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6561
6562 .next
6563 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6564 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6565 .next
6566 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6567 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6568 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6569 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6570 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6571 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6572 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6573 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6574 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6575 .code
6576 require condition = \
6577 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6578 .endd
6579 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6580 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6581 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6582 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6583 .endlist
6584
6585
6586
6587 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6588 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6589 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6590 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6591 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6592 options such as a list of local domains.
6593
6594 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6595 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6596 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6597 or may give up altogether.
6598
6599
6600
6601 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6602 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6603 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6604 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6605 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6606 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6607 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6608 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6609
6610 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6611 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6612 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6613
6614 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6615 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6616 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6617
6618 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6619 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6620 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6621 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6622 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6623 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6624 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6625 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6626 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6627 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6628 .code
6629 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6630 .endd
6631 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6632 looks up these keys, in this order:
6633 .code
6634 jane@eyre.example
6635 *@eyre.example
6636 *
6637 .endd
6638 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6639 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6640 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6641 Exim move on to try the next key.
6642
6643
6644
6645 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6646 .cindex "partial matching"
6647 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6648 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6649 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6650 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6651 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6652 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6653 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6654 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6655 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6656 a key in a DBM file is
6657 .code
6658 *.dates.fict.example
6659 .endd
6660 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6661 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6662 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6663 file.
6664
6665 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6666 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6667 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6668
6669 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6670 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6671 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6672 partial matching keys
6673 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6674 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6675 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6676
6677 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6678 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6679 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6680 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6681 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6682 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6683 remains.
6684
6685 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6686 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6687 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6688 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6689 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6690 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6691 .code
6692 2250.dates.fict.example
6693 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6694 *.dates.fict.example
6695 *.fict.example
6696 .endd
6697 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6698 finishes.
6699
6700 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6701 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6702 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6703 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6704 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6705 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6706 .code
6707 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6708 .endd
6709 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6710 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6711 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6712 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6713 .code
6714 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6715 .endd
6716 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6717 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6718
6719 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6720 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6721 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6722
6723 .ilist
6724 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6725 .next
6726 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6727 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6728 .next
6729 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6730 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6731 for &"*"& on its own.
6732 .next
6733 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6734 .endlist
6735
6736
6737 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6738 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6739 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6740 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6741 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6742 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6743 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6744
6745 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6746 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6747 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6748 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6749 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6750
6751
6752
6753
6754 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6755 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6756 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6757 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6758 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6759 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6760 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6761
6762 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6763 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6764 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6765 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6766 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6767 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6768
6769 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6770 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6771 complete.
6772
6773
6774
6775
6776 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6777 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6778 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6779 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6780 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6781 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6782 .code
6783 [name=$local_part]
6784 .endd
6785 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6786 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6787 .code
6788 [name="$local_part"]
6789 .endd
6790 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6791 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6792 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6793 of the following form is provided:
6794 .code
6795 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6796 .endd
6797 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6798 .code
6799 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6800 .endd
6801 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6802 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6803 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6804
6805
6806
6807
6808 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6809 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6810 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6811 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6812 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6813 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6814 an expansion string could contain:
6815 .code
6816 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6817 .endd
6818 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6819 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6820 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6821 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6822
6823 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6824 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6825 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6826 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6827 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6828 .code
6829 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6830 .endd
6831 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6832 altered and nothing is added.
6833
6834 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6835 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6836 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6837 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6838 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6839
6840 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6841 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6842 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6843 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6844 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6845 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6846 .code
6847 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6848 .endd
6849 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6850 white space is ignored.
6851
6852 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6853 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6854 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6855 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6856 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6857 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6858 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6859 .code
6860 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6861 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6862 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6863 .endd
6864 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6865 white space is ignored.
6866
6867 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6868 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6869 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6870 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6871 the pseudo-type MXH:
6872 .code
6873 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6874 .endd
6875 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6876 returned.
6877
6878 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6879 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6880 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6881 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6882 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6883 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6884 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6885 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6886 .code
6887 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6888 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6889 .endd
6890 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6891 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6892 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6893
6894 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6895 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6896 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6897 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6898 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6899 such a list.
6900
6901 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6902 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6903 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6904 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6905 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6906 result of a successful lookup such as:
6907 .code
6908 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6909 .endd
6910 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6911 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6912 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6913
6914
6915 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6916 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6917 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6918 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6919 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6920 .code
6921 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6922 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6923 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6924 .endd
6925 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6926 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6927 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6928 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6929
6930 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6931 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6932 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6933
6934 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6935 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6936 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6937 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6938 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6939 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6940 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6941 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6942 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6943 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6944 .code
6945 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6946 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6947 .endd
6948 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6949 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6950
6951
6952
6953
6954 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6955 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6956 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6957 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6958 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6959 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6960 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6961 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6962 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6963 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6964 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6965 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6966 .code
6967 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6968 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6969 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6970 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6971 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6972 .endd
6973 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6974 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6975
6976 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6977 the way they handle the results of a query:
6978
6979 .ilist
6980 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6981 gives an error.
6982 .next
6983 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6984 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6985 .next
6986 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6987 from all of them are returned.
6988 .endlist
6989
6990
6991 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6992 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6993 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6994 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6995
6996
6997 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6998 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6999 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7000 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7001 .code
7002 data = ${lookup ldap \
7003 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7004 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7005 .endd
7006 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7007 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7008 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7009 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7010
7011 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7012 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7013 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7014
7015
7016 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7017 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7018 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7019 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7020 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7021 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7022
7023 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7024 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7025 the string:
7026 .code
7027 * => \2A
7028 ( => \28
7029 ) => \29
7030 \ => \5C
7031 .endd
7032 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7033 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7034 .code
7035 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7036 .endd
7037 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7038 .code
7039 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7040 .endd
7041 yields
7042 .code
7043 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7044 .endd
7045 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7046 .code
7047 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7048 .endd
7049 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7050 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7051 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7052 .code
7053 , + " \ < > ;
7054 .endd
7055 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7056 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7057 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7058 .code
7059 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7060 .endd
7061 yields
7062 .code
7063 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7064 .endd
7065 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7066 .code
7067 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7068 .endd
7069 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7070 authentication below.
7071
7072
7073 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7074 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7075 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7076 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7077 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7078 by starting it with
7079 .code
7080 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7081 .endd
7082 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7083 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7084 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7085 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7086 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7087 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7088 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7089 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7090 failures, and timeouts.
7091
7092 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7093 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7094 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7095 doubled. For example
7096 .code
7097 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7098 .endd
7099 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7100 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7101 the local host) is used.
7102
7103 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7104 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7105 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7106 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7107 not available.
7108
7109 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7110 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7111 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7112 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7113 .code
7114 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7115 .endd
7116 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7117 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7118 .code
7119 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7120 .endd
7121 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7122 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7123 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7124 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7125 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7126 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7127 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7128 backup host.
7129
7130 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7131 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7132 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7133
7134 .ilist
7135 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7136 interface.
7137 .next
7138 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7139 .endlist
7140
7141
7142 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7143 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7144
7145
7146
7147 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7148 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7149 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7150 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7151 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7152 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7153 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7154 them. The following names are recognized:
7155 .display
7156 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7157 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7158 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7159 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7160 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7161 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7162 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7163 .endd
7164 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7165 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7166 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7167 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7168
7169 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7170 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7171 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7172 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7173 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7174 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7175 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7176 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7177 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7178
7179 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7180 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7181
7182
7183 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7184 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7185 .code
7186 ${lookup ldap
7187 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7188 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7189 {$value}fail}
7190 .endd
7191 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7192 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7193 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7194 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7195
7196 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7197 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7198 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7199
7200 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7201 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7202 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7203 quoting has two advantages:
7204
7205 .ilist
7206 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7207 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7208 .next
7209 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7210 .endlist
7211
7212 For example, a setting such as
7213 .code
7214 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7215 .endd
7216 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7217
7218 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7219 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7220 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7221 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7222 .code
7223 PASS=${quote:$3}
7224 .endd
7225 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7226 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7227 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7228
7229
7230
7231 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7232 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7233 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7234 as a sequence of values, for example
7235 .code
7236 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7237 .endd
7238 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7239 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7240 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7241 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7242 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7243 directory.
7244
7245 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7246 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7247 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7248
7249 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7250 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7251 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7252 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7253 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7254 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7255 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7256
7257 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7258 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7259 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7260 .code
7261 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7262 value1.1, value1.2
7263
7264 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7265 value two
7266
7267 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7268 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7269
7270 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7271 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7272 .endd
7273 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7274 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7275 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7276 results of LDAP lookups.
7277
7278
7279
7280
7281 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7282 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7283 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7284 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7285 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7286 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7287 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7288 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7289 .code
7290 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7291 .endd
7292 might return the string
7293 .code
7294 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7295 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7296 .endd
7297 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7298 .code
7299 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7300 .endd
7301 would just return
7302 .code
7303 Martin Guerre
7304 .endd
7305 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7306 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7307 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7308
7309
7310
7311 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7312 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7313 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7314 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7315 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7316 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7317 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7318 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7319 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7320 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7321 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7322 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7323 might be
7324 .code
7325 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7326 {$value}fail}
7327 .endd
7328 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7329 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7330 .code
7331 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7332 {$value}}
7333 .endd
7334 might be
7335 .code
7336 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7337 .endd
7338 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7339 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7340 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7341 .code
7342 Mister X
7343 .endd
7344 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7345 with a newline between the data for each row.
7346
7347
7348 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7349 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7350 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7351 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7352 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7353 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7354 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7355 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7356 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7357 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7358 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7359 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7360 information.
7361 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7362 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7363 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7364 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7365 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7366 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7367 .code
7368 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7369 .endd
7370 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7371 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7372 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7373 .code
7374 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7375 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7376 .endd
7377 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7378 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7379 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7380 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7381 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7382 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7383
7384 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7385 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7386 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7387 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7388 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7389 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7390 characters are not special.
7391
7392 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7393 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7394 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7395 done by starting the query with
7396 .display
7397 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7398 .endd
7399 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7400 .olist
7401 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7402 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7403 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7404 taken from there.
7405 .next
7406 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7407 .endlist
7408 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7409 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7410 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7411
7412 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7413 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7414 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7415 like this:
7416 .code
7417 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7418 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7419 master/db/name/pw
7420 .endd
7421 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7422 .code
7423 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7424 .endd
7425 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7426 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7427 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7428 .code
7429 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7430 .endd
7431
7432
7433 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7434 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7435 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7436 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7437 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7438 .display
7439 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7440 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7441 .endd
7442 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7443 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7444
7445 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7446 the queries.
7447
7448 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7449 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7450
7451 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7452 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7453 is zero because no rows are affected.
7454
7455
7456 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7457 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7458 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7459 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7460 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7461 looks like this:
7462 .code
7463 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7464 .endd
7465 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7466 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7467 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7468
7469 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7470 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7471 affected.
7472
7473 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7475 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7476 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7477 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7478 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7479 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7480 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7481 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7482 .code
7483 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7484 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7485 .endd
7486 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7487 .code
7488 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7489 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7490 .endd
7491 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7492 quote, which it doubles.
7493
7494 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7495 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7496 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7497 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7498 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7499 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7500 option.
7501 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7502 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7503
7504
7505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7507
7508 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7509 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7510 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7511 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7512 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7513 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7514 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7515 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7516 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7517
7518 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7519 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7520 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7521 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7522
7523
7524
7525 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7526 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7527 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7528 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7529 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7530 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7531 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7532 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7533
7534
7535 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7536 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7537 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7538
7539 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7540 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7541 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7542 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7543 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7544 .code
7545 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7546 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7547 .endd
7548 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7549 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7550 senders based on the receiving domain.
7551
7552
7553
7554
7555 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7556 .cindex "list" "negation"
7557 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7558 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7559 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7560 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7561 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7562 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7563
7564 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7565 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7566 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7567 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7568 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7569 .code
7570 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7571 .endd
7572 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7573 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7574 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7575 .code
7576 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7577 .endd
7578 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7579 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7580 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7581
7582 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7583 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7584 item.
7585
7586
7587
7588 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7589 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7590 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7591 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7592 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7593 file names are not allowed,
7594 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7595 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7596 lines:
7597
7598 .ilist
7599 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7600 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7601 .next
7602 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7603 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7604 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7605 .code
7606 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7607 .endd
7608 .endlist
7609
7610 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7611 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7612 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7613 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7614
7615 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7616 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7617 .code
7618 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7619 .endd
7620 and the file contains the lines
7621 .code
7622 !a.b.c
7623 *.b.c
7624 .endd
7625 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7626 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7627
7628
7629
7630 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7631 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7632 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7633 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7634 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7635 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7636 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7637 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7638
7639 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7640 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7641 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7642 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7643
7644
7645
7646
7647 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7648 .cindex "named lists"
7649 .cindex "list" "named"
7650 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7651 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7652 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7653 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7654 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7655 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7656 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7657 .code
7658 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7659 .endd
7660 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7661 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7662 configured with the line
7663 .code
7664 domains = +local_domains
7665 .endd
7666 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7667 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7668 .code
7669 dnslookup:
7670 driver = dnslookup
7671 domains = ! +local_domains
7672 transport = remote_smtp
7673 no_more
7674 .endd
7675 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7676 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7677 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7678 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7679 .code
7680 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7681 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7682 .endd
7683 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7684 .code
7685 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7686 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7687 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7688 .endd
7689 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7690 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7691 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7692 .code
7693 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7694 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7695 .endd
7696 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7697 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7698 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7699 .code
7700 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7701 .endd
7702 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7703 referenced lists if you can.
7704
7705 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7706 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7707 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7708 .code
7709 domains = +local_domains
7710 .endd
7711 on several of your routers
7712 or in several ACL statements,
7713 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7714 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7715 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7716 the same each time they are referenced.
7717
7718 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7719 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7720 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7721 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7722
7723
7724
7725 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7726 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7727 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7728 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7729 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7730 write
7731 .code
7732 ALIST = host1 : host2
7733 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7734 .endd
7735 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7736 .code
7737 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7738 .endd
7739 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7740 list, and write
7741 .code
7742 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7743 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7744 .endd
7745 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7746 .code
7747 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7748 .endd
7749
7750
7751 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7752 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7753 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7754 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7755 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7756 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7757 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7758 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7759 message. For example:
7760 .code
7761 domainlist special_domains = \
7762 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7763 .endd
7764 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7765 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7766 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7767 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7768 same list each time.
7769
7770 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7771 cache the result anyway. For example:
7772 .code
7773 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7774 .endd
7775 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7776 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7777
7778
7779
7780 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7781 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7782 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7783 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7784 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7785
7786 .ilist
7787 .cindex "primary host name"
7788 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7789 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7790 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7791 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7792 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7793 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7794 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7795 differ only in their names.
7796 .next
7797 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7798 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7799 .cindex "domain literal"
7800 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7801 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7802 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7803 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7804 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7805 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7806 .next
7807 .cindex "@mx_any"
7808 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7809 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7810 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7811 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7812 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7813 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7814 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7815 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7816 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7817 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7818 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7819
7820 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7821 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7822 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7823 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7824 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7825
7826 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7827 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7828 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7829 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7830 on a router). For example:
7831 .code
7832 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7833 .endd
7834 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7835 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7836
7837 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7838 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7839 contain negative items.
7840
7841 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7842 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7843 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7844 .code
7845 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7846 an.other.domain : ...
7847 .endd
7848 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7849 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7850 .code
7851 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7852 an.other.domain ? ...
7853 .endd
7854 .next
7855 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7856 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7857 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7858 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7859 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7860 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7861 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7862 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7863 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7864 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7865
7866 .next
7867 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7868 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7869 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7870 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7871 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7872 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7873 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7874 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7875 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7876
7877 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7878 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7879 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7880 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7881 expression by expansion, of course).
7882 .next
7883 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7884 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7885 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7886 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7887 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7888 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7889 .code
7890 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7891 .endd
7892 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7893 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7894 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7895 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7896 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7897 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7898 other statements in the same ACL.
7899
7900 .next
7901 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7902 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7903 .code
7904 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7905 .endd
7906 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7907 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7908
7909 .next
7910 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7911 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7912 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7913 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7914 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7915 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7916 expansion variable.
7917 .next
7918 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7919 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7920 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7921 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7922 .code
7923 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7924 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7925 .endd
7926 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7927 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7928 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7929 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7930 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7931 .next
7932 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7933 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7934 between the pattern and the domain.
7935 .endlist
7936
7937 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7938 .code
7939 domainlist funny_domains = \
7940 @ : \
7941 lib.unseen.edu : \
7942 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7943 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7944 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7945 nis;domains.byname : \
7946 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7947 .endd
7948 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7949 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7950 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7951 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7952 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7953 patterns earlier.
7954
7955
7956
7957 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7958 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7959 .cindex "list" "host list"
7960 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7961 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7962 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7963 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7964 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7965 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7966 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7967
7968
7969 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7970 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7971 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7972 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7973 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7974 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7975 not used.
7976
7977 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7978 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7979 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7980
7981
7982
7983 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7984 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7985 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7986 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7987 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7988 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7989 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7990 concerns.)
7991
7992 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7993 inspecting its IP address:
7994
7995 .ilist
7996 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7997 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7998 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7999 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8000 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8001 with the IP address of the subject host.
8002
8003 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8004 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8005 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8006 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8007 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8008
8009 .next
8010 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8011 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8012 domain name, as just described.
8013
8014 .next
8015 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8016 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8017 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8018 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8019 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8020 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8021 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8022 that can never match a client host.
8023
8024 .next
8025 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8026 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8027 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8028 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8029 .code
8030 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8031 accept hosts = @[]
8032 .endd
8033 .next
8034 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8035 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8036 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8037 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8038 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8039 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8040 significant end of the address.
8041
8042 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8043 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8044 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8045 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8046 .code
8047 192.168.23.236/31
8048 .endd
8049 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8050 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8051 matches.
8052
8053 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8054 .code
8055 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8056 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8057 .endd
8058 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8059 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8060 For example:
8061 .code
8062 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8063 .endd
8064 could make use of a file containing
8065 .code
8066 172.16.0.0/12
8067 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8068 .endd
8069 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8070 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8071 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8072 .code
8073 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8074 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8075 .endd
8076 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8077 list.
8078 .endlist
8079
8080
8081
8082 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8083 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8084 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8085 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8086 address, the pattern takes this form:
8087 .display
8088 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8089 .endd
8090 For example:
8091 .code
8092 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8093 .endd
8094 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8095 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8096 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8097 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8098 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8099 returned by the lookup is not used.
8100
8101 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8102 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8103 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8104 patterns of this form:
8105 .display
8106 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8107 .endd
8108 For example:
8109 .code
8110 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8111 .endd
8112 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8113 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8114 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8115 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8116 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8117
8118 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8119 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8120 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8121 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8122 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8123 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8124 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8125 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8126 addresses are always used.
8127
8128 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8129 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8130 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8131 configurations.
8132
8133 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8134 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8135 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8136 case the IP address is used on its own.
8137
8138
8139
8140 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8141 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8142 .cindex "unknown host name"
8143 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8144 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8145 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8146 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8147 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8148 above.)
8149
8150 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8151 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8152 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8153 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8154 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8155 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8156 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8157
8158 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8159 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8160
8161 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8162 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8163 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8164 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8165 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8166 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8167 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8168 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8169 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8170
8171 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8172 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8173
8174 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8175 .cindex "alias for host"
8176 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8177 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8178
8179 .ilist
8180 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8181 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8182 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8183 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8184 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8185 expression.
8186 .next
8187 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8188 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8189 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8190 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8191 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8192 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8193 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8194 example,
8195 .code
8196 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8197 .endd
8198 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8199 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8200 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8201 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8202 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8203 .code
8204 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8205 .endd
8206 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8207 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8208 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8209 required.
8210 .endlist
8211
8212
8213
8214
8215 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8216 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8217 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8218 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8219 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8220 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8221
8222 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8223 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8224
8225 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8226 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8227 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8228 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8229 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8230 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8231
8232 .ilist
8233 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8234 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8235 .code
8236 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8237 .endd
8238 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8239 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8240
8241 .next
8242 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8243 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8244 example:
8245 .code
8246 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8247 192.168.4.5
8248 .endd
8249 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8250 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8251 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8252 .endlist
8253
8254 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8255 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8256 list.
8257
8258
8259 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8260 "SECTtemdnserr"
8261 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8262 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8263 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8264 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8265 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8266 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8267 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8268 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8269 host lists such as whitelists.
8270
8271
8272
8273 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8274 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8275 .cindex "unknown host name"
8276 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8277 If a pattern is of the form
8278 .display
8279 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8280 .endd
8281 for example
8282 .code
8283 dbm;/host/accept/list
8284 .endd
8285 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8286 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8287 is not used.
8288
8289 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8290 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8291 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8292 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8293 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8294 lookup, both using the same file.
8295
8296
8297
8298 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8299 If a pattern is of the form
8300 .display
8301 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8302 .endd
8303 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8304 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8305 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8306 .code
8307 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8308 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8309 .endd
8310 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8311 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8312 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8313 operator.
8314
8315 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8316 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8317 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8318
8319 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8320 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8321 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8322 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8323 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8324 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8325
8326
8327
8328 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8329 "SECTmixwilhos"
8330 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8331 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8332 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8333 ACL you could have:
8334 .code
8335 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8336 .endd
8337 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8338 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8339 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8340 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8341 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8342 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8343
8344 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8345 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8346 .code
8347 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8348 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8349 .endd
8350 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8351 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8352
8353
8354
8355
8356
8357 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8358 .cindex "list" "address list"
8359 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8360 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8361 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8362 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8363 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8364 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8365 using this option setting:
8366 .code
8367 senders = :
8368 .endd
8369 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8370 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8371 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8372 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8373
8374 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8375 example:
8376 .code
8377 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8378 .endd
8379 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8380 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8381 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8382 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8383 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8384 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8385 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8386 .code
8387 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8388 *@+hostile_domains:\
8389 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8390 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8391 .endd
8392 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8393 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8394 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8395 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8396 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8397
8398 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8399 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8400 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8401 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8402 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8403 .code
8404 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8405 .endd
8406
8407 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8408 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8409 senders:
8410
8411 .ilist
8412 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8413 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8414 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8415 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8416 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8417 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8418 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8419 .code
8420 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8421 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8422 .endd
8423 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8424 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8425
8426 .next
8427 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8428 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8429 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8430 example:
8431 .code
8432 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8433 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8434 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8435 .endd
8436 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8437 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8438 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8439 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8440
8441 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8442 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8443 panic log.
8444 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8445 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8446 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8447 default. For example, with this lookup:
8448 .code
8449 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8450 .endd
8451 the file could contains lines like this:
8452 .code
8453 user1@domain1.example
8454 *@domain2.example
8455 .endd
8456 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8457 that are tried is:
8458 .code
8459 nimrod@jaeger.example
8460 *@jaeger.example
8461 *
8462 .endd
8463 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8464 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8465
8466 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8467 .code
8468 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8469 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8470 .endd
8471 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8472 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8473 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8474 .endlist
8475
8476
8477 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8478 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8479 always fails.
8480
8481
8482 .ilist
8483 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8484 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8485 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8486 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8487 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8488 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8489 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8490 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8491 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8492
8493 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8494 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8495 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8496 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8497 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8498 with
8499 .code
8500 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8501 .endd
8502 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8503 .code
8504 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8505 .endd
8506 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8507
8508 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8509 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8510 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8511 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8512 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8513 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8514 .code
8515 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8516 spammer3 : spammer4
8517 .endd
8518 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8519 doubling.
8520
8521 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8522 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8523 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8524 might have entries like
8525 .code
8526 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8527 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8528 *: ^\d{8}$
8529 .endd
8530 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8531 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8532 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8533 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8534
8535 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8536 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8537 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8538
8539 .next
8540 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8541 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8542 can only return a single list of local parts.
8543 .endlist
8544
8545 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8546 in these two examples:
8547 .code
8548 senders = +my_list
8549 senders = *@+my_list
8550 .endd
8551 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8552 example it is a named domain list.
8553
8554
8555
8556
8557 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8558 .cindex "case of local parts"
8559 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8560 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8561 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8562 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8563 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8564 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8565 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8566 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8567 default.
8568
8569 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8570 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8571 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8572 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8573 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8574 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8575 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8576 case-independent.
8577
8578 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8579 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8580 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8581 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8582 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8583 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8584 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8585 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8586
8587
8588
8589 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8590 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8591 .cindex "local part" "list"
8592 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8593 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8594 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8595 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8596 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8597 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8598 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8599 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8600
8601 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8602 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8603 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8604 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8605 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8606 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8607 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8608 types.
8609 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8610
8611
8612
8613
8614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8616
8617 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8618 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8619 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8620 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8621
8622 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8623 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8624 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8625 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8626 escape character, as described in the following section.
8627
8628 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8629 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8630 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8631 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8632 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8633 reasons.
8634
8635
8636
8637 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8638 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8639 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8640 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8641 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8642 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8643 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8644 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8645
8646 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8647 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8648 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8649 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8650 .code
8651 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8652 .endd
8653 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8654 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8655 string.
8656
8657
8658
8659 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8660 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8661 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8662 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8663 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8664 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8665 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8666 encoding.
8667
8668 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8669 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8670 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8671
8672
8673 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8674 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8675 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8676 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8677 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8678 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8679 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8680 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8681 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8682 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8683 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8684 and &%nhash%&.
8685
8686 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8687 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8688 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8689
8690 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8691 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8692 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8693 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8694 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8695 .code
8696 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8697 .endd
8698 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8699 Exim message identifier. For example:
8700 .code
8701 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8702 .endd
8703 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8704 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8705
8706
8707 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8708 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8709 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8710 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8711 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8712 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8713 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8714 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8715 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8716 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8717 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8718 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8719 being expanded.
8720
8721
8722
8723
8724 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8725 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8726 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8727 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8728 white space is significant.
8729
8730 .vlist
8731 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8732 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8733 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8734 .code
8735 $local_part
8736 ${domain}
8737 .endd
8738 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8739 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8740 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8741 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8742 given, the expansion fails.
8743
8744 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8745 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8746 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8747 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8748 .code
8749 ${lc:$local_part}
8750 .endd
8751 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8752 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8753 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8754 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8755 string easier to understand.
8756
8757 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8758 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8759 expansion item below.
8760
8761 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8762 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8763 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8764 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8765 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8766 .code
8767 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8768 .endd
8769 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8770 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8771 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8772
8773 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8774 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8775 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8776 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8777 must have the following type:
8778 .code
8779 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8780 .endd
8781 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8782 function should return one of the following values:
8783
8784 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8785 into the expanded string that is being built.
8786
8787 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8788 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8789
8790 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8791 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8792
8793 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8794
8795 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8796 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8797 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8798
8799 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8800 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8801 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8802 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8803 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8804 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8805 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8806 form:
8807 .display
8808 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8809 .endd
8810 .vindex "&$value$&"
8811 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8812 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8813 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8814 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8815 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8816 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8817 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8818 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8819 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8820
8821 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8822 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8823 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8824 yield &"2001"&:
8825 .code
8826 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8827 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8828 .endd
8829 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8830 appear, for example:
8831 .code
8832 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8833 .endd
8834 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8835 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8836
8837
8838 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8839 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8840 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8841 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8842 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8843 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8844 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8845 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8846 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8847 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8848 <&'string3'&> as before.
8849
8850 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8851 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8852 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8853 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8854 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8855 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8856 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8857 provided. For example:
8858 .code
8859 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8860 .endd
8861 yields &"42"&, and
8862 .code
8863 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8864 .endd
8865 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8866 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8867
8868
8869 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8870 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8871 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8872 .vindex "&$item$&"
8873 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8874 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8875 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8876 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8877 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8878 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8879 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8880 .code
8881 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8882 .endd
8883 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8884 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8885
8886
8887 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8888 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8889 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8890 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8891 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8892 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8893
8894 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8895 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8896 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8897 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8898 .code
8899 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8900 .endd
8901 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8902 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8903 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8904 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8905 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8906 .code
8907 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8908 .endd
8909 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8910 letters appear. For example:
8911 .display
8912 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8913 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8914 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8915 .endd
8916
8917 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8918 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8919 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8920 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8921 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8922 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8923 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8924 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8925 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8926 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8927 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8928 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8929 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8930 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8931 .code
8932 $header_reply-to:
8933 .endd
8934 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8935 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8936 lines) may be present.
8937
8938 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8939 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8940
8941 .ilist
8942 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8943 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8944 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8945
8946 .next
8947 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8948 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8949 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8950 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8951 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8952 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8953 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8954 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8955
8956 .next
8957 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8958 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8959 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8960 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8961 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8962 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8963 .endlist ilist
8964
8965 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8966 command of the following form:
8967 .code
8968 headers charset "UTF-8"
8969 .endd
8970 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8971 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8972 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8973 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8974 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8975 ISO-8859-1.
8976
8977 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8978 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8979 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8980 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8981
8982 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8983 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8984 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8985 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8986 router or transport are not accessible.
8987
8988 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8989 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8990 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8991 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8992 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8993 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8994
8995 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8996 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8997 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8998 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8999 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9000 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9001 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9002
9003 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9004 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9005 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9006 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9007 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9008 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9009 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9010 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9011
9012
9013 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9014 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9015 .cindex &%hmac%&
9016 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9017 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9018 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9019 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9020 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9021 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9022 present. For example:
9023 .code
9024 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9025 .endd
9026 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9027 produces:
9028 .code
9029 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9030 .endd
9031 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9032 an Exim configuration:
9033 .code
9034 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9035 .endd
9036 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9037 .code
9038 headers_add = \
9039 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9040 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9041 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9042 .endd
9043 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9044 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9045 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9046 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9047 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9048 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9049
9050
9051 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9052 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9053 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9054 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9055 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9056 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9057 .code
9058 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9059 .endd
9060 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9061 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9062 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9063 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9064 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9065
9066 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9067 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9068 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9069 .code
9070 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9071 .endd
9072 you can use
9073 .code
9074 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9075 .endd
9076
9077 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9078 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9079 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9080 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9081 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9082 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9083 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9084 some of the braces:
9085 .code
9086 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9087 .endd
9088 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9089 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9090 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9091
9092
9093 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9094 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9095 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9096 described in the next item.
9097
9098 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9099 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9100 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9101 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9102 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9103 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9104 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9105 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9106 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9107
9108 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9109 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9110 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9111 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9112 out by the system administrator.
9113
9114 .vindex "&$value$&"
9115 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9116 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9117 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9118 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9119 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9120 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9121 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9122 original lookup fails.
9123
9124 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9125 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9126 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9127 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9128 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9129 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9130 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9131 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9132
9133 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9134 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9135 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9136 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9137
9138 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9139 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9140 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9141 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9142
9143 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9144 .code
9145 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9146 .endd
9147 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9148 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9149 .code
9150 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9151 {$value}fail}
9152 .endd
9153
9154
9155 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9156 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9157 .vindex "&$item$&"
9158 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9159 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9160 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9161 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9162 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9163 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9164 .code
9165 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9166 .endd
9167 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9168 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9169 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9170
9171 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9172 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9173 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9174 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9175 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9176 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9177 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9178 .code
9179 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9180 .endd
9181 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9182 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9183 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9184 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9185 example,
9186 .code
9187 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9188 .endd
9189 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9190
9191
9192
9193 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9194 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9195 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9196 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9197 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9198 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9199 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9200 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9201
9202 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9203 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9204 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9205 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9206 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9207 not its contents.
9208
9209 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9210 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9211 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9212
9213 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9214 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9215
9216
9217 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9218 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9219 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9220 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9221 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9222 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9223 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9224 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9225
9226 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9227 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9228 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9229 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9230 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9231 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9232 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9233 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9234 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9235 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9236
9237 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9238 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9239 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9240 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9241
9242 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9243 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9244 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9245 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9246 is the expansion of the third argument.
9247
9248 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9249 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9250 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9251
9252 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9253 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9254 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9255 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9256 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9257 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9258 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9259 newlines are left in the string.
9260 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9261 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9262 the string expansion fails.
9263
9264 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9265 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9266
9267
9268
9269 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9270 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9271 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9272 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9273 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9274 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9275 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9276 examples:
9277 .code
9278 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9279 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9280 .endd
9281 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9282 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9283 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9284 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9285 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9286 example:
9287 .code
9288 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9289 .endd
9290 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9291 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9292 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9293 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9294 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9295 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9296 .code
9297 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9298 .endd
9299 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9300 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9301 turns them into spaces:
9302 .code
9303 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9304 .endd
9305 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9306 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9307 addition, the following errors can occur:
9308
9309 .ilist
9310 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9311 .next
9312 Failure to connect the socket;
9313 .next
9314 Failure to write the request string;
9315 .next
9316 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9317 .endlist
9318
9319 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9320 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9321 errors occurs. For example:
9322 .code
9323 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9324 {socket failure}}
9325 .endd
9326 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9327 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9328 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9329 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9330 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9331
9332 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9333 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9334
9335
9336 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9337 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9338 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9339 .vindex "&$value$&"
9340 .vindex "&$item$&"
9341 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9342 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9343 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9344 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9345 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9346 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9347 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9348 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9349 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9350 .code
9351 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9352 .endd
9353 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9354 can be found:
9355 .code
9356 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9357 .endd
9358 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9359 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9360 expansion items.
9361
9362 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9363 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9364 expansion item above.
9365
9366 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9367 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9368 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9369 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9370 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9371 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9372 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9373 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9374
9375 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9376 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9377 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9378 .vindex "&$value$&"
9379 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9380 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9381 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9382 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9383 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9384 &$value$&.
9385
9386 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9387 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9388 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9389 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9390
9391 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9392 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9393 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9394 .code
9395 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9396 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9397 ...
9398 endif
9399 .endd
9400 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9401 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9402 commands.
9403
9404 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9405 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9406 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9407 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9408
9409 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9410 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9411
9412
9413 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9414 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9415 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9416 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9417 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9418 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9419 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9420 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9421 .code
9422 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9423 .endd
9424 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9425 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9426 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9427 .code
9428 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9429 .endd
9430 yields &"defabc"&, and
9431 .code
9432 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9433 .endd
9434 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9435 the regular expression from string expansion.
9436
9437
9438
9439 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9440 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9441 .cindex "substring extraction"
9442 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9443 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9444 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9445 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9446 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9447 .code
9448 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9449 .endd
9450 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9451 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9452 omitted.
9453
9454 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9455 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9456 length required. For example
9457 .code
9458 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9459 .endd
9460 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9461 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9462 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9463 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9464
9465 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9466 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9467 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9468 .code
9469 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9470 .endd
9471 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9472 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9473 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9474 .code
9475 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9476 .endd
9477 yields an empty string, but
9478 .code
9479 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9480 .endd
9481 yields &"1"&.
9482
9483 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9484 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9485 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9486 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9487 .code
9488 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9489 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9490 .endd
9491 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9492
9493
9494
9495 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9496 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9497 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9498 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9499 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9500 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9501 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9502 replacement list. For example
9503 .code
9504 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9505 .endd
9506 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9507 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9508 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9509 place.
9510 .endlist
9511
9512
9513
9514 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9515 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9516 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9517 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9518 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9519 following operations can be performed:
9520
9521 .vlist
9522 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9523 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9524 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9525 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9526 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9527 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9528
9529
9530 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9531 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9532 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9533 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9534 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9535 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9536 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9537 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9538 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9539
9540 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9541 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9542 character. For example:
9543 .code
9544 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9545 .endd
9546 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9547 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9548 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9549 processing lists.
9550
9551
9552 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9553 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9554 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9555 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9556 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9557 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9558 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9559 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9560 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9561
9562 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9563 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9564 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9565 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9566 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9567 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9568 string.
9569
9570 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9571 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9572 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9573 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9574 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9575
9576
9577 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9578 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9579 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9580 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9581 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9582 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9583 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9584
9585
9586 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9587 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9588 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9589 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9590 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9591 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9592 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9593 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9594 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9595 C programming language):
9596 .table2 70pt 300pt
9597 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9598 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9599 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9600 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9601 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9602 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9603 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9604 .endtable
9605 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9606 space is permitted before or after operators.
9607
9608 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9609 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9610 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9611 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9612 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9613
9614 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9615 or 1024*1024*1024,
9616 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9617 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9618
9619 .display
9620 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9621 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9622 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9623 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9624 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9625 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9626 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9627 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9628 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9629 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9630 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9631 .endd
9632
9633 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9634 .code
9635 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9636 condition = \
9637 ${if and { \
9638 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9639 { \
9640 < \
9641 {$recipients_count} \
9642 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9643 } \
9644 }{yes}{no}}
9645 .endd
9646 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9647 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9648
9649
9650 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9651 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9652 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9653 example,
9654 .code
9655 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9656 .endd
9657 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9658 and then re-expands what it has found.
9659
9660
9661 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9662 .cindex "Unicode"
9663 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9664 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9665 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9666 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9667 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9668 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9669 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9670 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9671 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9672
9673 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9674 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9675 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9676 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9677 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9678 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9679 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9680
9681
9682 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9683 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9684 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9685 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9686 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9687 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9688 .code
9689 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9690 .endd
9691 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9692 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9693
9694
9695
9696 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9697 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9698 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9699 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9700 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9701 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9702
9703
9704 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9705 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9706 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9707 .cindex "lower casing"
9708 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9709 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9710 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9711 .code
9712 ${lc:$local_part}
9713 .endd
9714
9715 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9716 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9717 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9718 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9719 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9720 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9721 .code
9722 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9723 .endd
9724 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9725 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9726 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9727
9728
9729 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9730 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9731 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9732 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9733 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9734 empty.
9735
9736
9737 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9738 .cindex "masked IP address"
9739 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9740 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9741 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9742 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9743 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9744 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9745 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9746 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9747 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9748 .code
9749 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9750 .endd
9751 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9752 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9753 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9754 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9755 .code
9756 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9757 .endd
9758 returns the string
9759 .code
9760 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9761 .endd
9762 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9763
9764
9765 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9766 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9767 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9768 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9769 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9770 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9771
9772
9773 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9774 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9775 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9776 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9777 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9778 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9779 .code
9780 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9781 .endd
9782 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9783
9784
9785 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9786 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9787 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9788 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9789 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9790 is an empty string or
9791 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9792 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9793 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9794 respectively For example,
9795 .code
9796 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9797 .endd
9798 becomes
9799 .code
9800 "ab\"*\"cd"
9801 .endd
9802 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9803 variable or a message header.
9804
9805 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9806 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9807 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9808 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9809 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9810 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9811 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9812
9813
9814 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9815 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9816 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9817 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9818 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9819 .code
9820 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9821 .endd
9822 returns
9823 .code
9824 two%20%5C2A%20two
9825 .endd
9826 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9827 yields an unchanged string.
9828
9829
9830 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9831 .cindex "random number"
9832 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9833 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9834 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9835 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9836 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9837 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9838 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9839 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9840 random().
9841
9842
9843 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9844 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9845 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9846 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9847 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9848 for DNS. For example,
9849 .code
9850 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9851 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9852 .endd
9853 returns
9854 .code
9855 4.2.0.192
9856 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9857 .endd
9858
9859
9860 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9861 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9862 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9863 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9864 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9865 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9866 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9867 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9868 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9869 characters
9870 .code
9871 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9872 .endd
9873 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9874 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9875 characters.
9876
9877
9878 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9879 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9880 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9881 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9882 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9883 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9884 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9885 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9886
9887 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9888 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9889 to use this operator as well.
9890
9891
9892
9893 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9894 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9895 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9896 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9897 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9898 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9899 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9900
9901
9902 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9903 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9904 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9905 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9906 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9907 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9908
9909
9910 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9911 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9912 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9913 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9914 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9915 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9916 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9917 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9918 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9919 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9920 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9921 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9922 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9923
9924 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9925 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9926 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9927
9928 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9929 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9930 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9931 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9932 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9933
9934
9935
9936 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9937 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9938 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9939 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9940 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9941 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9942
9943
9944 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9945 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9946 .cindex "substring extraction"
9947 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9948 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9949 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9950 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9951 .code
9952 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9953 .endd
9954 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9955 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9956
9957 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9958 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9959 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9960 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9961 seconds.
9962
9963 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9964 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9965 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9966 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9967 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9968 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9969 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
9970
9971 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9972 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9973 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9974 .cindex "upper casing"
9975 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9976 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9977 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9978 .endlist
9979
9980
9981
9982
9983
9984
9985 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9986 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9987 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9988 while expanding strings:
9989
9990 .vlist
9991 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9992 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9993 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9994 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9995 condition.
9996
9997 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9998 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9999 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10000 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10001 are:
10002 .display
10003 &`= `& equal
10004 &`== `& equal
10005 &`> `& greater
10006 &`>= `& greater or equal
10007 &`< `& less
10008 &`<= `& less or equal
10009 .endd
10010 For example:
10011 .code
10012 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10013 .endd
10014 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10015 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10016 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
10017 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
10018 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10019 zero.
10020
10021 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10022 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10023 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10024
10025
10026 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10027 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10028 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10029 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10030 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10031 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10032 false if zero.
10033 An empty string is treated as false.
10034 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10035 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10036 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10037
10038 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10039 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10040 For example:
10041 .code
10042 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10043 .endd
10044
10045
10046 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10047 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10048 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10049 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10050 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10051 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10052 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10053 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10054
10055 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10056
10057 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10058 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10059 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10060 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10061 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10062 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10063 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10064 included in the binary.
10065
10066 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10067 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10068 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10069 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10070 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10071 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10072 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10073 string in LDAP form is:
10074 .code
10075 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10076 .endd
10077 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10078 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10079 .code
10080 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10081 .endd
10082 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10083 supported:
10084
10085 .ilist
10086 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10087 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10088 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10089 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10090 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10091 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10092 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10093 comparison fails.
10094
10095 .next
10096 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10097 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10098 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10099 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10100 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10101 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10102
10103 .next
10104 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10105 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10106 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10107 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10108 whatever its length.
10109
10110 .next
10111 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10112 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10113 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10114 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10115 .endlist
10116 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10117 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10118 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10119 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10120 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10121 support &[crypt16()]&.
10122
10123 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10124 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10125 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10126 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10127 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10128
10129 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10130 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10131 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10132
10133 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10134 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10135 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10136 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10137 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10138
10139 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10140 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10141 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10142 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10143 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10144 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10145 .code
10146 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10147 .endd
10148 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10149 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10150
10151 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10152 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10153 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10154 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10155 exists in the message. For example,
10156 .code
10157 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10158 .endd
10159 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10160 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10161
10162 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10163 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10164 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10165 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10166 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10167 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10168 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10169 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10170 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10171
10172 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10173 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10174 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10175 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10176 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10177 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10178 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10179 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10180
10181 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10182 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10183 .cindex "first delivery"
10184 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10185 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10186 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10187 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10188
10189
10190 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10191 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10192 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10193 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10194 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10195 .vindex "&$item$&"
10196 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10197 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10198 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10199 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10200 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10201 .ilist
10202 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10203 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10204 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10205 .next
10206 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10207 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10208 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10209 .endlist
10210 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10211 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10212 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10213 list separator is changed to a comma:
10214 .code
10215 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10216 .endd
10217 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10218 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10219
10220
10221 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10222 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10223 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10224 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10225 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10226 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10227 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10228 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10229 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10230 case-independent.
10231
10232 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10233 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10234 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10235 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10236 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10237 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10238 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10239 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10240 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10241 case-independent.
10242
10243 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10244 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10245 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10246 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10247 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10248 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10249 is true.
10250
10251 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10252 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10253 .code
10254 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10255 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10256 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10257 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10258 .endd
10259
10260 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10261 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10262 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10264 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10265 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10266 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10267 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10268 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10269 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10270 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10271
10272 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10273 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10274 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10275 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10276 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10277
10278 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10279 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10280 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10281 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10282 .code
10283 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10284 .endd
10285 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10286
10287 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10288 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10289 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10290 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10291 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10292 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10293 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10294 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10295 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10296 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10297 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10298 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10299 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10300 this can be used.
10301
10302
10303 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10304 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10305 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10306 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10307 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10308 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10309 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10310 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10311 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10312 case-independent.
10313
10314 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10315 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10316 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10317 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10318 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10319 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10320 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10321 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10322 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10323 case-independent.
10324
10325
10326 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10327 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10328 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10329 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10330 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10331 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10332 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10333 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10334 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10335 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10336 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10337 For example,
10338 .code
10339 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10340 .endd
10341 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10342 backslashes is also required.
10343
10344 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10345 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10346 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10347 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10348 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10349 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10350
10351 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10352 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10353 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10354 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10355 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10356 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10357 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10358 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10359
10360 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10361 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10362 See &*match_local_part*&.
10363
10364 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10365 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10366 See &*match_local_part*&.
10367
10368 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10369 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10370 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10371 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10372 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10373 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10374 .code
10375 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10376 .endd
10377 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10378
10379 .ilist
10380 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10381 .next
10382 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10383 .next
10384 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10385 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10386 in a single test such as
10387 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10388 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10389 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10390 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10391 .code
10392 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10393 .endd
10394 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10395 .next
10396 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10397 .next
10398 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10399 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10400 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10401 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10402 masks. For example:
10403 .code
10404 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10405 .endd
10406 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10407 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10408 address mask, for example:
10409 .code
10410 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10411 .endd
10412 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10413 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10414 .code
10415 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10416 .endd
10417 .endlist ilist
10418
10419 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10420 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10421
10422 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10423
10424 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10425 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10426 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10427 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10428 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10429 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10430 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10431 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10432 example is:
10433 .code
10434 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10435 .endd
10436 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10437 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10438 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10439 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10440 .code
10441 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10442 .endd
10443 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10444 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10445 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10446 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10447 caselessly.
10448
10449 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10450 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10451
10452 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10453 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10454 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10455 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10456
10457 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10458 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10459 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10460 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10461 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10462 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10463 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10464 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10465 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10466 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10467 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10468 .code
10469 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10470 .endd
10471 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10472 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10473
10474 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10475 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10476 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10477 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10478 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10479 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10480 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10481
10482 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10483 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10484 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10485 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10486 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10487 .code
10488 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10489 .endd
10490 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10491 .code
10492 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10493 .endd
10494 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10495 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10496 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10497 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10498 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10499 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10500 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10501 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10502
10503
10504 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10505 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10506 .cindex "Cyrus"
10507 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10508 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10509 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10510 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10511 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10512 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10513
10514 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10515 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10516 building Exim. For example:
10517 .code
10518 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10519 .endd
10520 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10521 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10522 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10523 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10524
10525 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10526 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10527 configuration, you might have this:
10528 .code
10529 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10530 .endd
10531 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10532 .code
10533 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10534 .endd
10535 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10536 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10537 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10538 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10539 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10540 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10541
10542
10543 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10544 .cindex "Radius"
10545 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10546 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10547 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10548 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10549 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10550 support.
10551
10552 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10553 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10554 this library, you need to set
10555 .code
10556 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10557 .endd
10558 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10559 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10560 .code
10561 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10562 .endd
10563 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10564 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10565 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10566
10567 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10568 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10569 the authentication is successful. For example:
10570 .code
10571 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10572 .endd
10573
10574
10575 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10576 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10577 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10578 .cindex "Cyrus"
10579 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10580 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10581 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10582 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10583 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10584 by a process that is not running as root.
10585
10586 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10587 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10588 building Exim. For example:
10589 .code
10590 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10591 .endd
10592 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10593 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10594 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10595
10596 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10597 two are mandatory. For example:
10598 .code
10599 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10600 .endd
10601 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10602 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10603 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10604 .endlist vlist
10605
10606
10607
10608 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10609 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10610 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10611 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10612 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10613 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10614 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10615
10616
10617 .vlist
10618 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10619 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10620 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10621 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10622 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10623 For example,
10624 .code
10625 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10626 .endd
10627 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10628 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10629 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10630
10631 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10632 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10633 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10634 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10635 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10636 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10637 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10638 parsed but not evaluated.
10639 .endlist
10640 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10641
10642
10643
10644
10645 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10646 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10647 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10648 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10649 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10650
10651 .vlist
10652 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10653 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10654 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10655 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10656 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10657 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10658 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10659 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10660 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10661 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10662 matching condition.
10663
10664 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10665 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10666 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10667 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10668 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10669 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10670 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10671 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10672 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10673 during subsequent delivery.
10674
10675 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10676 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10677 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10678 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10679 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10680 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10681 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10682 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10683 delivery.
10684
10685 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10686 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10687 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10688 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10689 be preserved by coding like this:
10690 .code
10691 warn !verify = sender
10692 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10693 .endd
10694 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10695 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10696 failure.
10697
10698 .vitem &$address_data$&
10699 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10700 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10701 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10702 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10703 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10704 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10705 user filter files.
10706
10707 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10708 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10709 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10710 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10711 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10712 from the child's routing.
10713
10714 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10715 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10716 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10717 address.
10718
10719 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10720 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10721 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10722
10723 .vitem &$address_file$&
10724 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10725 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10726 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10727 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10728 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10729 .code
10730 /home/r2d2/savemail
10731 .endd
10732 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10733 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10734 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10735 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10736 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10737 to the relevant file.
10738
10739 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10740 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10741 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10742 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10743
10744 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10745 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10746 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10747 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10748
10749 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10750 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10751 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10752 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10753 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10754 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10755 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10756 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10757 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10758 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10759 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10760 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10761 command line option.
10762
10763
10764
10765
10766 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10767 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10768 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10769 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10770 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10771 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10772 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10773 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10774 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10775 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10776 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10777
10778 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10779 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10780 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10781 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10782 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10783
10784
10785 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10786 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10787 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10788 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10789 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10790 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10791 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10792 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10793 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10794 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10795 an undefined mechanism.
10796
10797 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10798 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10799 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10800 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10801 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10802 the ACL malware condition.
10803
10804 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10805 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10806 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10807 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10808 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10809 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10810
10811 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10812 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10813 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10814 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10815 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10816 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10817 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10818
10819 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10820 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10821 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10822 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10823 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10824
10825 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10826 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10827 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10828 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10829 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10830
10831 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10832 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10833 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10834 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10835 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10836 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10837 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10838
10839 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10840 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10841 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10842 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10843 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10844 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10845 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10846
10847 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10848 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10849 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10850
10851 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10852 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10853 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10854 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10855 compilations of the same version of the program.
10856
10857 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10858 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10859 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10860 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10861 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10862
10863 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10864 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10865 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10866 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10867 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10868
10869 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10870 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10871 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10872 &$dnslist_value$&
10873 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10874 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10875 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10876 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10877 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10878 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10879 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10880 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10881 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10882
10883 .vitem &$domain$&
10884 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10885 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10886 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10887 case for &$domain$&.
10888
10889 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10890 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10891 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10892 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10893
10894 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10895 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10896 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10897 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10898 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10899 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10900
10901 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10902 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10903 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10904
10905 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10906
10907 .ilist
10908 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10909 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10910 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10911 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10912 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10913 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10914 the &(smtp)& transport.
10915
10916 .next
10917 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10918 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10919 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10920 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10921
10922 .next
10923 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10924 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10925 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10926 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10927 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10928 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10929
10930 .next
10931 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10932 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10933 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10934 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10935 .endlist
10936
10937
10938 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10939 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10940 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10941 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10942 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10943 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10944 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10945 used.
10946
10947 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10948 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10949 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10950 to nothing.
10951
10952 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10953 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10954 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10955
10956 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10957 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10958 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10959
10960 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10961 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10962 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10963
10964 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10965 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10966 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10967 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10968 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10969
10970 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10971 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10972 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10973 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10974 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10975
10976 .vitem &$home$&
10977 .vindex "&$home$&"
10978 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10979 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10980 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10981 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10982 by a setting on the transport itself.
10983
10984 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10985 of the environment variable HOME.
10986
10987 .vitem &$host$&
10988 .vindex "&$host$&"
10989 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10990 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10991 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10992 to local and remote transports.
10993
10994 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10995 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10996 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10997 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10998 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10999 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11000 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11001 is connected.
11002
11003 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11004 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11005 client is connected.
11006
11007
11008 .vitem &$host_address$&
11009 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11010 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11011 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11012 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11013
11014 .vitem &$host_data$&
11015 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11016 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11017 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11018 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11019 .code
11020 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11021 message = $host_data
11022 .endd
11023 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11024 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11025 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11026 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11027 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11028 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11029 variables is set to &"1"&.
11030
11031 .ilist
11032 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11033 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11034
11035 .next
11036 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11037 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11038 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11039 .endlist ilist
11040
11041 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11042 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11043 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11044 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11045 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11046 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11047 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11048 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11049 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11050 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11051
11052 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11053 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11054 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11055
11056
11057 .vitem &$inode$&
11058 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11059 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11060 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11061 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11062 a unique name for the file.
11063
11064 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11065 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11066 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11067
11068 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11069 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11070 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11071
11072 .vitem &$item$&
11073 .vindex "&$item$&"
11074 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11075 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11076 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11077 empty.
11078
11079 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11080 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11081 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11082 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11083 lookup.
11084
11085 .vitem &$load_average$&
11086 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11087 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11088 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11089 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11090
11091 .vitem &$local_part$&
11092 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11093 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11094 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11095 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11096 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11097
11098 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11099 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11100 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11101 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11102 once.
11103
11104 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11105 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11106 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11107 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11108 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11109 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11110
11111 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11112 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11113 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11114 &$address_pipe$&).
11115
11116 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11117 local part of the recipient address.
11118
11119 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11120 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11121 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11122
11123 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11124 the addresses
11125 .code
11126 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11127 abc\:xyz@test.example
11128 .endd
11129 the value of &$local_part$& is
11130 .code
11131 abc:xyz
11132 .endd
11133 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11134 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11135 have:
11136 .code
11137 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11138 .endd
11139 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11140 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11141 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11142
11143 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11144 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11145 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11146 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11147 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11148 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11149 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11150
11151 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11152 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11153 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11154 variable expands to nothing.
11155
11156 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11157 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11158 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11159 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11160 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11161
11162 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11163 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11164 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11165 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11166 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11167
11168 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11169 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11170 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11171 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11172
11173 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11174 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11175 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11176
11177 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11178 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11179 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11180 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11181 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11182 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11183 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11184 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11185
11186 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11187 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11188 This contains the expanded value of the
11189 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11190 been read.
11191
11192 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11193 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11194 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11195 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11196 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11197 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11198
11199 .vitem &$log_space$&
11200 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11201 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11202 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11203 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11204 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11205 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11206
11207
11208 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11209 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11210 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11211 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11212 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11213 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11214 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11215 variable is empty.
11216
11217 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11218 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11219 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11220 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11221 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11222
11223 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11224 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11225 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11226 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11227 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11228 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11229 character(s).
11230
11231 .vitem &$message_age$&
11232 .cindex "message" "age of"
11233 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11234 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11235 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11236 delivery attempt.
11237
11238 .vitem &$message_body$&
11239 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11240 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11241 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11242 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11243 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11244 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11245 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11246 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11247 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11248
11249 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11250 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11251 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11252 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11253 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11254
11255 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11256 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11257 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11258 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11259 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11260 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11261 &$message_body$&.
11262
11263 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11264 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11265 .cindex "message body" "size"
11266 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11267 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11268 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11269 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11270 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11271
11272 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11273 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11274 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11275 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11276 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11277 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11278 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11279 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11280
11281 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11282 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11283 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11284 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11285 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11286 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11287
11288 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11289 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11290 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11291 contents of header lines is done.
11292
11293 .vitem &$message_id$&
11294 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11295
11296 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11297 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11298 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11299 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11300 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11301 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11302 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11303 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11304 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11305 from the body is not counted.
11306
11307 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11308 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11309 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11310 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11311 header and the body).
11312
11313 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11314 .code
11315 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11316 condition = \
11317 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11318 .endd
11319 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11320 message has not yet been received.
11321
11322 .vitem &$message_size$&
11323 .cindex "size" "of message"
11324 .cindex "message" "size"
11325 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11326 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11327 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11328 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11329 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11330 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11331 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11332 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11333 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11334
11335 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11336 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11337 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11338 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11339
11340 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11341 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11342 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11343 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11344
11345 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11346 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11347 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11348
11349 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11350 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11351 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11352 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11353 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11354 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11355 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11356 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11357 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11358 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11359
11360 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11361 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11362 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11363
11364 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11365 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11366 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11367 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11368 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11369 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11370 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11371 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11372 the original address.
11373
11374 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11375 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11376 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11377 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11378 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11379
11380 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11381 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11382 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11383
11384 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11385 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11386 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11387 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11388 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11389 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11390 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11391 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11392 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11393
11394 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11395 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11396 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11397 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11398 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11399 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11400 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11401 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11402 user.
11403
11404 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11405 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11406 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11407 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11408
11409 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11410 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11411 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11412 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11413
11414 .vitem &$pid$&
11415 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11416 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11417 This variable contains the current process id.
11418
11419 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11420 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11421 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11422 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11423 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11424 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11425 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11426 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11427 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11428 variable"& error if encountered.
11429
11430 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11431 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11432 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11433 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11434 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11435 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11436 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11437
11438
11439 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11440 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11441 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11442 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11443
11444 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11445 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11446 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11447 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11448
11449 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11450 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11451 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11452 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11453
11454 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11455 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11456 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11457
11458 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11459 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11460 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11461 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11462
11463 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11464 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11465 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11466 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11467 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11468
11469 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11470 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11471 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11472 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11473 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11474 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11475
11476 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11477 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11478 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11479 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11480 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11481
11482 .vitem &$received_count$&
11483 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11484 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11485 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11486 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11487 delivering.
11488
11489 .vitem &$received_for$&
11490 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11491 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11492 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11493 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11494 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11495
11496 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11497 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11498 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11499 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11500 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11501 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11502 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11503 option.
11504
11505 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11506 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11507 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11508 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11509 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11510 time.
11511
11512 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11513 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11514 &(smtp)& transport).
11515
11516 .vitem &$received_port$&
11517 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11518 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11519
11520 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11521 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11522 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11523 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11524 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11525 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11526 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11527 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11528 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11529
11530 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11531 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11532 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11533 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11534 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11535 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11536
11537 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11538 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11539 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11540
11541 .vitem &$received_time$&
11542 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11543 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11544 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11545
11546 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11547 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11548 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11549 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11550 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11551 .display
11552 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11553 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11554 .endd
11555 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11556 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11557 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11558 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11559
11560 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11561 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11562 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11563 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11564
11565 .ilist
11566 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11567 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11568
11569 .next
11570 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11571
11572 .next
11573 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11574 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11575 MAIL).
11576
11577 .next
11578 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11579 .next
11580
11581 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11582 .endlist
11583
11584 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11585 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11586
11587 .vitem &$recipients$&
11588 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11589 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11590 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11591 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11592 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11593 cases:
11594
11595 .olist
11596 In a system filter file.
11597 .next
11598 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11599 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11600 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11601 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11602 .next
11603 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11604 .endlist
11605
11606
11607 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11608 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11609 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11610 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11611 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11612 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11613
11614
11615 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11616 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11617 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11618 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11619
11620
11621 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11622 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11623 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11624 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11625 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11626 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11627 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11628
11629 .vitem &$return_path$&
11630 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11631 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11632 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11633 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11634 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11635 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11636 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11637 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11638 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11639 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11640 envelope sender.
11641
11642 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11643 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11644 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11645
11646 .vitem &$runrc$&
11647 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11648 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11649 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11650 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11651 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11652 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11653 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11654 another.
11655
11656 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11657 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11658 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11659 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11660 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11661 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11662 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11663 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11664
11665 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11666 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11667 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11668 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11669 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11670 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11671
11672 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11673 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11674 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11675 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11676 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11677 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11678 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11679 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11680
11681 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11682 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11683 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11684
11685 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11686 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11687 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11688
11689 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11690 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11691 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11692 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11693 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11694 this:
11695 .display
11696 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11697 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11698 .endd
11699 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11700 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11701 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11702 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11703
11704 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11705 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11706 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11707 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11708 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11709 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11710 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11711 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11712 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11713 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11714 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11715 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11716 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11717
11718 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11719 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11720 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11721 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11722 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11723 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11724
11725 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11726 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11727 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11728 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11729
11730 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11731 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11732 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11733 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11734 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11735 &$authenticated_id$&.
11736
11737 .new
11738 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11739 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11740 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11741 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11742 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11743 other times, this variable is false.
11744
11745 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11746 library, by setting:
11747 .code
11748 dns_use_dnssec = 1
11749 .endd
11750
11751 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11752 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11753
11754 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11755 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11756
11757 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11758 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11759 .wen
11760
11761
11762 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11763 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11764 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11765 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11766 other means, this variable is empty.
11767
11768 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11769 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11770 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11771 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11772 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11773 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11774 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11775
11776 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11777 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11778 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11779 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11780
11781 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11782 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11783 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11784 is set to &"1"&.
11785
11786 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11787 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11788 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11789 following are true:
11790
11791 .ilist
11792 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11793 .next
11794 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11795 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11796 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11797 .next
11798 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11799 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11800 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11801 .next
11802 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11803 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11804 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11805 .next
11806 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11807 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11808 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11809 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11810 .code
11811 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11812 .endd
11813 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11814 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11815 .endlist
11816
11817
11818 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11819 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11820 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11821 number that was used on the remote host.
11822
11823 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11824 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11825 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11826 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11827 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11828 called Exim.
11829
11830 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11831 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11832 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11833 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11834
11835 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11836 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11837 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11838 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11839 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11840 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11841 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11842 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11843 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11844 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11845 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11846 the parentheses.
11847
11848 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11849 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11850 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11851 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11852 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11853
11854 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11855 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11856 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11857 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11858 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11859
11860 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11861 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11862 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11863 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11864 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11865 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11866 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11867
11868 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11869 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11870 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11871 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11872 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11873
11874 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11875 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11876 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11877 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11878 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11879 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11880
11881 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11882 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11883 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11884 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11885 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11886 .code
11887 MAIL FROM:<>
11888 MAIL FROM: <>
11889 .endd
11890 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11891 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11892 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11893 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11894
11895 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11896 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11897 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11898 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11899 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11900 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11901 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11902
11903 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11904 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11905 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11906 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11907 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11908 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11909 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11910 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11911 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11912 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11913 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11914
11915 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11916 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11917 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11918 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11919 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11920 message is junk mail.
11921
11922 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11923 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11924 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11925 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11926
11927
11928 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11929 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11930 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11931
11932 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11933 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11934 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11935 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11936 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11937 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11938
11939 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11940 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11941 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11942 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11943 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11944 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11945 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11946 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11947 .code
11948 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11949 .endd
11950 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11951
11952
11953 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11954 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11955 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11956 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11957 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11958 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11959
11960 .vitem &$tls_bits$&
11961 .vindex "&$tls_bits$&"
11962 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength; the meaning of
11963 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
11964 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
11965 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
11966 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
11967
11968 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11969 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11970 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11971 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11972
11973 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11974 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11975 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11976 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11977 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11978 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11979 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11980 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11981
11982 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11983 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11984 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11985 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11986 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11987 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11988
11989 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11990 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11991 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11992 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11993 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11994 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11995 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11996 deliveries.
11997
11998 .vitem &$tls_sni$&
11999 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12000 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12001 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12002 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12003 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12004 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12005 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12006 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12007 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12008
12009 The value will be retained for the lifetime of the message. During outbound
12010 SMTP deliveries, it reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12011 the transport.
12012
12013 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12014 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12015 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12016 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12017
12018 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12019 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12020 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12021
12022 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12023 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12024 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12025
12026 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12027 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12028 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12029 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12030 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12031 values for those that are behind (west).
12032
12033 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12034 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12035 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12036 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12037
12038 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12039 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12040 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12041 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12042 flag.
12043
12044 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12045 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12046 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12047 -0500.
12048
12049 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12050 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12051 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12052 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12053
12054 .vitem &$value$&
12055 .vindex "&$value$&"
12056 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12057 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12058 &*reduce*& expansion.
12059
12060 .vitem &$version_number$&
12061 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12062 The version number of Exim.
12063
12064 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12065 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12066 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12067 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12068
12069 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12070 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12071 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12072 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12073 .endlist
12074 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12075
12076
12077
12078 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12079 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12080
12081 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12082 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12083 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12084 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12085 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12086 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12087 the line
12088 .code
12089 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12090 .endd
12091 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12092
12093
12094 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12095 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12096 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12097 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12098 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12099 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12100 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12101 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12102 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12103
12104 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12105 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12106 should usually be something like
12107 .code
12108 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12109 .endd
12110 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12111 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12112 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12113 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12114 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12115 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12116 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12117 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12118 two ways:
12119
12120 .ilist
12121 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12122 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12123 a startup when Exim is entered.
12124 .next
12125 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12126 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12127 .endlist
12128
12129 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12130 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12131
12132
12133 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12134 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12135 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12136 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12137 forms:
12138 .code
12139 ${perl{foo}}
12140 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12141 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12142 .endd
12143 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12144 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12145 with an error message of the form
12146 .code
12147 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12148 .endd
12149 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12150 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12151 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12152 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12153 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12154 that was passed to &%die%&.
12155
12156
12157 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12158 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12159 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12160 the Perl code
12161 .code
12162 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12163 .endd
12164 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12165 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12166 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12167
12168 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12169 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12170 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12171 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12172
12173 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12174 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12175 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12176 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12177 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12178 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12179 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12180
12181
12182 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12183 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12184 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12185 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12186 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12187 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12188 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12189 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12190 avoided, but the output is lost.
12191
12192 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12193 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12194 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12195 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12196 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12197 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12198 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12199 .code
12200 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12201 .endd
12202 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12203 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12204 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12205 as the first subroutine argument.
12206 .ecindex IIDperl
12207
12208
12209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12211
12212 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12213 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12214 "Starting the daemon"
12215 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12216 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12217 .cindex "network interface"
12218 .cindex "interface" "network"
12219 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12220 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12221 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12222 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12223 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12224 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12225 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12226 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12227 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12228 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12229 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12230
12231 .olist
12232 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12233 and ports to listen on.
12234 .next
12235 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12236 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12237 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12238 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12239 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12240 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12241 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12242 as an error situation.
12243 .next
12244 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12245 for the outgoing connection.
12246 .endlist
12247
12248
12249 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12250 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12251 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12252 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12253 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12254
12255 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12256 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12257 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12258 chapter describes how they operate.
12259
12260 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12261 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12262
12263
12264
12265 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12266 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12267 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12268 following options:
12269
12270 .ilist
12271 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12272 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12273 .next
12274 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12275 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12276 .endlist
12277
12278 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12279 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12280 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12281 colons. For example:
12282 .code
12283 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12284 192.168.23.65 ; \
12285 ::1 ; \
12286 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12287 .endd
12288 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12289 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12290
12291 .olist
12292 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12293 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12294 .code
12295 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12296 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12297 .endd
12298 .next
12299 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12300 with a colon separator, for example:
12301 .code
12302 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12303 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12304 .endd
12305 .endlist
12306
12307 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12308 default setting contains just one port:
12309 .code
12310 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12311 .endd
12312 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12313 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12314 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12315 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12316 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12317
12318
12319
12320 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12321 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12322 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12323 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12324 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12325 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12326 .code
12327 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12328 .endd
12329 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12330 .code
12331 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12332 .endd
12333 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12334
12335
12336
12337 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12338 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12339 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12340 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12341 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12342 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12343 exim.
12344
12345 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12346 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12347 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12348 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12349 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12350 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12351 .code
12352 -oX 1225
12353 .endd
12354 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12355 whereas
12356 .code
12357 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12358 .endd
12359 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12360 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12361 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12362
12363
12364
12365 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12366 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12367 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12368 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12369 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12370 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12371 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12372 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12373 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12374 common use of this option is expected to be
12375 .code
12376 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12377 .endd
12378 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12379 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12380 this way when a daemon is started.
12381
12382 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12383 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12384 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12385 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12386 connections via the daemon.)
12387
12388
12389
12390
12391 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12392 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12393 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12394 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12395 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12396 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12397 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12398 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12399 .code
12400 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12401 .endd
12402 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12403 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12404 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12405 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12406 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12407 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12408 .code
12409 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12410 .endd
12411 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12412 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12413 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12414 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12415 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12416
12417 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12418 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12419 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12420 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12421 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12422 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12423 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12424 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12425 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12426 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12427 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12428 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12429
12430 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12431 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12432 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12433 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12434 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12435
12436
12437
12438 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12439 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12440 .code
12441 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12442 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12443 .endd
12444 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12445 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12446 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12447 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12448
12449 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12450 .code
12451 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12452 .endd
12453 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12454 .code
12455 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12456 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12457 .endd
12458 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12459 IPv4 loopback address only:
12460 .code
12461 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12462 .endd
12463 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12464 .code
12465 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12466 .endd
12467 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12468
12469
12470
12471 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12472 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12473 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12474 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12475 treated as local.
12476
12477 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12478 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12479 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12480 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12481
12482 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12483 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12484 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12485 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12486 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12487 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12488 used for listening. Consider this example:
12489 .code
12490 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12491 192.168.53.235 ; \
12492 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12493
12494 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12495 .endd
12496 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12497 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12498 Exim is routing.
12499
12500 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12501 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12502 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12503 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12504 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12505 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12506 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12507 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12508
12509
12510
12511 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12512 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12513 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12514 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12515 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12516 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12517 details.
12518
12519
12520
12521
12522 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12524
12525 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12526 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12527 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12528 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12529
12530 .ilist
12531 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12532 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12533 .next
12534 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12535 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12536 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12537 .next
12538 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12539 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12540 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12541 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12542 settings.
12543 .endlist
12544
12545 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12546 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12547 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12548 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12549 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12550 listed in more than one group.
12551
12552 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12553 .table2
12554 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12555 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12556 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12557 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12558 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12559 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12560 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12561 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12562 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12563 .endtable
12564
12565
12566 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12567 .table2
12568 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12569 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12570 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12571 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12572 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12573 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12574 .endtable
12575
12576
12577
12578 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12579 .table2
12580 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12581 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12582 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12583 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12584 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12585 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12586 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12587 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12588 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12589 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12590 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12591 .endtable
12592
12593
12594
12595 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12596 .table2
12597 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12598 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12599 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12600 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12601 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12602 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12603 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12604 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12605 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12606 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12607 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12608 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12609 .endtable
12610
12611
12612
12613 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12614 .table2
12615 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12616 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12617 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12618 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12619 .endtable
12620
12621
12622
12623 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12624 .table2
12625 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12626 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12627 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12628 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12629 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12630 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12631 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12632 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12633 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12634 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12635 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12636 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12637 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12638 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12639 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12640 .endtable
12641
12642
12643
12644 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12645 .table2
12646 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12647 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12648 .endtable
12649
12650
12651
12652 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12653 .table2
12654 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12655 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12656 .endtable
12657
12658
12659
12660 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12661 .table2
12662 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12663 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12664 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12665 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12666 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12667 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12668 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12669 .endtable
12670
12671
12672
12673 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12674 .table2
12675 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12676 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12677 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12678 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12679 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12680 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12681 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12682 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12683 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12684 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12685 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12686 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12687 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12688 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12689 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12690 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12691 connection"
12692 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12693 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12694 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12695 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12696 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12697 .endtable
12698
12699
12700
12701 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12702 .table2
12703 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12704 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12705 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12706 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12707 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12708 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12709 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12710 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12711 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12712 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12713 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12714 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12715 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12716 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12717 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12718 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12719 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12720 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12721 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12722 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12723 words""&"
12724 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12725 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12726 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12727 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12728 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12729 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12730 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12731 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12732 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12733 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12734 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12735 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12736 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12737 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12738 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12739 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12740 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12741 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12742 .endtable
12743
12744
12745
12746 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12747 .table2
12748 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12749 item"
12750 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12751 item"
12752 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12753 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12754 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12755 .endtable
12756
12757
12758
12759 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12760 .table2
12761 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12762 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12763 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12764 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12765 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12766 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
12767 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12768 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12769 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12770 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12771 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12772 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12773 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12774 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12775 .endtable
12776
12777
12778
12779 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12780 .table2
12781 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12782 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12783 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12784 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12785 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12786 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12787 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12788 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12789 .endtable
12790
12791
12792
12793 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12794 .table2
12795 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12796 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12797 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12798 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12799 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12800 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12801 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12802 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12803 .endtable
12804
12805
12806
12807
12808 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12809 .table2
12810 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12811 .endtable
12812
12813
12814
12815
12816
12817 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12818 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12819
12820 .table2
12821 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12822 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12823 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12824 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12825 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12826 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12827 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12828 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12829 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12830 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12831 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12832 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12833 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12834 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12835 connection"
12836 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12837 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12838 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12839 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12840 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12841 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12842 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12843 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12844 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12845 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12846 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12847 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12848 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12849 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12850 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12851 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12852 .endtable
12853
12854
12855
12856 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12857 .table2
12858 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12859 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12860 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12861 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12862 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12863 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12864 .endtable
12865
12866
12867
12868 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12869 .table2
12870 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12871 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12872 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12873 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12874 words""&"
12875 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12876 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12877 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12878 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12879 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12880 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12881 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12882 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12883 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12884 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12885 .endtable
12886
12887
12888
12889 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12890 .table2
12891 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12892 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12893 directory"
12894 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12895 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12896 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12897 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12898 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12899 .endtable
12900
12901
12902
12903 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12904 .table2
12905 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12906 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12907 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12908 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12909 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12910 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12911 .new
12912 .row &%dns_use_dnssec%& "parameter for resolver"
12913 .wen
12914 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
12915 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12916 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12917 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12918 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12919 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12920 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12921 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12922 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12923 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12924 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12925 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12926 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12927 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12928 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12929 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12930 .endtable
12931
12932
12933
12934 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12935 .table2
12936 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12937 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12938 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12939 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12940 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12941 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12942 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12943 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12944 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12945 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12946 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12947 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12948 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12949 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12950 .endtable
12951
12952
12953
12954 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12955 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12956 &dagger;.
12957
12958 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
12959 .cindex "8BITMIME"
12960 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12961 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12962 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12963 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12964 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12965
12966 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
12967 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
12968 It now defaults to true.
12969 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
12970 .display
12971 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
12972 .endd
12973
12974 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12975 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12976 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12977 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12978 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12979 further details.
12980
12981 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12982 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12983 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12984 SMTP messages.
12985
12986 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12987 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12988 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12989 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12990 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12991
12992 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12993 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12994 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12995 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12996 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12997
12998 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12999 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13000 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13001 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13002
13003 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13004 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13005 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13006 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13007 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13008
13009 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13010 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13011 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13012 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13013
13014 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13015 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13016 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13017 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13018
13019 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13020 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13021 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13022 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13023 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13024
13025
13026 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13027 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13028 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13029 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13030
13031 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13032 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13033 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13034 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13035 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13036
13037 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13038 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13039 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13040 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13041 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13042
13043 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13044 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13045 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13046 further details.
13047
13048 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13049 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13050 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13051 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13052
13053 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13054 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13055 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13056 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13057
13058 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13059 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13060 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13061 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13062
13063 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13064 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13065 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13066 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13067
13068 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13069 .cindex "admin user"
13070 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13071 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13072 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13073 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13074 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13075 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13076 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13077
13078 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13079 .cindex "domain literal"
13080 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13081 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13082 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13083 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13084
13085 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13086 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13087 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13088 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13089 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13090 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13091 the local host's IP addresses.
13092
13093
13094 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13095 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13096 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13097 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13098 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13099 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13100 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13101 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13102 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13103
13104 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13105 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13106 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13107 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13108 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13109 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13110 experiment if they wish.
13111
13112 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13113 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13114 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13115 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13116 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13117 suitable setting is:
13118 .code
13119 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13120 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13121 .endd
13122 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13123 .code
13124 dns_check_names_pattern =
13125 .endd
13126 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13127
13128
13129 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13130 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13131 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13132 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13133 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13134 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13135 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13136 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13137 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13138 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13139 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13140
13141 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13142 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13143 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13144 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13145 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13146 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13147
13148 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13149 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13150 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13151 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13152 .code
13153 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13154 .endd
13155 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13156 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13157 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13158 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13159
13160
13161 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13162 .cindex "thawing messages"
13163 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13164 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13165 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13166 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13167 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13168 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13169
13170 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13171 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13172 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13173
13174
13175 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13176 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13177 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13178 .code
13179 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13180 .endd
13181 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13182 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13183
13184
13185 .option bi_command main string unset
13186 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13187 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13188 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13189 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13190 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13191
13192
13193 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13194 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13195 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13196 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13197 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13198 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13199
13200
13201 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13202 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13203 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13204 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13205
13206 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13207 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13208 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13209 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13210 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13211 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13212 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13213 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13214 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13215 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13216
13217 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13218 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13219 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13220 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13221
13222
13223 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13224 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13225 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13226 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13227 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13228 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13229 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13230 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13231 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13232
13233 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13234 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13235 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13236 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13237 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13238 messages.
13239
13240 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13241 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13242 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13243 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13244 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13245 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13246 connection. A typical setting might be:
13247 .code
13248 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13249 .endd
13250 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13251 .code
13252 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13253 .endd
13254 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13255 address.
13256
13257 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13258 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13259 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13260 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13261 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13262 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13263
13264
13265 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13266 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13267 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13268 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13269
13270
13271 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13272 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13273 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13274 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13275
13276
13277 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13278 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13279 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13280 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13281
13282
13283 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13284 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13285 callout verification. The default value is
13286 .code
13287 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13288 .endd
13289 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13290
13291
13292 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13293 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13294
13295
13296 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13297 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13298
13299 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13300 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13301 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13302 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13303 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13304 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13305 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13306 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13307 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13308 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13309
13310
13311 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13312 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13313
13314
13315 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13316 .cindex "checking disk space"
13317 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13318 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13319 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13320 message is accepted.
13321
13322 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13323 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13324 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13325 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13326 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13327 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13328 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13329 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13330
13331
13332 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13333 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13334 .code
13335 check_spool_space = 10M
13336 check_spool_inodes = 100
13337 .endd
13338 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13339 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13340 transit.
13341
13342 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13343 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13344 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13345
13346 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13347 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13348 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13349 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13350 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13351 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13352
13353 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13354 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13355
13356 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13357 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13358 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13359
13360 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13361 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13362 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13363 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13364 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13365 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13366
13367 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13368 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13369 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13370 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13371 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13372 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13373 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13374
13375 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13376 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13377
13378 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13379 .cindex "warning of delay"
13380 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13381 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13382 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13383 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13384 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13385 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13386 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13387 with
13388 .code
13389 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13390 .endd
13391 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13392 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13393 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13394 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13395 .code
13396 delay_warning = 6h
13397 .endd
13398 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13399 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13400 .code
13401 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13402 .endd
13403
13404 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13405 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13406 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13407 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13408 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13409 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13410 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13411 not sent. The default is:
13412 .code
13413 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13414 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13415 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13416 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13417 } {no}{yes}}
13418 .endd
13419 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13420 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13421 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13422 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13423
13424 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13425 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13426 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13427 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13428 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13429 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13430 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13431 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13432
13433 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13434 .cindex "load average"
13435 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13436 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13437 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13438 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13439 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13440
13441
13442 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13443 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13444 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13445 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13446 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13447 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13448 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13449 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13450
13451 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13452 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13453 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13454 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13455 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13456 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13457 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13458 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13459
13460 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13461 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13462 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13463 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13464
13465
13466 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13467 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13468 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13469 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13470 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13471 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13472 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13473
13474
13475 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13476 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13477 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13478 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13479 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13480 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13481 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13482 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13483 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13484 by a setting such as this:
13485 .code
13486 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13487 .endd
13488 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13489 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13490 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13491 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13492 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13493 options are applied after this global option.
13494
13495 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13496 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13497 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13498 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13499 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13500 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13501 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13502 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13503 value of this option. The default pattern is
13504 .code
13505 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13506 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13507 .endd
13508 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13509 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13510 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13511 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13512 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13513 empty string.
13514
13515 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13516 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13517 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13518
13519 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13520 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13521 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13522 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13523
13524 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13525 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13526 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13527 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13528 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13529 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13530 domain matches this list.
13531
13532 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13533 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13534 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13535
13536
13537 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13538 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13539 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13540 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13541 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13542 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13543 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13544 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13545 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13546 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13547 to set in them.
13548
13549
13550 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13551 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13552
13553
13554 .new
13555 .option dns_use_dnssec main integer -1
13556 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13557 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13558 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13559 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13560 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13561
13562 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13563 .wen
13564
13565
13566 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13567 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13568 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13569 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13570 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13571 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13572 on.
13573
13574 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13575
13576
13577 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13578 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13579 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13580 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13581
13582 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13583 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13584 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13585 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13586 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13587 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13588 .code
13589 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13590 .endd
13591 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13592 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13593
13594 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13595 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13596 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13597 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13598 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13599 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13600 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13601 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13602 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13603
13604
13605 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13606 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13607 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13608 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13609 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13610 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13611 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13612 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13613 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13614
13615 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13616 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13617 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13618 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13619 are examined. For example:
13620 .code
13621 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13622 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13623 postmaster@mydomain.example
13624 .endd
13625 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13626 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13627 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13628 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13629 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13630 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13631 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13632
13633
13634 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13635 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13636 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13637 .display
13638 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13639 .endd
13640 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13641 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13642 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13643 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13644 overrides the default.
13645
13646 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13647 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13648 and warning messages. For example:
13649 .code
13650 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13651 .endd
13652 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13653 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13654 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13655 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13656 not used.
13657
13658
13659 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13660 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13661 .cindex "Exim group"
13662 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13663 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13664 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13665 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13666 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13667 security issues.
13668
13669
13670 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13671 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13672 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13673 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13674 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13675 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13676 other place.
13677 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13678 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13679 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13680 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13681
13682
13683 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13684 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13685 .cindex "Exim user"
13686 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13687 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13688 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13689 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13690
13691 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13692 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13693 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13694 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13695
13696
13697 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13698 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13699 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13700 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13701
13702
13703 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13704 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13705
13706 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13707 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13708 .oindex "&%-t%&"
13709 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13710 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13711 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13712 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13713 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13714 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13715 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13716 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13717 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13718 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13719 addresses.
13720
13721
13722 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13723 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13724 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13725 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13726 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13727 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13728 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13729 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13730 retries.
13731
13732 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13733 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13734 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13735 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13736
13737
13738
13739 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13740 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13741 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13742 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13743 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13744 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13745 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13746 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13747 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13748 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13749 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13750 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13751 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13752 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13753 logging that you require.
13754
13755
13756 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13757 .cindex "HP-UX"
13758 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13759 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13760 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13761 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13762 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13763 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13764 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13765 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13766
13767 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13768 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13769 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13770 user's name.
13771
13772 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13773 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13774 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13775 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13776 .code
13777 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13778 gecos_name = $1
13779 .endd
13780
13781 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13782 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13783
13784
13785 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13786 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13787 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13788 implementations of TLS.
13789
13790 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13791 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13792 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13793 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13794 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13795 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13796
13797
13798
13799 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13800 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13801 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13802 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13803 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13804 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13805 sections are rejected.
13806
13807
13808 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13809 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13810 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13811 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13812 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13813 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13814 zero means &"no limit"&.
13815
13816
13817
13818
13819 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13820 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13821 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13822 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13823 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13824 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13825 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13826 if you want to do semantic checking.
13827 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13828 set.
13829
13830
13831 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13832 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13833 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13834 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13835 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13836 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13837 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13838 .code
13839 helo_allow_chars = _
13840 .endd
13841 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13842
13843
13844 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13845 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13846 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13847 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13848 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13849 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13850 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13851 do.
13852
13853
13854 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13855 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13856 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13857 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13858 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13859 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13860 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13861 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13862 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13863 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13864 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13865 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13866
13867 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13868 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13869 EHLO command either:
13870
13871 .ilist
13872 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13873 .next
13874 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13875 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13876 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13877 calling host address, or
13878 .next
13879 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13880 available) yields the calling host address.
13881 .endlist
13882
13883 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13884 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13885 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13886
13887 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13888 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13889 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13890 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13891 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13892 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13893 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13894 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13895 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13896 error.
13897
13898 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13899 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13900 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13901 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13902 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13903 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13904 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13905 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13906 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13907
13908 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13909 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13910 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13911 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13912 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13913
13914 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13915 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13916 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13917 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13918
13919
13920 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13921 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13922 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13923 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13924 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13925 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13926 default configuration file contains
13927 .code
13928 host_lookup = *
13929 .endd
13930 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13931 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13932
13933 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13934 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13935 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13936
13937 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13938 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13939 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13940 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13941 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13942 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13943
13944
13945 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13946 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13947 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13948 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13949 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13950 if you want.
13951
13952 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13953 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13954 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13955 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13956
13957
13958
13959 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13960 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13961 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13962 as soon as the connection is made.
13963 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13964 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13965 connections immediately.
13966
13967 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13968 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13969 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13970 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13971 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13972
13973
13974 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13975 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13976 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13977 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13978 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13979 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13980 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13981 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13982 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13983 .code
13984 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13985 .endd
13986 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13987
13988
13989
13990 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13991 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13992 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13993 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13994 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13995 records
13996 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13997 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13998
13999 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14000 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14001 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14002 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14003 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14004 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14005 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14006
14007
14008 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14009 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14010 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14011 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14012 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14013
14014
14015
14016 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14017 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14018 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14019 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14020 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14021 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14022
14023 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14024 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14025 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14026 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14027 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14028 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14029 for frozen messages. For example,
14030 .code
14031 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14032 .endd
14033 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14034 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14035 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14036 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14037 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14038 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14039
14040
14041 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14042 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14043 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14044 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14045 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14046 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14047 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14048 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14049 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14050 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14051
14052
14053 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14054 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14055
14056
14057 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14058 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14059 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14060 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14061 logged.
14062
14063
14064 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14065 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14066 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14067 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14068 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14069 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14070 and constrained to be a directory.
14071
14072
14073 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14074 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14075 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14076 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14077 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14078 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14079 and constrained to be a file.
14080
14081
14082 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14083 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14084 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14085 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14086 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14087
14088
14089 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14090 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14091 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14092 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14093 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14094 identity to be proven.
14095
14096
14097 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14098 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14099 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14100 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14101 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14102
14103
14104 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14105 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14106 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14107 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14108 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14109 with LDAP support.
14110
14111
14112 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14113 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14114 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14115 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14116 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14117 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14118 to hard/demand.
14119
14120
14121 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14122 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14123 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14124 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14125 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14126 of SSL-on-connect.
14127 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14128 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14129
14130
14131 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14132 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14133 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14134 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14135 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14136 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14137 has been built with LDAP support.
14138
14139
14140
14141 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14142 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14143 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14144 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14145 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14146 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14147 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14148
14149 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14150 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14151 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14152
14153 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14154 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14155 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14156 and the default qualify domain.
14157
14158 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14159 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14160 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14161 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14162
14163 .cindex "envelope sender"
14164 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14165 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14166 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14167
14168 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14169 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14170 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14171
14172
14173
14174
14175 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14176 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14177 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14178 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14179 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14180 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14181 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14182 example, if
14183 .code
14184 local_from_prefix = *-
14185 .endd
14186 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14187 .code
14188 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14189 .endd
14190 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14191 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14192 qualify domain.
14193
14194
14195 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14196 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14197
14198
14199 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14200 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14201 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14202 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14203 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14204 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14205 &%local_interfaces%& is
14206 .code
14207 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14208 .endd
14209 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14210 .code
14211 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14212 .endd
14213
14214 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14215 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14216 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14217 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14218 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14219 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14220 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14221 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14222
14223
14224
14225 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14226 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14227 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14228 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14229 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14230 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14231 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14232 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14233
14234
14235
14236
14237 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14238 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14239 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14240 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14241 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14242 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14243 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14244 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14245 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14246 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14247 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14248 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14249 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14250 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14251 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14252
14253
14254
14255 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14256 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14257 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14258 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14259 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14260 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14261 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14262 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14263 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14264 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14265 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14266 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14267 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14268 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14269
14270
14271 .option log_selector main string unset
14272 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14273 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14274 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14275 minus characters. For example:
14276 .code
14277 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14278 .endd
14279 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14280 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14281
14282
14283 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14284 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14285 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14286 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14287 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14288 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14289 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14290 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14291 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14292 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14293 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14294 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14295 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14296
14297
14298 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14299 .cindex "too many open files"
14300 .cindex "open files, too many"
14301 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14302 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14303 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14304 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14305 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14306 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14307 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14308 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14309 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14310 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14311 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14312 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14313
14314
14315 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14316 .cindex "length of login name"
14317 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14318 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14319 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14320 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14321 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14322 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14323
14324
14325 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14326 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14327 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14328 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14329 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14330 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14331 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14332 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14333
14334
14335 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14336 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14337 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14338 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14339 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14340 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14341 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14342
14343
14344 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14345 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14346 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14347 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14348 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14349 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14350 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14351 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14352 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14353 empty string, the option is ignored.
14354
14355
14356 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14357 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14358 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14359 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14360 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14361 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14362 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14363 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14364 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14365 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14366 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14367 colons will become hyphens.
14368
14369
14370 .option message_logs main boolean true
14371 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14372 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14373 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14374 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14375 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14376 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14377 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14378 which is not affected by this option.
14379
14380
14381 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14382 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14383 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14384 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14385 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14386 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14387 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14388 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14389 optionally followed by K or M.
14390
14391 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14392 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14393 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14394 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14395 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14396
14397 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14398 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14399 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14400 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14401 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14402 message that an individual transport can process.
14403
14404 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14405 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14406 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14407 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14408 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14409 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14410 some problems may result.
14411
14412 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14413 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14414 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14415
14416
14417 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14418 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14419 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14420 .code
14421 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14422 .endd
14423 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14424 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14425 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14426 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14427 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14428
14429
14430 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14431 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14432 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14433 contains a full description of this facility.
14434
14435
14436
14437 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14438 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14439 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14440 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14441 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14442
14443
14444 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14445 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14446 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14447 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14448 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14449 safety precaution.
14450
14451 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14452 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14453 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14454 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14455 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14456
14457 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14458 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14459 example is
14460 .code
14461 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14462 .endd
14463 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14464 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14465 transport driver.
14466
14467
14468 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14469 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14470 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14471 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14472 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14473
14474 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14475 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14476 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14477 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14478 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14479 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14480 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14481
14482 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14483 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14484 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14485 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14486 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14487
14488 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14489 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14490 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14491 some now infamous attacks.
14492
14493 An example:
14494 .code
14495 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14496 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14497 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14498 .endd
14499
14500 Possible options may include:
14501 .ilist
14502 &`all`&
14503 .next
14504 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14505 .next
14506 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14507 .next
14508 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14509 .next
14510 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
14511 .next
14512 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14513 .next
14514 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14515 .next
14516 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14517 .next
14518 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14519 .next
14520 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14521 .next
14522 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14523 .next
14524 &`no_compression`&
14525 .next
14526 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14527 .next
14528 &`no_sslv2`&
14529 .next
14530 &`no_sslv3`&
14531 .next
14532 &`no_ticket`&
14533 .next
14534 &`no_tlsv1`&
14535 .next
14536 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
14537 .next
14538 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
14539 .next
14540 &`single_dh_use`&
14541 .next
14542 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14543 .next
14544 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14545 .next
14546 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14547 .next
14548 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14549 .next
14550 &`tls_d5_bug`&
14551 .next
14552 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14553 .endlist
14554
14555
14556 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14557 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14558 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14559 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14560 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14561
14562
14563 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14564 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14565 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14566 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14567 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14568 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14569 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14570 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14571 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14572 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14573 an ACL.
14574
14575 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14576 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14577 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14578 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14579 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14580 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14581 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14582
14583
14584 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14585 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14586 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14587
14588
14589 .option perl_startup main string unset
14590 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14591 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14592
14593
14594 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14595 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14596 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14597 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14598 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14599 PostgreSQL support.
14600
14601
14602 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14603 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14604 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14605 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14606 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14607 to the host name:
14608 .code
14609 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14610 .endd
14611 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14612 spool directory.
14613 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14614 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14615 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14616
14617
14618 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14619 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14620 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14621 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14622 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14623 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14624 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14625 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14626 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14627
14628
14629 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14630 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14631 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14632 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14633 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14634 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14635 volume of mail. Use with care!
14636
14637
14638 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14639 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14640 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14641 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14642 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14643 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14644 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14645 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14646 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14647 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14648
14649 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14650 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14651 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14652 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14653 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14654 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14655
14656
14657 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14658 .cindex "printing characters"
14659 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14660 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14661 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14662 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14663 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14664 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14665 characters.
14666
14667 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14668 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14669 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14670 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14671 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14672 standards.
14673
14674
14675 .option process_log_path main string unset
14676 .cindex "process log path"
14677 .cindex "log" "process log"
14678 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14679 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14680 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14681 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14682 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14683 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14684 different spool directories.
14685
14686
14687 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14688 .oindex "&%-M%&"
14689 .oindex "&%-R%&"
14690 .oindex "&%-q%&"
14691 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14692 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14693 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14694
14695
14696 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14697 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14698 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14699 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14700 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14701 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14702 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14703 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14704 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14705
14706 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14707 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14708 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14709 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14710 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14711 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14712 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14713
14714
14715 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14716 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14717 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14718
14719
14720
14721 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14722 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14723 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14724 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14725 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14726 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14727 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14728 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14729
14730
14731 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14732 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
14733 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14734 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14735 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14736
14737
14738 .option queue_only main boolean false
14739 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14740 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14741 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14742 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14743 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14744 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14745
14746 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14747 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14748 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14749 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14750
14751
14752 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14753 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14754 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14755 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14756 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14757 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14758 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14759 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14760 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14761 .code
14762 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14763 .endd
14764 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14765 &_/some/file_& exists.
14766
14767
14768 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14769 .cindex "load average"
14770 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14771 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14772 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14773 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14774 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14775 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14776 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14777 false.
14778
14779 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14780 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14781 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14782 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14783
14784
14785 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14786 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14787 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14788 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14789 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14790 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14791 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14792 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14793 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14794 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14795 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14796 re-evaluated for each message.
14797
14798
14799 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14800 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14801 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14802 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14803 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14804 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14805
14806
14807 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14808 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14809 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14810 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14811 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14812 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14813 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14814 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14815 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14816 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14817 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14818 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14819 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14820
14821
14822
14823 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14824 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14825 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14826 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14827 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14828 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14829 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14830 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14831 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14832
14833 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14834 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14835 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14836 the daemon's command line.
14837
14838 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14839 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14840 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14841 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14842 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14843 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14844 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14845 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14846 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14847 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14848 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14849 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14850 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14851 &%queue_domains%&.
14852
14853
14854 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14855 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14856 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14857 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14858 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14859 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14860 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14861
14862 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14863 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14864 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14865 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14866 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14867 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14868 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14869 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14870 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14871 header lines. The default setting is:
14872
14873 .code
14874 received_header_text = Received: \
14875 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14876 {${if def:sender_ident \
14877 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14878 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14879 by $primary_hostname \
14880 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14881 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14882 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14883 ${if def:sender_address \
14884 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14885 id $message_exim_id\
14886 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14887 .endd
14888
14889 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14890 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14891 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14892 header lines such as the following:
14893 .code
14894 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14895 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14896 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14897 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14898 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14899 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14900 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14901 .endd
14902 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14903 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14904 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14905 message was accepted.
14906
14907
14908 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14909 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14910 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14911 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14912 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14913 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14914 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14915 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14916
14917
14918 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14919 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14920 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14921 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14922 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14923 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14924 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14925 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14926 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14927 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14928 option was not set.
14929
14930
14931 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14932 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14933 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14934 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14935 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14936 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14937 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14938 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14939 done.
14940
14941 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14942 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14943 RCPT commands in a single message.
14944
14945
14946 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14947 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14948 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14949 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14950 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14951 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14952 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14953
14954
14955 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14956 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14957 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14958 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14959 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14960 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14961 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14962 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14963 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14964 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14965 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14966 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14967 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14968 tagged with its process id.
14969
14970 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14971 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14972 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14973 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14974 is received.
14975
14976 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14977 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14978 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14979 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14980 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14981 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14982 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14983 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14984 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14985 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14986 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14987
14988 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14989 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14990 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14991 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14992
14993
14994 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14995 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14996 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14997 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14998 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14999 .code
15000 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15001 .endd
15002 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15003 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15004
15005
15006 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15007 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15008 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15009 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15010 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15011 past failures.
15012
15013
15014 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15015 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15016 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15017 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15018 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15019 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15020 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15021 the default value.
15022
15023
15024 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15025 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15026 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15027 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15028 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15029 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15030 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15031 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15032 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15033 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15034
15035
15036 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15037 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15038
15039
15040 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15041 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15042 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15043 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15044 in the list.
15045
15046 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15047 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15048 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15049 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15050 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15051
15052
15053 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15054 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15055 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15056 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15057 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15058 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15059 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15060 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15061 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15062 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15063
15064
15065 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15066 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15067 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15068 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15069 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15070 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15071 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15072 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15073 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15074 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15075 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15076
15077
15078
15079 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15080 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15081 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15082 .cindex "inetd"
15083 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15084 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15085 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15086 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15087 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15088 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15089
15090 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15091 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15092 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15093 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15094
15095
15096 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15097 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15098 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15099 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15100 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15101 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15102 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15103 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15104
15105 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15106 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15107 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15108 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15109 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15110 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15111 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15112 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15113
15114
15115 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15116 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15117 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15118 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15119 live with.
15120
15121
15122 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15123 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15124
15125 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15126 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15127 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15128 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15129 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15130 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15131 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15132 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15133 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15134 seen).
15135
15136
15137 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15138 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15139 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15140 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15141 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15142 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15143 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15144 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15145 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15146 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15147 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15148
15149 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15150 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15151 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15152 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15153 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15154 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15155
15156
15157
15158 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15159 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15160 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15161 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15162 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15163 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15164 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15165 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15166 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15167 to all messages received in the same connection.
15168
15169 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15170 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15171 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15172 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15173
15174
15175 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15176 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15177
15178 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
15179 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15180 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15181 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15182 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15183 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15184 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15185 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15186 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15187 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15188 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15189 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15190 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15191
15192
15193 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15194 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15195 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15196 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15197 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15198 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15199 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15200 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15201 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15202 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15203 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15204 individual host.
15205
15206 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15207 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15208 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15209 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15210
15211
15212 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15213 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15214 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15215 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15216 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15217 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15218 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15219 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15220 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15221
15222 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15223 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15224 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15225 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15226
15227 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15228 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15229 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15230 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15231 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15232 For example:
15233 .code
15234 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15235 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15236 .endd
15237
15238 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15239 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15240 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15241 &%helo_data%& value.
15242
15243 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15244 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15245 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15246 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15247 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15248 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15249 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15250 .code
15251 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15252 $version_number $tod_full
15253 .endd
15254 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15255 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15256 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15257 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15258 multiline response).
15259
15260
15261 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15262 .cindex "checking disk space"
15263 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15264 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15265 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15266 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15267 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15268 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15269 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15270
15271
15272 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15273 .cindex "connection backlog"
15274 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15275 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15276 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15277 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15278 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15279 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15280 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15281 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15282 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15283 attacks by SYN flooding.
15284
15285
15286 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15287 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15288 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15289 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15290 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15291 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15292 fewer, but they still exist.
15293
15294 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15295 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15296 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15297 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15298 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15299 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15300 does detect many instances.
15301
15302 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15303 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15304 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15305 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15306
15307
15308
15309 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15310 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15311 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15312 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15313 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15314 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15315 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15316 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15317 example:
15318 .code
15319 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15320 $sender_host_address
15321 .endd
15322 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15323 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15324 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15325 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15326 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15327 the command.
15328
15329
15330 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15331 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15332 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15333 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15334 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15335
15336
15337 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15338 .cindex "load average"
15339 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15340 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15341 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15342 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15343 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15344 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15345
15346
15347
15348 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15349 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15350 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15351 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15352 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15353 .code
15354 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15355 .endd
15356 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15357 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15358 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15359 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15360 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15361
15362 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15363 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15364 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15365 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15366 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15367 not count towards the limit.
15368
15369
15370
15371 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15372 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15373 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15374 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15375 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15376 that subvert web
15377 clients
15378 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15379 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15380
15381
15382
15383 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15384 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15385 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15386 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15387 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15388 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15389 recipients.
15390
15391 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15392 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15393 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15394 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15395
15396 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15397 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15398 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15399 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15400 values:
15401
15402 .ilist
15403 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15404 .next
15405 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15406 fractional parts are allowed here.
15407 .next
15408 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15409 .next
15410 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15411 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15412 .endlist
15413
15414 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15415 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15416 .code
15417 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15418 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15419 .endd
15420 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15421 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15422 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15423 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15424
15425
15426 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15427 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15428
15429
15430 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15431 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15432
15433
15434 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15435 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15436 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15437 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15438 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15439 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15440 the message is abandoned.
15441 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15442 .code
15443 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15444 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15445 .endd
15446 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15447 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15448
15449
15450 .oindex "&%-os%&"
15451 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15452 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15453 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15454 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15455 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15456
15457
15458 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15459 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15460 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15461
15462
15463 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15464 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15465 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15466 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15467 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15468 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15469 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15470 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15471 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15472 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15473 .code
15474 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15475 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15476 .endd
15477
15478 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15479 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15480 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15481 The default value is
15482 .code
15483 127.0.0.1 783
15484 .endd
15485 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15486
15487
15488
15489 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15490 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15491 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15492 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15493 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15494 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15495 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15496 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15497 arrival of the message.
15498
15499 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15500 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15501 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15502 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15503 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15504
15505 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15506 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15507 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15508 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15509 automatically deleted.
15510
15511 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15512 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15513 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15514 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15515 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15516 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15517 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15518 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15519 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15520
15521
15522 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15523 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15524 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15525 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15526 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15527 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15528 &$primary_hostname$&.
15529
15530 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15531 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15532 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15533 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15534 as failures in the configuration file.
15535
15536 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15537 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15538
15539 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15540 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15541 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15542 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15543
15544 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15545 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15546 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15547 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15548 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15549 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15550
15551 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15552 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15553 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15554 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15555 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15556 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15557 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15558
15559
15560 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15561 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15562 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15563 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15564 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15565 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15566 domain causes a syntax error.
15567 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15568 syntax checking.
15569
15570
15571 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15572 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15573 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15574 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15575 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15576 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15577 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15578 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15579 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15580 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15581 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15582 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15583
15584
15585 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15586 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15587 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15588 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15589 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15590 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15591 details of Exim's logging.
15592
15593
15594
15595 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15596 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15597 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15598 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15599 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15600
15601
15602
15603 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15604 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15605 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15606 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15607 details of Exim's logging.
15608
15609
15610 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15611 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15612 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15613 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15614 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15615 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15616 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15617 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15618 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15619 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15620 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15621
15622
15623 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15624 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15625 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15626 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15627 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15628 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15629
15630
15631 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15632 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15633 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15634 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15635 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15636
15637 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15638 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15639 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15640 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15641 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15642
15643 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15644 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15645 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15646 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15647 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15648 contains the pipe command.
15649
15650
15651 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15652 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15653 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15654 is used in a system filter.
15655
15656
15657 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15658 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15659 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15660 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15661 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15662 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15663 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15664 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15665 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15666 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15667
15668 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15669 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15670 transport option overrides.
15671
15672
15673 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15674 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15675 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15676 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15677 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15678 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15679 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15680 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15681 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15682 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15683 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15684 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15685 TCP_NODELAY.
15686
15687
15688 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15689 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15690 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15691 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15692 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15693 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15694 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15695 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15696 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15697 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15698
15699 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15700 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15701 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15702
15703
15704 .option timezone main string unset
15705 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15706 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15707 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15708 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15709 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15710 .code
15711 timezone = UTC
15712 .endd
15713 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15714 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15715 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15716 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15717 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15718 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15719
15720
15721 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15722 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15723 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15724 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15725 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15726 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15727 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15728 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15729
15730
15731 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15732 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15733 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15734 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15735 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15736 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15737 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15738
15739 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15740 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15741 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15742 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15743
15744 If the option contains &$tls_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
15745 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
15746 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
15747 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
15748
15749 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15750 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15751 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15752 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15753 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15754
15755 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15756
15757
15758 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
15759 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
15760 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
15761 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
15762 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
15763 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
15764
15765 The value must be at least 1024.
15766
15767 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
15768 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
15769 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
15770
15771 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
15772 number.
15773
15774 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
15775 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
15776 larger prime than requested.
15777
15778
15779 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15780 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15781 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
15782 to be used by Exim.
15783
15784 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
15785 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
15786 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
15787 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
15788 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
15789 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
15790 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
15791
15792 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
15793 loaded by Exim.
15794
15795 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
15796 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
15797 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
15798 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
15799
15800 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
15801 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
15802 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
15803 in IKE is assigned number 23.
15804
15805 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
15806 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
15807 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
15808 "ike23".
15809
15810 The available primes are:
15811 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
15812 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
15813 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
15814
15815 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
15816 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
15817
15818
15819 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15820 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15821 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15822 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15823 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15824
15825
15826
15827 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15828 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15829 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15830 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15831 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15832 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15833 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15834
15835 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15836
15837
15838 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15839 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15840 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15841 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15842 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15843 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15844 TLS session.
15845
15846
15847 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15848 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15849 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15850 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15851 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15852 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15853 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15854 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15855 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15856 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15857 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15858
15859
15860 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15861 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15862 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15863 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15864
15865
15866 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15867 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15868 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15869 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15870 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15871 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15872 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15873 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15874 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15875
15876 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15877 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15878 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15879 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15880 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15881 use OpenSSL with a directory.
15882
15883 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15884
15885
15886 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15887 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15888 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15889 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15890 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15891 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15892 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15893 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15894
15895 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15896 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15897 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15898 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15899 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15900 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15901 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15902
15903 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15904 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15905 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15906 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15907 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15908 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15909 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15910 certificate"&.
15911
15912 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15913 certificates.
15914
15915
15916 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15917 .cindex "trusted groups"
15918 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15919 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15920 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15921 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15922 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15923 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15924 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15925 are trusted.
15926
15927 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15928 .cindex "trusted users"
15929 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15930 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15931 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15932 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15933 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15934 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15935 Exim user are trusted.
15936
15937 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15938 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15939 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15940 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15941 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15942 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15943 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15944 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15945 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15946 &%-F%& option.
15947
15948 .option unknown_username main string unset
15949 See &%unknown_login%&.
15950
15951 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15952 .cindex "trusted users"
15953 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15954 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15955 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15956 .cindex "envelope sender"
15957 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15958 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15959 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15960 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15961 is used) is ignored.
15962
15963 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15964 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15965 .code
15966 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15967 .endd
15968 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15969 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15970 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15971 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15972 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15973 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15974 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15975 followed by a hyphen
15976 by a setting like this:
15977 .code
15978 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15979 .endd
15980 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15981 restriction, you can use
15982 .code
15983 untrusted_set_sender = *
15984 .endd
15985 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15986 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15987 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15988 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15989 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15990 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15991 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15992 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15993
15994 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15995 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15996 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15997 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15998 sender address.
15999
16000
16001 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16002 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16003 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16004 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16005 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16006 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16007 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16008 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16009 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16010 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16011 .code
16012 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16013 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16014 .endd
16015 The pattern can be seen by running
16016 .code
16017 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16018 .endd
16019 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16020 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16021 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16022 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16023 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16024 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16025
16026
16027 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16028 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16029
16030
16031 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16032 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16033 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16034 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16035 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16036 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16037 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16038 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16039
16040
16041 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16042 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16043 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16044 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16045 .ecindex IIDconfima
16046 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16047
16048
16049
16050
16051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16053
16054 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16055 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16056 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16057 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16058 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16059
16060 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16061 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16062 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16063 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16064 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16065
16066
16067
16068 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16069 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16070 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16071 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16072 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16073 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16074 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16075
16076 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16077 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16078 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16079 routers, and the eventual transport.
16080
16081 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16082 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16083 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16084 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16085 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16086
16087 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16088 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16089 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16090 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16091 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16092
16093 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16094 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16095 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16096 .code
16097 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16098 .endd
16099 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16100 .code
16101 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16102 .endd
16103 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16104 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16105
16106 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16107 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16108 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16109 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16110 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16111 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16112 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16113
16114
16115
16116 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16117 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16118 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16119 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16120 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16121 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16122 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16123 routing.
16124
16125
16126
16127 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16128 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16129 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16130 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16131 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16132 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16133 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16134 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16135 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16136 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16137 you could put:
16138 .code
16139 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16140 .endd
16141 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16142 and
16143 .code
16144 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16145 .endd
16146 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16147 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16148 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16149 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16150
16151
16152 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16153 .cindex "case of local parts"
16154 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16155 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16156 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16157 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16158 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16159 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16160 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16161 more details.
16162
16163 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16164 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16165 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16166 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16167 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16168 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16169 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16170 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16171 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16172
16173 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16174 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16175 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16176 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16177
16178
16179
16180 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16181 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16182 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16183 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16184 .vindex "&$home$&"
16185 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16186 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16187 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16188 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16189 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16190 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16191 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16192 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16193 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16194 the router is skipped.
16195
16196 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16197 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16198 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16199 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16200 setting to achieve this. For example:
16201 .code
16202 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16203 .endd
16204 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16205 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16206 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16207
16208
16209
16210 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16211 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16212 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16213 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16214 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16215 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16216 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16217 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16218
16219 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16220 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16221
16222 This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16223 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16224
16225 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16226 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16227 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16228 .code
16229 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16230 .endd
16231 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16232 .code
16233 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16234 .endd
16235
16236 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16237 .code
16238 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16239 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16240 condition = foobar
16241 .endd
16242
16243 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16244 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16245 be specified using &%condition%&.
16246
16247
16248 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16249 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16250 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16251 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16252 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16253 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16254 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16255 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16256 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16257 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16258 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16259 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16260
16261
16262
16263 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16264 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16265 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16266 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16267 transport option of the same name.
16268
16269
16270 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16271 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16272 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16273 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16274 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16275 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16276 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16277 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16278
16279
16280
16281 .option driver routers string unset
16282 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16283 to be used.
16284
16285
16286
16287 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16288 .cindex "envelope sender"
16289 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16290 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16291 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16292 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16293 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16294 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16295 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16296
16297 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16298 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16299 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16300 setting.
16301
16302 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16303 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16304 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16305 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16306
16307 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16308 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16309 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16310 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16311 settings:
16312 .code
16313 errors_to =
16314 errors_to = ""
16315 .endd
16316 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16317 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16318 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16319 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16320 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16321
16322 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16323 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16324 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16325 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16326 setting &%return_path%&.
16327
16328 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16329 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16330 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16331
16332
16333
16334 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16335 .cindex "address" "testing"
16336 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16337 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16338 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16339 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16340 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16341 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16342 on for the system alias file.
16343 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16344 are evaluated.
16345
16346 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16347 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16348 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16349
16350
16351
16352 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16353 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16354 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16355 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16356
16357
16358
16359 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16360 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16361 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16362
16363
16364
16365 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16366 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16367 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16368
16369
16370
16371 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16372 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16373 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16374 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16375 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16376 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16377 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16378 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16379 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16380
16381 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16382 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16383 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16384 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16385 transport for further details.
16386
16387
16388 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16389 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16390 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16391 .cindex "transport" "local"
16392 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16393 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16394 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16395 process.
16396 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16397 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16398 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16399 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16400 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16401
16402
16403
16404 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16405 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16406 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16407 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16408 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16409 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16410 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16411 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16412 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16413 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16414 &"see"& the added header lines.
16415
16416 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16417 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16418 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16419 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16420
16421 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16422 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16423
16424 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16425 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16426 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16427 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16428 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16429 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16430 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16431 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16432 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16433 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16434
16435
16436
16437 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16438 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16439 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16440 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16441 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16442 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16443 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16444 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16445 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16446 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16447 &"see"& the original header lines.
16448
16449 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16450 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16451 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16452 errors.
16453
16454 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16455 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16456
16457 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16458 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16459 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16460 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16461
16462
16463 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16464 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16465 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16466 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16467 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16468 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16469 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16470 like
16471 .code
16472 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16473 .endd
16474 by setting
16475 .code
16476 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16477 .endd
16478 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16479 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16480 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16481 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16482 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16483 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16484
16485 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16486 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16487 .code
16488 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16489 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16490 .endd
16491 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16492 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16493
16494 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16495 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16496 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16497 domain that is being routed.
16498
16499 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16500 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16501 checked.
16502
16503 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16504 .cindex "additional groups"
16505 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16506 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16507 .cindex "transport" "local"
16508 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16509 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16510 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16511 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16512 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16513
16514
16515
16516 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16517 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16518 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16519 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16520 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16521 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16522 evaluated.
16523
16524 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16525 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16526 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16527 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16528 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16529 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16530 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16531 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16532 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16533
16534 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16535 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16536 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16537 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16538 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16539 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16540 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16541 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16542 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16543 the relevant transport.
16544
16545 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16546 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16547 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16548 callout.
16549
16550 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16551 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16552 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16553 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16554 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16555 .code
16556 real_localuser:
16557 driver = accept
16558 local_part_prefix = real-
16559 check_local_user
16560 transport = local_delivery
16561 .endd
16562 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16563 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16564 .code
16565 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16566 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16567 .endd
16568
16569 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16570 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16571 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16572 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16573
16574
16575 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16576 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16577
16578
16579
16580 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16581 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16582 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16583 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16584 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16585 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16586 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16587 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16588 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16589 &%username-foo%&.
16590
16591
16592 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16593 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16594
16595
16596
16597 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16598 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16599 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16600 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16601 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16602 are evaluated, and
16603 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16604 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16605 example:
16606 .code
16607 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16608 .endd
16609 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16610 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16611 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16612 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16613 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16614 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16615 each virtual domain:
16616 .code
16617 postmaster:
16618 driver = redirect
16619 local_parts = postmaster
16620 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16621 .endd
16622
16623
16624 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16625 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16626 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16627 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16628 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16629 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16630 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16631 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16632 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16633 redirect addresses.
16634
16635
16636
16637 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16638 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16639 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16640 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16641 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16642 delivery to be deferred.
16643
16644 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16645 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16646 .oindex "&%self%&"
16647 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16648 means of the setting
16649 .code
16650 self = pass
16651 .endd
16652 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16653 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16654 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16655
16656 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16657 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16658 controls what happens next.
16659
16660
16661 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16662 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16663 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16664 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16665 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16666 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16667 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16668 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16669
16670 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16671 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16672 applies to all of them.
16673
16674
16675
16676 .option pass_router routers string unset
16677 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16678 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16679 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16680 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16681 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16682 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16683 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16684 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16685 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16686 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16687
16688
16689
16690 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16691 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16692 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16693 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16694 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16695 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16696
16697 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16698 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16699 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16700 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16701
16702
16703
16704 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16705 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16706 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16707 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16708 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16709 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16710 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16711
16712 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16713 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16714 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16715 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16716
16717 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16718 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16719 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16720 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16721 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16722
16723 .cindex "NFS"
16724 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16725 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16726 unavailable.
16727
16728 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16729 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16730 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16731 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16732 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16733 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16734 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16735 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16736
16737 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16738 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16739 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16740 operates as follows:
16741
16742 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16743 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16744 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16745 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16746 used. For example:
16747 .code
16748 require_files = mail:/some/file
16749 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16750 .endd
16751 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16752 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16753
16754 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16755 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16756 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16757 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16758
16759 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16760 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16761 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16762 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16763 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16764
16765 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16766 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16767 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16768 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16769 check again in that process.
16770
16771 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16772 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16773 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16774 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16775 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16776 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16777 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16778 .code
16779 require_files = +/some/file
16780 .endd
16781 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16782 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16783 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16784
16785
16786
16787 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16788 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16789 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16790 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16791 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16792 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16793 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16794 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16795 latter kind.
16796
16797 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16798 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16799 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16800 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16801 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16802 same name.
16803
16804 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16805 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16806 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16807
16808
16809
16810 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16811 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16812 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16813 .vindex "&$home$&"
16814 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16815 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16816 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16817 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16818 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16819 cause the router to defer.
16820
16821 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16822 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16823 place.
16824 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16825 are evaluated.)
16826 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16827 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16828
16829 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16830 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16831 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16832 of these values that is set:
16833
16834 .ilist
16835 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16836 .next
16837 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16838 .next
16839 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16840 .next
16841 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16842 .endlist
16843
16844 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16845 router, but not for the transport.
16846
16847
16848
16849 .option self routers string freeze
16850 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16851 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16852 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16853 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16854 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16855 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16856 of remote hosts.
16857 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16858 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16859 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16860 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16861 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16862
16863 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16864 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16865 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16866 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16867 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16868 cases:
16869
16870 .vlist
16871 .vitem &%defer%&
16872 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16873
16874 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16875 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16876 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16877 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16878
16879 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16880 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16881 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16882 rewritten.
16883
16884 .vitem &%pass%&
16885 .oindex "&%more%&"
16886 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16887 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16888 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16889 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16890 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16891 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16892 combination
16893 .code
16894 self = pass
16895 no_more
16896 .endd
16897 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16898 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16899 be passed to the next router.
16900
16901 .vitem &%fail%&
16902 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16903
16904 .vitem &%send%&
16905 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16906 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16907 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16908 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16909 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16910 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16911 .endlist
16912
16913
16914
16915 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16916 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16917 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16918 address matches something on the list.
16919 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16920 are evaluated.
16921
16922 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16923 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16924 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16925 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16926 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16927 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16928 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16929 matters.
16930
16931
16932 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16933 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16934 .cindex "packet radio"
16935 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16936 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16937 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16938 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16939 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16940 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16941 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16942 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16943
16944 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16945 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16946 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16947 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16948 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16949 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16950 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16951 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16952 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16953 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16954 .code
16955 translate_ip_address = \
16956 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16957 {$value}fail}}
16958 .endd
16959 The file would contain lines like
16960 .code
16961 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16962 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16963 .endd
16964 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16965 are doing.
16966
16967
16968
16969 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16970 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16971 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16972 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16973 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16974 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16975 delivery is deferred.
16976
16977 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16978 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16979 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16980
16981
16982
16983 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16984 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16985 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16986 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16987 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16988 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16989 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16990 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16991 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16992 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16993 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16994 environment.
16995
16996
16997
16998
16999 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17000 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17001 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17002 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17003 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17004 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17005 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17006 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17007 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17008 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17009
17010 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17011 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17012 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17013 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17014 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17015
17016 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17017 environment.
17018
17019
17020
17021
17022 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17023 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17024 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17025 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17026 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17027 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17028 delivery to be deferred.
17029
17030 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17031 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17032 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17033 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17034 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17035 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17036
17037 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17038 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17039 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17040 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17041 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17042 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17043 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17044 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17045
17046 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17047 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17048 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17049 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17050 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17051 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17052 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17053 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17054 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17055 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17056
17057 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17058 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17059 subsequent routers.
17060
17061
17062 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17063 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17064 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17065 .cindex "transport" "local"
17066 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17067 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17068 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17069 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17070 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17071 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17072 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17073 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17074 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17075 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17076 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17077 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17078
17079
17080
17081 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17082 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17083 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17084
17085
17086 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17087 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17088 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
17089 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17090 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
17091 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17092 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17093 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17094 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17095
17096 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17097 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17098 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17099 user or group.
17100
17101
17102 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17103 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17104 addresses
17105 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17106 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17107 are evaluated.
17108
17109
17110 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17111 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17112 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17113 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17114 are evaluated.
17115 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17116 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17117
17118
17119
17120
17121
17122
17123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17125
17126 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17127 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17128 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17129 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17130 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17131 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17132 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17133 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17134 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17135 .code
17136 localusers:
17137 driver = accept
17138 domains = mydomain.example
17139 check_local_user
17140 transport = local_delivery
17141 .endd
17142 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17143 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17144 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17145 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17146
17147
17148
17149
17150
17151
17152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17154
17155 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17156 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17157 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17158 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17159 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17160 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17161
17162 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17163 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17164 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17165 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17166 records.
17167
17168 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17169 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17170 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17171 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17172 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17173 generic option, the router declines.
17174
17175 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17176 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17177 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17178
17179 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17180 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17181 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17182 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17183 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17184 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17185
17186
17187 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17188 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17189 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17190 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17191 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17192 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17193
17194 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17195 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17196 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17197 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17198 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17199 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17200 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17201 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17202 case routing fails.
17203
17204
17205 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17206 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17207 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17208 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17209 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17210
17211 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17212 .ilist
17213 The domain does not exist in DNS
17214 .next
17215 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17216 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17217 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17218 .next
17219 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17220 .next
17221 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17222 .next
17223 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17224 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17225 .next
17226 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17227 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17228 .next
17229 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17230 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17231 .next
17232 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17233 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17234 .endlist
17235
17236
17237
17238
17239 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17240 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17241 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17242
17243 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17244 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17245 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17246 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17247 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17248 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17249 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17250
17251
17252 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17253 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17254 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17255 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17256 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17257 required. For example,
17258 .code
17259 check_srv = smtp
17260 .endd
17261 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17262 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17263 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17264 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17265 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17266 normal way.
17267
17268 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17269 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17270 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17271 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17272 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17273 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17274
17275 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17276 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17277 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17278 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17279 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17280 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17281 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17282 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17283
17284 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17285 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17286
17287
17288
17289 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17290 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17291 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17292 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17293 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17294 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17295 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17296 setting:
17297 .code
17298 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17299 .endd
17300 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17301 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17302 the address record.
17303
17304
17305 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17306 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17307 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17308 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17309
17310
17311
17312
17313 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17314 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17315 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17316 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17317 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17318 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17319 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17320 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17321 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17322 &'resolv.conf'&.
17323
17324
17325
17326 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17327 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17328 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17329 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17330 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17331 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17332 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17333 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17334 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17335 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17336 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17337
17338 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17339 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17340 sense.
17341
17342 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17343 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17344 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17345 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17346 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17347 header rewriting.
17348
17349
17350 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17351 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17352 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17353 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17354 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17355 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17356 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17357 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17358
17359 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17360 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17361 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17362 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17363 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17364 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17365 without processing them independently,
17366 provided the following conditions are met:
17367
17368 .ilist
17369 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17370 &%headers_remove%&.
17371 .next
17372 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17373 the domain.
17374 .endlist
17375
17376
17377
17378
17379 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17380 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17381 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17382 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17383 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17384 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17385 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17386 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17387 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17388 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17389
17390 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17391 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17392 local wildcard.
17393
17394
17395
17396 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17397 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17398 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17399 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17400
17401
17402
17403
17404 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17405 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17406 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17407 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17408 if
17409 .code
17410 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17411 .endd
17412 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17413 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17414 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17415 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17416 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17417 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17418
17419
17420 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17421 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17422 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17423 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17424 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17425
17426 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17427 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17428 such as that implied by
17429 .code
17430 domains = @mx_any
17431 .endd
17432 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17433 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17434 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17435 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17436
17437
17438
17439
17440
17441
17442
17443
17444
17445 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17446 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17447
17448 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17449 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17450 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17451 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17452 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17453 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17454 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17455 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17456 router handles the address
17457 .code
17458 root@[192.168.1.1]
17459 .endd
17460 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17461 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17462 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17463 .code
17464 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17465 .endd
17466 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17467 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17468
17469 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17470 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17471 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17472 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17473
17474 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17475 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17476 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17477 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17478
17479
17480
17481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17483
17484 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17485 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17486 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17487 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17488 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17489 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17490 must set
17491 .code
17492 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17493 .endd
17494 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17495
17496 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17497 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17498 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17499 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17500 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17501 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17502 must not be specified for it.
17503
17504 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17505 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17506 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17507 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17508 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17509 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17510 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17511
17512
17513 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17514 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17515 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17516 delivery to the address is deferred.
17517
17518
17519 .option port iplookup integer 0
17520 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17521 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17522 call.
17523
17524
17525 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17526 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17527 protocols is to be used.
17528
17529
17530 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17531 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17532 default value is:
17533 .code
17534 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17535 .endd
17536 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17537 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17538
17539
17540 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17541 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17542 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17543 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17544 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17545 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17546 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17547 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17548
17549
17550 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17551 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17552 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17553 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17554 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17555 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17556 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17557 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17558 following could be used:
17559 .code
17560 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17561 reroute = $local_part@$1
17562 .endd
17563
17564 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17565 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17566 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17567 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17568
17569
17570
17571
17572 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17574
17575 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17576 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17577 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17578 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17579 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17580 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17581 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17582 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17583 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17584 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17585
17586 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17587 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17588 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17589 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17590 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17591 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17592 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17593
17594 .vindex "&$host$&"
17595 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17596 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17597 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17598 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17599 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17600 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17601 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17602 text string.
17603
17604 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17605 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17606 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17607 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17608 below, following the list of private options.
17609
17610
17611 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17612
17613 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17614 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17615
17616 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17617 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17618
17619 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17620 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17621 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17622 of the following values:
17623 .code
17624 decline
17625 defer
17626 fail
17627 freeze
17628 ignore
17629 pass
17630 .endd
17631 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17632 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17633 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17634 &%pass_router%&),
17635 .oindex "&%more%&"
17636 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17637 router only if &%more%& is true.
17638
17639 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17640 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17641 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17642 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17643
17644 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17645 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17646 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17647
17648
17649 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17650 .cindex "randomized host list"
17651 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17652 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17653 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17654 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17655 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17656 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17657 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17658 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17659
17660 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17661 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17662 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17663 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17664 .code
17665 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17666 .endd
17667 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17668 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17669 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17670 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17671 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17672
17673
17674 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17675 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17676 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17677 example:
17678 .code
17679 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17680 .endd
17681 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17682 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17683 deferred.
17684
17685
17686 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17687 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17688 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17689 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17690
17691
17692 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17693 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17694 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17695 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17696 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17697 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17698 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17699 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17700
17701 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17702 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17703 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17704 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17705 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17706 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17707 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17708 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17709
17710
17711
17712
17713 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17714 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17715 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17716 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17717 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17718 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17719 .display
17720 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17721 .endd
17722 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17723 no options:
17724 .code
17725 route_list = \
17726 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17727 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17728 .endd
17729 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17730 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17731 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17732 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17733 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17734 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17735 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17736 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17737 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17738 in a &%route_list%&).
17739
17740 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17741 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17742 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17743 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17744
17745
17746
17747 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17748 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17749 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17750 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17751 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17752 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17753 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17754 like this:
17755 .code
17756 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17757 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17758 .endd
17759 This data can be accessed by setting
17760 .code
17761 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17762 .endd
17763 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17764 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17765 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17766 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17767 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17768
17769
17770
17771
17772 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17773 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17774 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17775 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17776 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17777 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17778 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17779
17780 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17781 variables are set during its expansion:
17782
17783 .ilist
17784 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17785 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17786 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17787 .code
17788 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17789 .endd
17790 .next
17791 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17792 .next
17793 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17794
17795 .next
17796 .vindex "&$value$&"
17797 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17798 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17799 .code
17800 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17801 .endd
17802 .endlist
17803
17804 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17805 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17806
17807
17808
17809 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17810 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17811 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17812 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17813 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17814 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17815
17816 .ilist
17817 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17818 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17819 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17820 .code
17821 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17822 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17823 .endd
17824 .next
17825 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17826 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17827 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17828 number follows. For example:
17829 .code
17830 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17831 .endd
17832 .endlist
17833
17834 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17835 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17836 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17837 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17838 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17839 transport.
17840
17841 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17842 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17843 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17844 records in the DNS. For example:
17845 .code
17846 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17847 .endd
17848 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17849 example:
17850 .code
17851 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17852 .endd
17853 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17854 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17855 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17856 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17857 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17858 happens is controlled by the
17859 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17860 &%self%& option of the router.
17861
17862 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17863 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17864 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17865 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17866 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17867 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17868 defined by MX preferences.
17869
17870 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17871 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17872 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17873
17874 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17875 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17876 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17877 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17878
17879 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17880 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17881 router.
17882
17883 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17884 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17885 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17886
17887 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17888 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17889
17890
17891
17892 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17893 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17894 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17895 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17896 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17897 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17898 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17899
17900 .ilist
17901 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17902 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17903 .next
17904 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17905 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17906 .next
17907 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17908 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17909 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17910 .next
17911 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17912 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17913 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17914 .endlist
17915
17916 For example:
17917 .code
17918 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17919 domain2 host4:host5
17920 .endd
17921 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17922 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17923 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17924 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17925 call.
17926
17927 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17928 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17929 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17930 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17931 function called.
17932
17933
17934
17935 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17936 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17937
17938 .vindex "&$host$&"
17939 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17940 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17941
17942
17943
17944 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17945 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17946 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17947
17948 .ilist
17949 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17950 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17951 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17952 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17953 .code
17954 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17955 .endd
17956 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17957 your first router something like this:
17958 .code
17959 smart_route:
17960 driver = manualroute
17961 domains = !+local_domains
17962 transport = remote_smtp
17963 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17964 .endd
17965 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17966 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17967 they are tried in order
17968 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17969 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17970 .code
17971 smart_route:
17972 driver = manualroute
17973 transport = remote_smtp
17974 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17975 .endd
17976 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17977 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17978 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17979 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17980 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17981 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17982 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17983 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17984
17985 .next
17986 .cindex "mail hub example"
17987 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17988 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17989 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17990 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17991 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17992 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17993 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17994 lookup is easier to manage.
17995
17996 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17997 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17998 example:
17999 .code
18000 hub_route:
18001 driver = manualroute
18002 transport = remote_smtp
18003 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18004 .endd
18005 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18006 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18007 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18008 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18009 domain can be used to find the host:
18010 .code
18011 through_firewall:
18012 driver = manualroute
18013 transport = remote_smtp
18014 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18015 .endd
18016 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18017 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18018 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18019 next router.
18020
18021 .next
18022 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18023 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18024 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18025 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18026 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18027 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18028 .code
18029 save_in_file:
18030 driver = manualroute
18031 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18032 route_list = saved.domain.example
18033 .endd
18034 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18035 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18036 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18037 .code
18038 save_in_file:
18039 driver = manualroute
18040 route_list = \
18041 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18042 *.saved.domain2.example \
18043 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18044 batch_pipe
18045 .endd
18046 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18047 .vindex "&$host$&"
18048 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18049 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18050 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18051 the address if the lookup fails.
18052
18053 .next
18054 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18055 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18056 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18057 one way it can be done:
18058 .code
18059 # Transport
18060 uucp:
18061 driver = pipe
18062 user = nobody
18063 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18064 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18065 return_fail_output = true
18066
18067 # Router
18068 uucphost:
18069 transport = uucp
18070 driver = manualroute
18071 route_data = \
18072 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18073 .endd
18074 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18075 .code
18076 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18077 .endd
18078 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18079 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18080 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18081 .endlist
18082 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18083 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18084
18085
18086
18087
18088
18089
18090
18091
18092 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18094
18095 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18096 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18097 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18098 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18099 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18100 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18101 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18102 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18103 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18104 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18105 options:
18106 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18107
18108 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18109 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18110 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18111 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18112 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18113
18114
18115 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18116 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18117 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18118 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18119 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18120 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18121
18122
18123 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18124 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18125 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18126 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18127 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18128 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18129 not set, a value for the gid also.
18130
18131 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18132 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18133 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18134 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18135 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18136 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18137 gid.
18138
18139
18140 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18141 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18142 before running the command.
18143
18144
18145 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18146 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18147 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18148 timeout.
18149
18150
18151 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18152 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18153 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18154 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18155 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18156
18157 .ilist
18158 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18159 below).
18160 .next
18161 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18162 &%no_more%& is set.
18163 .next
18164 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18165 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18166 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18167 included in the SMTP response.
18168 .next
18169 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18170 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18171 included in any SMTP response.
18172 .next
18173 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18174 .next
18175 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18176 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18177 .next
18178 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18179 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18180 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18181 .endlist
18182
18183 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18184 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18185 the page):
18186 .code
18187 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18188 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18189 .endd
18190 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18191 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18192 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18193 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18194
18195 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18196 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18197 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18198 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18199 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18200
18201 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18202 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18203 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18204 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18205 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18206
18207 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18208 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18209 variable. For example, this return line
18210 .code
18211 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18212 .endd
18213 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18214 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18215 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18216 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18217
18218
18219
18220
18221 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18222 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18223
18224 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18225 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18226 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18227 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18228 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18229 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18230 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18231 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18232 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18233 redirected in several different ways:
18234
18235 .ilist
18236 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18237 independently.
18238 .next
18239 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18240 .next
18241 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18242 .next
18243 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18244 .next
18245 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18246 .next
18247 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18248 .next
18249 It can be discarded.
18250 .endlist
18251
18252 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18253 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18254 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18255 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18256
18257
18258
18259 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18260 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18261 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18262 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18263 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18264 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18265 .code
18266 system_aliases:
18267 driver = redirect
18268 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18269 .endd
18270 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18271 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18272 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18273 cause delivery to be deferred.
18274
18275 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18276 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18277 .code
18278 userforward:
18279 driver = redirect
18280 check_local_user
18281 file = $home/.forward
18282 no_verify
18283 .endd
18284 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18285 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18286 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18287 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18288 comments.
18289
18290
18291
18292 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18293 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18294 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18295 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18296
18297 .ilist
18298 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18299 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18300 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18301 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18302 .next
18303 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18304 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18305 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18306 saves some resources.
18307 .endlist
18308
18309
18310
18311
18312
18313
18314 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18315 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18316 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18317 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18318 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18319
18320 .ilist
18321 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18322 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18323 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18324 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18325 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18326 document is intended for use by end users.
18327 .next
18328 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18329 described in the next section.
18330 .endlist
18331
18332 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18333 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18334 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18335 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18336 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18337
18338
18339
18340 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18341 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18342 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18343 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18344 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18345 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18346 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18347 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18348 commas or newlines.
18349 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18350 quotes.
18351
18352 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18353 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18354 next newline character is ignored.
18355
18356 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18357 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18358 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18359 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18360 removed.
18361
18362 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18363 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18364 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18365 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18366 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18367 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18368 setting:
18369 .code
18370 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18371 .endd
18372
18373
18374 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18375 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18376 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18377 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18378 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18379 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18380 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18381 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18382 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18383 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18384 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18385
18386 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18387 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18388 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18389 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18390 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18391 .code
18392 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18393 .endd
18394 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18395 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18396 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18397 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18398 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18399 synonymously.
18400
18401 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18402 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18403 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18404 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18405 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18406
18407 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18408 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18409 contains:
18410 .code
18411 Sam.Reman: spqr
18412 .endd
18413 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18414 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18415 this forward file:
18416 .code
18417 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18418 .endd
18419 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18420 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18421 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18422 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18423 should really contain
18424 .code
18425 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18426 .endd
18427 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18428 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18429 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18430
18431
18432
18433 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18434 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18435 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18436
18437 .ilist
18438 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18439 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18440 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18441 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18442 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18443 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18444 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18445
18446 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18447 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18448 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18449 in double quotes, for example:
18450 .code
18451 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18452 .endd
18453 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18454 quote just the command. An item such as
18455 .code
18456 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18457 .endd
18458 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18459
18460 .new
18461 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18462 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18463 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18464 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18465 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18466 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18467 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18468 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18469 an &%accept%& router.
18470 .wen
18471
18472 .next
18473 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18474 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18475 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18476 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18477 .code
18478 /home/world/minbari
18479 .endd
18480 is treated as a file name, but
18481 .code
18482 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18483 .endd
18484 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18485 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18486 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18487 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18488
18489 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18490 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18491
18492 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18493 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18494 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18495 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18496
18497 .next
18498 .cindex "included address list"
18499 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18500 If an item is of the form
18501 .code
18502 :include:<path name>
18503 .endd
18504 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18505 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18506 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18507 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18508 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18509 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18510 .code
18511 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18512 .endd
18513 It must be given as
18514 .code
18515 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18516 .endd
18517 .next
18518 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18519 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18520 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18521 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18522 .cindex "black hole"
18523 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18524 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18525 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18526 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18527
18528 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18529 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18530 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18531 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18532 &_/dev/null_&.
18533
18534 .next
18535 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18536 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18537 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18538 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18539 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18540 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18541 redirection items of the form
18542 .code
18543 :defer:
18544 :fail:
18545 .endd
18546 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18547 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18548 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18549 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18550 .code
18551 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18552 .endd
18553 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18554 of a
18555 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18556 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18557 default.
18558 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18559 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18560 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18561
18562 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18563 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18564 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18565 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18566 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18567 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18568 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18569 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18570 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18571 ignored.
18572
18573 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18574 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18575 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18576 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18577
18578 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18579 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18580 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18581 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18582 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18583
18584 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18585 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18586 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18587 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18588 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18589 rules still apply.
18590
18591 .next
18592 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18593 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18594 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18595 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18596 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18597 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18598 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18599 .endlist
18600
18601
18602 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18603 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18604 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18605 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18606 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18607 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18608 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18609 aliasing scheme of the type
18610 .code
18611 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18612 localpart1: pipe
18613 localpart2: pipe
18614 .endd
18615 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18616 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18617 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18618 such as
18619 .code
18620 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18621 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18622 .endd
18623 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18624 the pipes are distinct.
18625
18626
18627
18628 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18629 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18630 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18631 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18632 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18633 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18634 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18635 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18636 can be used to avoid this.
18637
18638
18639 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18640 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18641 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18642 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18643 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18644 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18645 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18646
18647
18648
18649 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18650
18651 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18652 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18653
18654
18655 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18656 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18657 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18658
18659
18660 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18661 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18662 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18663 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18664
18665
18666 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18667 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18668 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18669 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18670 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18671 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18672 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18673
18674 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18675 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18676
18677
18678 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18679 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18680 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18681 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18682 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18683
18684
18685
18686 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18687 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18688 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18689 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18690 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18691 let ordinary users do.
18692
18693
18694
18695 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18696 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18697 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18698 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18699 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18700 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18701
18702 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18703 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18704 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18705 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18706 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18707 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18708 .code
18709 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18710 .endd
18711 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18712 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18713 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18714 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18715 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18716 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18717 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18718 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18719
18720
18721 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18722 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18723 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18724 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18725 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18726 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18727 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18728 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18729
18730
18731
18732 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18733 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18734 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18735 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18736 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18737 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18738
18739
18740 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18741 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18742 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18743 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18744 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18745 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18746
18747 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18748 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18749 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18750 .code
18751 data = #Exim filter\n\
18752 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18753 .endd
18754 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18755 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18756 choice into a newline.
18757
18758
18759 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18760 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18761 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18762 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18763 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18764
18765
18766 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18767 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18768 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18769 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18770 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18771 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18772 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18773 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18774
18775 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18776 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18777 runs a check on the containing directory,
18778 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18779 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18780 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18781 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18782 not, the router declines.
18783
18784
18785 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18786 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18787 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18788 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18789 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18790 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18791 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18792
18793
18794 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18795 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18796 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18797 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18798 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18799
18800
18801 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18802 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18803 redirection list.
18804
18805
18806 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18807 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18808 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18809
18810
18811
18812
18813 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18814 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18815 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18816 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18817 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18818 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18819 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18820 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18821 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18822
18823
18824 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18825 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18826 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18827 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18828 functions.
18829
18830 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18831 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18832 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18833 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18834
18835 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18836 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18837 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18838 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18839 &_.forward_& files).
18840
18841
18842 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18843 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18844 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18845
18846
18847 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18848 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18849 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18850 of the embedded Perl support.
18851
18852
18853 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18854 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18855 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18856
18857
18858 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18859 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18860 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18861
18862
18863 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18864 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18865 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18866 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18867 &%one_time%& is set.
18868
18869
18870 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18871 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18872 to make use of &%run%& items.
18873
18874
18875 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18876 If this option is true, items of the form
18877 .code
18878 :include:<path name>
18879 .endd
18880 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18881
18882
18883 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18884 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18885 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18886 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18887 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18888
18889
18890 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18891 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18892 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18893
18894
18895 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18896 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18897 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18898 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18899 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18900
18901
18902
18903
18904 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18905 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18906 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18907 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18908 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18909 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18910 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18911
18912
18913 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18914 .cindex "EACCES"
18915 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18916 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18917 file did not exist.
18918
18919
18920 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18921 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
18922 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18923 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18924 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18925
18926 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18927 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18928 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18929 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18930 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18931 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18932 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18933 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18934
18935
18936
18937 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18938 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18939 redirection list must start with this directory.
18940
18941
18942 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18943 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18944 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18945
18946
18947 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18948 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18949 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18950 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18951 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18952 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18953 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18954 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18955 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18956 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18957 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18958 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18959 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18960 before they subscribed.
18961
18962 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18963 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18964 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18965 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18966 attempt.
18967
18968 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18969 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18970 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18971 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18972
18973 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18974 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18975 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18976
18977 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18978 &%one_time%&.
18979
18980 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18981 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18982 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18983 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18984 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18985 expansion.
18986
18987
18988 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18989 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18990 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18991 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18992 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18993 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18994 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18995 See &%check_owner%& above.
18996
18997
18998 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18999 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19000 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19001 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19002
19003
19004 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19005 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19006 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19007 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19008 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19009 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19010 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19011
19012
19013 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19014 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19015 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19016 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19017 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19018 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19019 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19020 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19021
19022 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19023 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19024 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19025 addresses.
19026
19027 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19028 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19029 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19030 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19031 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19032 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19033 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19034 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19035 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19036 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19037
19038
19039 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19040 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19041 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19042 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19043 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19044 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19045
19046
19047 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19048 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19049 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19050 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19051 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19052 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19053
19054
19055 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19056 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19057 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19058 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19059 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19060
19061
19062 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19063 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19064 :subaddress part of an address.
19065
19066 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19067 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19068 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19069 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19070
19071
19072 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19073 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19074 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19075 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19076 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19077 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19078 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19079
19080
19081
19082 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19083 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19084 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19085 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19086 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19087 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19088 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19089 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19090 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19091 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19092 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19093 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19094 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19095 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19096 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19097 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19098
19099 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19100 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19101 the following routers.
19102
19103 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19104 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19105 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19106 so it is passed to the following routers.
19107
19108 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19109 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19110 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19111 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19112
19113 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19114 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19115 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19116 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19117 .code
19118 userforward:
19119 driver = redirect
19120 allow_filter
19121 check_local_user
19122 file = $home/.forward
19123 file_transport = address_file
19124 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19125 reply_transport = address_reply
19126 no_verify
19127 skip_syntax_errors
19128 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19129 syntax_errors_text = \
19130 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19131 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19132 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19133 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19134 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19135 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19136 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19137 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19138 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19139 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19140 .endd
19141 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19142 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19143 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19144 .code
19145 real_localuser:
19146 driver = accept
19147 check_local_user
19148 local_part_prefix = real-
19149 transport = local_delivery
19150 .endd
19151 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19152 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19153 .code
19154 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19155 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19156 .endd
19157
19158
19159 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19160 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19161
19162
19163 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19164 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19165 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19166 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19167
19168
19169
19170
19171
19172
19173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19175
19176 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19177 "Environment for local transports"
19178 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19179 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19180 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19181 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19182 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19183 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19184 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19185
19186 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19187 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19188 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19189 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19190
19191 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19192 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19193 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19194 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19195 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19196
19197
19198
19199 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19200 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19201 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19202 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19203 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19204 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19205 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19206 time.
19207
19208 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19209 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19210 .code
19211 my_transport:
19212 driver = pipe
19213 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19214 .endd
19215 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19216 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19217 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19218 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19219
19220
19221
19222
19223 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19224 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19225 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19226 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19227 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19228 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19229 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19230 group (set by the transport). For example:
19231 .code
19232 # Routers ...
19233 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19234 local_users:
19235 driver = accept
19236 check_local_user
19237 transport = group_delivery
19238
19239 # Transports ...
19240 # This transport overrides the group
19241 group_delivery:
19242 driver = appendfile
19243 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19244 group = mail
19245 .endd
19246 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19247 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19248 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19249 set.
19250
19251 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19252 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19253 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19254 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19255 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19256 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19257
19258 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19259 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19260 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19261 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19262 original gid is also used.
19263
19264 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19265 following that is set is used:
19266
19267 .ilist
19268 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19269 .next
19270 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19271 .next
19272 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19273 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19274 .next
19275 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19276 .next
19277 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19278 the uid is the creator's uid;
19279 .next
19280 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19281 .endlist
19282
19283 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19284 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19285 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19286 The first of the following that is set is used:
19287
19288 .ilist
19289 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19290 .next
19291 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19292 .next
19293 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19294 .next
19295 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19296 .next
19297 The Exim uid.
19298 .endlist
19299
19300 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19301 &%never_users%& list.
19302
19303
19304
19305
19306
19307 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19308 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19309 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19310 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19311 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19312 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19313 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19314 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19315 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19316 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19317
19318 .ilist
19319 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19320 .next
19321 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19322 .next
19323 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19324 .next
19325 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19326 .endlist
19327
19328 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19329
19330 .ilist
19331 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19332 .next
19333 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19334 .endlist
19335
19336
19337 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19338 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19339 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19340
19341
19342
19343 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19344 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19345 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19346 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19347 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19348 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19349 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19350 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19351 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19352 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19353 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19354 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19355 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19356 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19357
19358
19359
19360
19361
19362
19363
19364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19366
19367 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19368 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19369 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19370 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19371 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19372
19373
19374 .option body_only transports boolean false
19375 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19376 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19377 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19378 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19379 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19380 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19381 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19382 automatically suppress them.
19383
19384
19385 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19386 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19387 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19388 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19389 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19390 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19391
19392
19393 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19394 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19395 deliveries by the transport or for any
19396 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19397 what you are doing.
19398
19399
19400 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19401 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19402 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19403 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19404 transport is run.
19405 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19406 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19407 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19408 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19409 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19410 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19411 one.
19412
19413
19414 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19415 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19416 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19417 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19418 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19419 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19420 safely be resent to other recipients.
19421
19422
19423 .option driver transports string unset
19424 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19425 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19426
19427
19428 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19429 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19430 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19431 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19432 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19433 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19434 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19435 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19436 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19437 resent to other recipients.
19438
19439
19440 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19441 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19442 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19443 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19444 &%user%& (see below).
19445
19446
19447 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19448 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19449 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19450 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19451 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19452 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19453 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19454 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19455 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19456
19457
19458
19459 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19460 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19461 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19462 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19463 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19464 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19465 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19466 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19467
19468
19469 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19470 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19471 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19472 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19473 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19474 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19475 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19476 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19477 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19478
19479
19480
19481 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19482 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19483 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19484 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19485 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19486 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19487 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19488 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19489 example,
19490 .code
19491 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19492 x@y w@z
19493 .endd
19494 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19495 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19496 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19497 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19498 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19499 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19500 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19501 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19502 change envelope recipients at this time.
19503
19504
19505 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19506 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19507 .vindex "&$home$&"
19508 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19509 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19510 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19511 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19512 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19513 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19514 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19515 deferred.
19516
19517
19518 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19519 .cindex "additional groups"
19520 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19521 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19522 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19523 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19524 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19525
19526
19527 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19528 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19529 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19530 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19531 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19532 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19533 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19534 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19535 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19536 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19537 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19538 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19539 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19540 delivered.
19541
19542
19543
19544 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19545 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19546 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19547 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19548 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19549 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19550 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19551 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19552 that contains
19553 .code
19554 local_part_prefix = *-
19555 .endd
19556 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19557 is delivered with
19558 .code
19559 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19560 .endd
19561 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19562 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19563 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19564 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19565 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19566
19567
19568 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19569 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19570 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19571 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19572 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19573 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19574 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19575 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19576 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19577
19578 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19579 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19580 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19581 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19582
19583 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19584 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19585 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19586
19587
19588 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19589 .cindex "envelope sender"
19590 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19591 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19592 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19593 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19594 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19595 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19596 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19597 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19598 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19599
19600 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19601 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19602
19603 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19604 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19605 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19606 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19607 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19608 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19609 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19610
19611 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19612 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19613 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19614 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19615 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19616
19617
19618
19619 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19620 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19621 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19622 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19623 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19624 have easy access to it.
19625
19626 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19627 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19628 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19629 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19630 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19631 recipients.
19632
19633
19634 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19635 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19636
19637
19638 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19639 .cindex "shadow transport"
19640 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19641 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19642 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19643
19644 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19645 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19646 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19647 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19648 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19649 cause a log line to be written.
19650
19651 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19652 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19653 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19654 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19655 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19656 of the form
19657 .code
19658 ST=<shadow transport name>
19659 .endd
19660 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19661 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19662 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19663 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19664 headers that some sites insist on.
19665
19666
19667 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19668 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19669 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19670 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19671 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19672 individual users or via a system filter.
19673
19674 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19675 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19676 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19677 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19678 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19679
19680 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19681 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19682 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19683 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19684 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19685 &(pipe)& transports.
19686
19687 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19688 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19689 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19690 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19691 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19692
19693 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19694 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19695 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19696 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19697
19698 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19699 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19700 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19701 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19702 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19703 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19704
19705 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19706 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19707 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19708 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19709 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19710 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19711 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19712 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19713
19714 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19715 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19716 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19717 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19718 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19719 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19720 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19721 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19722 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19723 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19724
19725 .vindex "&$host$&"
19726 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19727 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19728 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19729 which the message is being sent. For example:
19730 .code
19731 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19732 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19733 .endd
19734
19735 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19736 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19737 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19738 .ilist
19739 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19740 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19741 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19742 example:
19743 .code
19744 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19745 .endd
19746 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19747 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19748 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19749 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19750 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19751 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19752 .next
19753 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19754 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19755 arguments. Consider this example:
19756 .code
19757 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19758 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19759 .endd
19760 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19761 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19762 .code
19763 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19764 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19765 .endd
19766 .endlist
19767
19768 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19769 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19770 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19771 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19772 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19773 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19774 bounced from a transport filter.
19775
19776 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19777 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19778 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19779
19780
19781 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19782 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19783 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19784 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19785 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19786 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19787 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19788 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19789 becomes a temporary error.
19790
19791
19792 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19793 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19794 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19795 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19796 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19797 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19798 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19799 option is not set.
19800
19801 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19802 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19803 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19804
19805 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19806 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19807 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19808 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19809 retry data.
19810 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19811 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19812 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19813
19814
19815
19816
19817
19818
19819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19820 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19821
19822 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19823 "Address batching"
19824 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19825 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19826 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19827 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19828 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19829 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19830 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19831
19832 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19833 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19834 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19835 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19836 local transport, for example:
19837
19838 .ilist
19839 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19840 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19841 recipients saves space.
19842 .next
19843 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19844 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19845 .next
19846 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19847 to a scanner program or
19848 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19849 acceptable.
19850 .endlist
19851
19852 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19853 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19854 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19855
19856 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19857 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19858 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19859 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19860 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19861 to certain conditions:
19862
19863 .ilist
19864 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19865 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19866 batching is possible.
19867 .next
19868 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19869 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19870 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19871 .next
19872 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19873 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19874 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19875 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19876 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19877 from taking place.
19878 .next
19879 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19880 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19881 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19882 be the same.
19883 .endlist
19884
19885 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19886 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19887 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19888 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19889 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19890 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19891 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19892 .code
19893 check_string = "."
19894 escape_string = ".."
19895 .endd
19896 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19897 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19898 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19899
19900 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19901 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19902 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19903 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19904 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19905 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19906
19907 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19908 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19909 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19910 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19911 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19912 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19913 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19914 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19915 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19916
19917
19918
19919
19920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19921 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19922
19923 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19924 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19925 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19926 .cindex "directory creation"
19927 .cindex "creating directories"
19928 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19929 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19930 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19931 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19932 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19933 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19934 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19935 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19936 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19937 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19938
19939 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19940 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19941 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19942 included.
19943
19944 .cindex "quota" "system"
19945 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19946 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19947 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19948
19949 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19950 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19951 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19952 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19953
19954 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19955 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19956 private options.
19957
19958 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19959 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19960 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19961 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19962 option).
19963
19964
19965
19966 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19967 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19968 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19969 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19970 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19971
19972 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19973 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19974 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19975 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19976 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19977 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19978 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19979 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19980 operation. There are two cases:
19981
19982 .ilist
19983 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19984 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19985 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19986 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19987 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19988 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19989 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19990 .next
19991 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19992 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19993 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19994 .endlist
19995
19996
19997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19998 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19999 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20000 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20001 form:
20002 .code
20003 save folder23
20004 .endd
20005 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20006 .code
20007 require "fileinto";
20008 fileinto "folder23";
20009 .endd
20010 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20011 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20012 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20013 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20014 way of handling this requirement:
20015 .code
20016 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20017 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20018 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20019 {$address_file} \
20020 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20021 }} \
20022 }
20023 .endd
20024 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20025 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20026 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20027
20028 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20029 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20030 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20031 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20032 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20033 path to the transport.
20034
20035 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20036 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20037
20038
20039
20040
20041 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20042 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20043
20044
20045
20046 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20047 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20048 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20049 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20050 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20051 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20052 delivery is deferred.
20053
20054
20055 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20056 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20057 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20058 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20059 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20060 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20061 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20062 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20063
20064
20065 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20066 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20067 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20068 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20069 file.
20070
20071
20072 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20073 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20074
20075
20076 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20077 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20078 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20079 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20080 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20081
20082
20083 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20084 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20085 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20086 process is running.
20087
20088
20089 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20090 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20091 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20092 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20093 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20094 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20095 contains is significant.
20096
20097 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20098 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20099 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20100 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20101 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20102
20103 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20104 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20105 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20106 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20107 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20108 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20109 .code
20110 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20111 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20112 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20113 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20114 .endd
20115 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20116 .cindex "directory creation"
20117 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20118 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20119 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20120
20121 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20122 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20123 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20124 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20125 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20126
20127
20128
20129 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20130 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20131 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20132 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20133 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20134 beneath.
20135
20136 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20137 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20138 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20139 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20140 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20141 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20142 &%file_must_exist%&.
20143
20144
20145 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20146 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20147 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20148 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20149
20150 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20151 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20152 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20153 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20154 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20155
20156
20157 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20158 .cindex "base62"
20159 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20160 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20161 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20162 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20163 .code
20164 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20165 .endd
20166 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20167 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20168 option.
20169
20170
20171 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20172 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20173 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20174
20175
20176 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20177 See &%check_string%& above.
20178
20179
20180 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20181 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20182 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20183 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20184 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20185 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20186 &%file%&.
20187
20188 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20189 .cindex "locking files"
20190 .cindex "lock files"
20191 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20192 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20193
20194 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20195 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20196 examples:
20197 .code
20198 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20199 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20200 file = $home/inbox
20201 .endd
20202 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20203 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20204 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20205 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20206 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20207 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20208
20209
20210
20211 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20212 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20213 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20214 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20215 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20216 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20217 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20218 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20219 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20220 this added to it:
20221 .code
20222 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20223 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20224 .endd
20225 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20226 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20227 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20228 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20229 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20230 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20231 delivery is deferred.
20232
20233
20234 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20235 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20236 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20237 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20238
20239
20240 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20241 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20242 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20243 .cindex "locking files"
20244 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20245 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20246 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20247 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20248 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20249 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20250 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20251 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20252
20253 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20254 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20255 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20256 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20257
20258 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20259 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20260 retries is
20261 .code
20262 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20263 .endd
20264 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20265 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20266 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20267
20268 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20269 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20270 .code
20271 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20272 .endd
20273
20274 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20275 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20276 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20277 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20278
20279
20280 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20281 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20282 for details of locking.
20283
20284
20285 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20286 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20287 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20288
20289
20290 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20291 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20292 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20293
20294
20295 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20296 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20297 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20298 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20299 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20300
20301
20302 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20303 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20304 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20305 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20306 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20307 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20308 external source that maintains the data.
20309
20310
20311 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20312 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20313 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20314 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20315 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20316 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20317 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20318 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20319
20320
20321
20322 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20323 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20324 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20325 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20326 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20327 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20328 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20329 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20330 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20331 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20332
20333
20334 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20335 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20336 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20337 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20338 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20339 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20340 calculation. The default value is:
20341 .code
20342 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20343 .endd
20344 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20345 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20346 &_Trash_&
20347 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20348 .code
20349 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20350 .endd
20351 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20352 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20353 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20354 directly into that directory.
20355
20356
20357 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20358 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20359 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20360
20361
20362 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20363 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20364 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20365
20366
20367 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20368 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20369 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20370 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20371 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20372 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20373 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20374 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20375
20376 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20377 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20378 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20379 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20380 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20381 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20382 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20383 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20384 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20385 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20386
20387
20388 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20389 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20390 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20391 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20392 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20393 below for further details.
20394
20395
20396 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20397 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20398 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20399
20400
20401 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20402 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20403 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20404
20405
20406 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20407 .cindex "locking files"
20408 .cindex "file" "locking"
20409 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20410 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20411 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20412 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20413 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20414 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20415 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20416
20417 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20418 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20419 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20420 combination:
20421 .code
20422 mbx_format = true
20423 message_prefix =
20424 message_suffix =
20425 .endd
20426 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20427 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20428 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20429 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20430 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20431 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20432 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20433 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20434
20435 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20436 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20437 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20438 append messages to it.
20439
20440
20441 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20442 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20443 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20444 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20445 in which case it is:
20446 .code
20447 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20448 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20449 .endd
20450 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20451 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20452
20453 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20454 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20455 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20456 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20457 setting
20458 .code
20459 message_suffix =
20460 .endd
20461 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20462 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20463
20464 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20465 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20466 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20467 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20468 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20469 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20470 value, and this option is ignored.
20471
20472
20473 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20474 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20475 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20476 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20477 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20478
20479
20480 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20481 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20482 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20483 on users about incoming mail.
20484
20485
20486 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20487 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20488 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20489 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20490 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20491 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20492 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20493 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20494 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20495
20496 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20497 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20498 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20499
20500 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20501 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20502 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20503 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20504 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20505 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20506
20507 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20508 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20509 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20510 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20511 be handled.
20512
20513 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20514
20515 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20516 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20517 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20518 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20519 system quota failures.
20520
20521 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20522 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20523 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20524 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20525 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20526 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20527 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20528 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20529 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20530 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20531
20532
20533 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20534 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20535 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20536 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20537 delivery directory.
20538
20539
20540 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20541 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20542 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20543 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20544 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20545 &"no quota"&.
20546
20547
20548 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20549 See &%quota%& above.
20550
20551
20552 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20553 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20554 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20555 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20556 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20557 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20558 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20559
20560 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20561 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20562 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20563 the file length to the file name. For example:
20564 .code
20565 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20566 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20567 .endd
20568 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20569 number of lines in the message.
20570
20571 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20572 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20573 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20574
20575 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20576
20577
20578 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20579 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20580 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20581 .code
20582 quota_warn_message = "\
20583 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20584 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20585 This message is automatically created \
20586 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20587 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20588 a warning threshold that is\n\
20589 set by the system administrator.\n"
20590 .endd
20591
20592
20593 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20594 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20595 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20596 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20597 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20598 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20599 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20600 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20601 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20602 sign. For example:
20603 .code
20604 quota = 10M
20605 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20606 .endd
20607 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20608 percent sign is ignored.
20609
20610 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20611 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20612 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20613 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20614 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20615 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20616 .code
20617 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20618 .endd
20619 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20620 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20621 option.
20622
20623 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20624 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20625 percentage.
20626
20627
20628 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20629 .cindex "envelope sender"
20630 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20631 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20632 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20633 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20634 for details of batch SMTP.
20635
20636
20637 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20638 .cindex "carriage return"
20639 .cindex "linefeed"
20640 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20641 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20642 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20643 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20644
20645 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20646 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20647 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20648 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20649 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20650 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20651
20652
20653 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20654 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20655 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20656 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20657 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20658 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20659
20660
20661 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20662 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20663 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20664 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20665 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20666
20667 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20668 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20669 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20670 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20671
20672 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20673 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20674 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20675 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20676 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20677 error.
20678
20679 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20680 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20681
20682
20683 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20684 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20685 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20686 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20687 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20688 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20689 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20690
20691 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20692 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20693 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20694 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20695 file corruption.
20696
20697 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20698 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20699 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20700
20701
20702 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20703 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20704 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20705 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20706 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20707 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20708 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20709 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20710 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20711
20712 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20713 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20714 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20715 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20716
20717
20718
20719
20720 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20721 .cindex "appending to a file"
20722 .cindex "file" "appending"
20723 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20724
20725 .ilist
20726 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20727 return is given.
20728
20729 .next
20730 .cindex "directory creation"
20731 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20732 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20733 &%directory_mode%& option.
20734
20735 .next
20736 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20737 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20738 transport.
20739
20740 .next
20741 .cindex "file" "locking"
20742 .cindex "locking files"
20743 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20744 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20745 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20746
20747 .olist
20748 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20749 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20750 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20751 .next
20752 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20753 .next
20754 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20755 Unlink the hitching post name.
20756 .next
20757 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20758 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20759 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20760 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20761 .next
20762 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20763 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20764 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20765 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20766 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20767 it before trying again.
20768 .endlist olist
20769
20770 .next
20771 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20772 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20773 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20774
20775 .next
20776 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20777 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20778 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20779 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20780 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20781 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20782 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20783 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20784 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20785 checked.
20786
20787 .next
20788 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20789 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20790 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20791 delivery is deferred.
20792
20793 .next
20794 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20795 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20796 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20797 permissions.
20798
20799 .next
20800 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20801 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20802 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20803
20804 .next
20805 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20806 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20807 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20808
20809 .next
20810 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20811 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20812 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20813 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20814 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20815 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20816 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20817 that prevents link following.
20818
20819 .next
20820 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20821 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20822 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20823 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20824 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20825
20826 .next
20827 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20828
20829 .next
20830 .cindex "file" "locking"
20831 .cindex "locking files"
20832 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20833 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20834 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20835 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20836 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20837 .code
20838 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20839 .endd
20840 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20841 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20842 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20843
20844 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20845 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20846 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20847
20848 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20849 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20850 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20851 delivery is deferred.
20852
20853 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20854 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20855 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20856 immediately. It retries up to
20857 .code
20858 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20859 .endd
20860 times (rounded up).
20861 .endlist
20862
20863 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20864 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20865
20866
20867 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20868 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20869 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20870 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20871 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20872 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20873 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20874 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20875 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20876 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20877
20878 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20879 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20880 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20881 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20882 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20883 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20884 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20885
20886 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20887 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20888 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20889 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20890
20891
20892 .cindex "maildir format"
20893 .cindex "mailstore format"
20894 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20895 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20896 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20897 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20898 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20899
20900 .cindex "directory creation"
20901 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20902 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20903 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20904 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20905 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20906 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20907 deferred.
20908
20909
20910
20911 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20912 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20913 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20914 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20915 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20916 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20917 &_new_& subdirectory.
20918
20919 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20920 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20921 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20922 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20923 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20924 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20925 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20926
20927 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20928 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20929 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20930 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20931 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20932 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20933 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20934 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20935
20936 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20937 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20938 folders. Consider this example:
20939 .code
20940 maildir_format = true
20941 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20942 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20943 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20944 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20945 .endd
20946 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20947 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20948 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20949 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20950 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20951 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20952
20953 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20954 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20955 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20956 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20957 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20958
20959 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20960 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20961 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20962
20963 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20964 .cindex "maildir++"
20965 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20966 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20967 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20968 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20969 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20970 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20971 amount of space used.
20972
20973 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20974 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20975 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20976 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20977 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20978 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20979
20980
20981
20982
20983 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20984 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20985 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20986 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20987 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20988 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20989
20990
20991 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20992 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20993 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20994 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20995 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20996 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20997 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20998 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20999 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21000 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21001 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21002 backwards compatibility).
21003
21004 For one common implementation, you might set:
21005 .code
21006 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21007 .endd
21008 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21009
21010 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21011 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21012 &[stat()]& each message file.
21013
21014
21015 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21016 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21017 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21018 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21019 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21020 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21021 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21022 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21023 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21024
21025 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21026 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21027 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21028 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21029 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21030 need to know the quota.
21031
21032 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21033 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21034
21035 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21036 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21037 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21038 details.
21039
21040
21041 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21042 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21043 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21044 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21045 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21046 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21047 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21048 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21049
21050 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21051 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21052 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21053 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21054 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21055 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21056
21057 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21058 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21059 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21060 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21061 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21062 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21063
21064 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21065 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21066 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21067 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21068
21069
21070 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21071 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21072 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21073 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21074 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21075 .code
21076 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21077 .endd
21078 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21079 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21080 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21081 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21082 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21083
21084
21085
21086
21087
21088
21089 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21090 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21091
21092 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21093 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21094 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21095 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21096 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21097 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21098 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21099 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21100
21101 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21102 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21103 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21104 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21105 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21106
21107
21108 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21109 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21110 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21111 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21112 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21113
21114 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21115 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21116 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21117 transport is run as a consequence of a
21118 &%mail%&
21119 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21120 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21121 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21122 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21123 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21124 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21125
21126 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21127 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21128 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21129 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21130
21131 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21132 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21133 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21134 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21135 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21136 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21137 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21138
21139 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21140 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21141 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21142 the transport defers.
21143 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21144 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21145
21146 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21147 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21148 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21149 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21150
21151 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21152 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21153 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21154 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21155 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21156 problems. They are just discarded.
21157
21158
21159
21160 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21161 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21162
21163 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21164 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21165 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21166
21167
21168 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21169 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21170 when the message is specified by the transport.
21171
21172
21173 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21174 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21175 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21176 string comes first.
21177
21178
21179 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21180 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21181 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21182
21183
21184 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21185 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21186 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21187
21188
21189 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21190 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21191 specified by the transport.
21192
21193
21194 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21195 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21196 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21197 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21198
21199
21200 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21201 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21202 the message is specified by the transport.
21203
21204
21205 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21206 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21207 used.
21208
21209
21210 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21211 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21212 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21213 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21214 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21215
21216
21217
21218 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21219 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21220 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21221 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21222
21223 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21224 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21225 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21226 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21227 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21228 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21229 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21230 infinity.
21231
21232 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21233 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21234 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21235 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21236 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21237
21238 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21239 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21240 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21241 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21242 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21243 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21244
21245
21246 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21247 See &%once%& above.
21248
21249
21250 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21251 See &%once%& above.
21252 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21253
21254
21255 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21256 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21257 specified by the transport.
21258
21259
21260 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21261 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21262 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21263 configuration option.
21264
21265
21266 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21267 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21268 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21269 automatic responses. For example:
21270 .code
21271 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21272 .endd
21273 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21274 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21275 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21276 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21277 small.
21278
21279
21280
21281 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21282 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21283 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21284 the text comes first.
21285
21286
21287 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21288 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21289 when the message is specified by the transport.
21290 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21291 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21292
21293
21294
21295
21296 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21297 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21298
21299 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21300 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21301 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21302 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21303 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21304 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21305 specified command
21306 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21307 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21308 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21309 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21310 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21311 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21312 .code
21313 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21314 .endd
21315 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21316 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21317 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21318 as follows:
21319
21320 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21321 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21322
21323
21324 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21325 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21326 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21327 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21328 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21329
21330
21331 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21332 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21333 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21334 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21335 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21336 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21337 LMTP protocol.
21338
21339 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21340 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21341 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21342 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21343 in its response to the LHLO command.
21344
21345 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21346 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21347 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21348 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21349
21350
21351 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21352 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21353 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21354 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21355 LMTP transport:
21356 .code
21357 lmtp:
21358 driver = lmtp
21359 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21360 batch_max = 20
21361 user = exim
21362 .endd
21363 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21364 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21365
21366
21367
21368 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21369 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21370
21371 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21372 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21373 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21374 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21375 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21376 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21377 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21378 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21379 following ways:
21380
21381 .ilist
21382 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21383 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21384 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21385 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21386 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21387 .next
21388 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21389 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21390 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21391 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21392 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21393 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21394 that are routed to the transport.
21395 .next
21396 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21397 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21398 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21399 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21400 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21401 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21402 the local part that was redirected.
21403 .endlist
21404
21405
21406 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21407 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21408 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21409
21410 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21411 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21412 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21413 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21414 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21415 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21416 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21417
21418
21419 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21420 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21421 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21422 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21423 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21424
21425
21426
21427
21428 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21429 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21430 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21431 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21432 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21433 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21434 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21435 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21436 &"local delivery failed"&.
21437
21438 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21439 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21440 will be sent as normal.
21441
21442 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21443 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21444 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21445 apply in this case.
21446
21447 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21448 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21449 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21450 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21451
21452 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21453 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21454 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21455 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21456 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21457 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21458 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21459 &%temp_errors%&.
21460
21461
21462
21463 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21464 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21465 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21466 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21467 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21468 run.
21469
21470 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21471 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21472 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21473 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21474
21475 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21476 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21477 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21478 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21479 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21480 .code
21481 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21482 .endd
21483 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21484 arguments. You have to write
21485 .code
21486 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21487 .endd
21488 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21489 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21490 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21491 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21492 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21493 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21494 example:
21495 .code
21496 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21497 .endd
21498
21499 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21500 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21501 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21502 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21503 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21504 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21505 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21506 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21507 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21508 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21509
21510 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21511 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21512 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21513 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21514 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21515 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21516 control what is done with it.
21517
21518 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21519 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21520 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21521 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21522 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21523 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21524 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21525 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21526 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21527 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21528 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21529
21530
21531
21532 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21533 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21534 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21535 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21536 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21537 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21538 environment.
21539 .display
21540 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21541 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21542 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21543 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21544 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21545 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21546 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21547 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21548 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21549 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21550 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21551 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21552 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21553 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21554 &`USER `& see below
21555 .endd
21556 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21557 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21558 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21559 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21560 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21561 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21562 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21563
21564 .cindex "HOST"
21565 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21566 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21567 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21568 the router.
21569
21570 .cindex "HOME"
21571 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21572 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21573 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21574 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21575
21576
21577 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21578 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21579
21580
21581
21582 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21583 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21584 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21585 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21586 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21587 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21588 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21589 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21590 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21591 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21592 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21593 example, if
21594 .code
21595 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21596 .endd
21597 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21598 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21599 &%use_shell%& is set.
21600
21601
21602 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21603 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21604
21605
21606 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21607 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21608 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21609
21610
21611 .option check_string pipe string unset
21612 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21613 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21614 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21615 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21616 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21617 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21618 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21619 ignored.
21620
21621
21622 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21623 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21624 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21625 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21626 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21627 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21628 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21629
21630
21631 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21632 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21633 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21634 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21635 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21636 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21637 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21638
21639
21640 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21641 See &%check_string%& above.
21642
21643
21644 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21645 .cindex "exec failure"
21646 .cindex "failure of exec"
21647 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21648 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21649 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21650 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21651 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21652
21653
21654 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21655 .cindex "signal exit"
21656 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21657 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21658 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21659 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21660
21661
21662 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21663 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21664 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21665 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21666 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21667 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21668
21669 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21670 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21671
21672 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21673 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21674 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21675 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21676 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21677
21678
21679 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21680 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21681 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21682 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21683 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21684 Only one of them may be set.
21685
21686
21687
21688 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21689 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21690 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21691 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21692
21693
21694
21695 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21696 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21697 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21698 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21699 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21700 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21701 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21702 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21703
21704
21705 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21706 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21707 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21708 .code
21709 message_prefix = \
21710 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21711 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
21712 .endd
21713 .cindex "Cyrus"
21714 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21716 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21717 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21718 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21719 setting
21720 .code
21721 message_prefix =
21722 .endd
21723 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21724 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21725
21726
21727 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21728 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21729 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21730 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21731 .code
21732 message_suffix =
21733 .endd
21734 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21735 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21736
21737
21738 .option path pipe string "see below"
21739 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21740 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21741 .code
21742 /bin:/usr/bin
21743 .endd
21744 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21745 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21746 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21747
21748
21749 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21750 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21751 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21752 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21753 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21754 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21755 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21756 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21757 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21758
21759
21760 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21761 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21762 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21763 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21764 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21765 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21766 accept the message is used.
21767
21768
21769 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21770 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21771 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21772 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21773 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21774 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21775
21776
21777 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21778 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21779 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21780 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21781 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21782 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21783 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21784
21785
21786
21787 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21788 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21789 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21790 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21791 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21792 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21793 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21794 of them may be set.
21795
21796
21797
21798 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21799 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21800 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21801 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21802 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21803 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21804 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21805 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21806 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21807 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21808 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21809 and 73, respectively.
21810
21811
21812 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21813 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21814 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21815 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21816 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21817 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21818 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21819
21820 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21821 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21822 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21823 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21824 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21825 delivery to be deferred.
21826
21827 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21828 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21829
21830
21831 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21832 .cindex "envelope sender"
21833 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21834 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21835 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21836 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21837 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21838
21839 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21840 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21841 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21842 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21843 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21844 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21845 class database.
21846
21847
21848 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21849 .cindex "carriage return"
21850 .cindex "linefeed"
21851 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21852 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21853 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21854 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21855
21856 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21857 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21858 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21859 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21860 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21861
21862
21863 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21864 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21865 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21866 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21867 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21868 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21869 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21870 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21871 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21872 its &%-c%& option.
21873
21874
21875
21876 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21877 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21878 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21879 .cindex "external local delivery"
21880 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21881 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21882 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21883 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21884 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21885 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21886 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21887 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21888 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21889 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21890 .code
21891 # transport
21892 procmail_pipe:
21893 driver = pipe
21894 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21895 return_path_add
21896 delivery_date_add
21897 envelope_to_add
21898 check_string = "From "
21899 escape_string = ">From "
21900 umask = 077
21901 user = $local_part
21902 group = mail
21903
21904 # router
21905 procmail:
21906 driver = accept
21907 check_local_user
21908 transport = procmail_pipe
21909 .endd
21910 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21911 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21912 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21913 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21914 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21915 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21916
21917 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21918 .code
21919 IFS=" "
21920 .endd
21921 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21922 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21923
21924 .cindex "Cyrus"
21925 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21926 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21927 .code
21928 # transport
21929 local_delivery_cyrus:
21930 driver = pipe
21931 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21932 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21933 user = cyrus
21934 group = mail
21935 return_output
21936 log_output
21937 message_prefix =
21938 message_suffix =
21939
21940 # router
21941 local_user_cyrus:
21942 driver = accept
21943 check_local_user
21944 local_part_suffix = .*
21945 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21946 .endd
21947 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21948 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21949 sender.
21950 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21951 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21952
21953
21954 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21955 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21956
21957 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21958 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21959 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21960 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21961 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21962 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21963 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21964 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21965
21966
21967 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21968 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21969 two ways:
21970
21971 .ilist
21972 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21973 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21974 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21975 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21976 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21977 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21978 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21979 .next
21980 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21981 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21982 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21983 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21984 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21985 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21986 process.
21987 .endlist
21988
21989
21990 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21991 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21992 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21993
21994
21995
21996 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21997 .vindex "&$host$&"
21998 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21999 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22000 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22001 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22002 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22003 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22004 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22005 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22006
22007
22008 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22009 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22010 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22011 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22012 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22013 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22014 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22015 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22016 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22017 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22018 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22019 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22020 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22021 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22022
22023
22024 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22025 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22026 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22027
22028
22029 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22030 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22031 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22032 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22033 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22034 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22035 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22036 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22037
22038 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22039 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22040 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22041 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22042 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22043 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22044 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22045 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22046 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22047
22048
22049 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22050 .cindex "Cyrus"
22051 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22052 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22053 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22054 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22055 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22056 ignored.
22057
22058 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22059 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22060 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22061 particular connection.
22062
22063 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22064 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22065 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22066 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22067
22068 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22069 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22070 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22071 .code
22072 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22073 .endd
22074 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22075 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22076
22077 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22078 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22079 value.
22080
22081
22082 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22083 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22084 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22085 authenticated as a client.
22086
22087
22088 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22089 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22090 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22091 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22092
22093
22094 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22095 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22096 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22097 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22098 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22099 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22100 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22101
22102
22103 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22104 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22105 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22106 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22107 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22108 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22109 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22110 option.
22111
22112
22113 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22114 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22115 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22116 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22117
22118
22119 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22120 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22121 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22122 cutoff times.
22123
22124 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22125 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22126 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22127 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22128 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22129 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22130
22131 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22132 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22133 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22134 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22135 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22136 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22137 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22138 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22139 to them.
22140
22141
22142 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22143 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22144 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22145 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22146 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22147
22148
22149 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22150 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22151 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22152 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22153 details.
22154
22155
22156 .new
22157 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22158 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22159 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22160 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22161 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22162 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22163 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22164
22165 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22166 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22167 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22168 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22169 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22170 .wen
22171
22172
22173 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22174 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22175 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22176 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22177 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22178 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22179 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22180 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22181
22182 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22183 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22184 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22185 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22186 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22187 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22188
22189 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22190 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22191 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22192 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22193 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22194
22195 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22196 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22197 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22198 copy of the message is sent.
22199
22200 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22201 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22202 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22203 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22204 fails"& facility.
22205
22206
22207 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22208 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22209 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22210 zero.
22211
22212 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22213 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22214 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22215 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22216 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22217 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22218
22219 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22220 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22221 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22222 implementations of TLS.
22223
22224 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22225 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22226 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22227 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22228 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22229 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22230 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22231 option is:
22232 .code
22233 $primary_hostname
22234 .endd
22235 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22236 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22237 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22238 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22239 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22240 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22241 interface address, you could use this:
22242 .code
22243 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22244 {$primary_hostname}}
22245 .endd
22246 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22247 callouts.
22248
22249 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22250 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22251 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22252 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22253 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22254 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22255
22256 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22257 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22258 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22259 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22260
22261 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22262 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22263 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22264 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22265 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22266 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22267 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22268
22269 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22270 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22271 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22272 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22273 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22274 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22275 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22276 address are used.
22277
22278 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22279 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22280
22281
22282 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22283 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22284 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22285 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22286 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22287 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22288 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22289 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22290 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22291 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22292
22293
22294 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22295 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22296 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22297 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22298
22299
22300 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22301 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22302 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22303 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22304
22305
22306 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22307 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22308 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22309 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22310 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22311 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22312 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22313 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22314
22315
22316 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22317 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22318 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22319 why it exists.
22320
22321
22322
22323 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22324 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22325 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22326 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22327 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22328 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22329 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22330 explanation of when this might be needed.
22331
22332
22333 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22334 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22335 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22336 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22337 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22338
22339
22340 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22341 .cindex "randomized host list"
22342 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22343 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22344 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22345 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22346 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22347 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22348 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22349 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22350
22351 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22352 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22353 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22354 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22355 .code
22356 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22357 .endd
22358 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22359 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22360 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22361
22362 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22363 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22364 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22365 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22366 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22367 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22368 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22369 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22370 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22371
22372
22373 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22374 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22375 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22376 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22377 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22378 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22379
22380 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22381 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22382 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22383 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22384 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22385 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22386 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22387
22388 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22389 .cindex "bind IP address"
22390 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22391 .vindex "&$host$&"
22392 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22393 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22394 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22395 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22396 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22397 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22398 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22399 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22400 unknown.
22401
22402 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22403 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22404 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22405 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22406 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22407 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22408 .code
22409 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22410 .endd
22411 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22412 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22413 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22414 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22415
22416
22417 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22418 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22419 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22420 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22421 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22422 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22423 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22424 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22425 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22426 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22427 unreachable hosts.
22428
22429
22430 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22431 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22432 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22433 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22434 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22435
22436 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22437 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22438 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22439 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22440 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22441 permits this.
22442
22443
22444 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22445 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22446 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22447 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22448 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22449 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22450 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22451 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22452
22453
22454 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22455 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22456 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22457 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22458 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22459 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22460 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22461 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22462
22463 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22464 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22465 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22466 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22467 is deferred.
22468
22469
22470
22471 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22472 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22473 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22474 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22475 .vindex "&$port$&"
22476 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22477 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22478 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22479 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22480 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22481
22482 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22483 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22484 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22485 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22486
22487
22488 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22489 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22490 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22491 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22492 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22493 addresses is not affected.
22494
22495 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22496 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22497 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22498 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22499 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22500 hosts.
22501
22502
22503 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22504 .cindex "serializing connections"
22505 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22506 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22507 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22508 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22509 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22510 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22511 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22512
22513 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22514 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22515 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22516 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22517 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22518 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22519
22520 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22521 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22522 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22523 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22524 are used for ETRN serialization.
22525
22526
22527 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22528 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22529 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22530 .cindex "size" "of message"
22531 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22532 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22533 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22534 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22535 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22536 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22537 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22538 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22539
22540 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22541 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22542
22543
22544 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22545 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22546 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22547 .vindex "&$host$&"
22548 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22549 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22550 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22551 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22552 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22553 details of TLS.
22554
22555 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22556 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22557 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22558 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22559 client.
22560
22561
22562 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22563 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22564 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22565 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22566 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22567
22568
22569 .new
22570 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22571 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22572 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22573 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22574 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22575 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22576 will fail.
22577
22578 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22579 .wen
22580
22581
22582 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22583 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22584 .vindex "&$host$&"
22585 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22586 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22587 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22588 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22589 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22590 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22591 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22592 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22593
22594
22595 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22596 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22597 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22598 .vindex "&$host$&"
22599 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22600 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22601 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22602 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22603 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22604 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22605 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22606 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22607 ciphers is a preference order.
22608
22609
22610
22611 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22612 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22613 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22614 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_sni variable and causes any
22615 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22616 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22617 certificate and private key for the session.
22618
22619 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22620
22621 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
22622 TLS extensions.
22623
22624
22625
22626
22627 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22628 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22629 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22630 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22631 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22632 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22633 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22634 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22635 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22636 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22637 in clear.
22638
22639
22640 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22641 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22642 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22643 .vindex "&$host$&"
22644 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22645 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22646 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22647 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22648 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22649 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22650 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22651 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22652 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22653
22654
22655
22656
22657 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22658 "SECTvalhosmax"
22659 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22660 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22661 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22662 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22663 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22664
22665
22666 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22667 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22668 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22669 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22670 retrying.
22671
22672 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22673 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22674 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22675
22676 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22677 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22678 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22679 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22680 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22681
22682 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22683 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22684 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22685 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22686 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22687 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22688 see below for an exception).
22689
22690 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22691 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22692 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22693 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22694 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22695
22696 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22697 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22698 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22699 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22700 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22701 reached their retry times.
22702
22703 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22704 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22705 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22706 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22707 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22708 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22709 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22710 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22711 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22712 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22713 reached.
22714
22715 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22716 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22717 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22718 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22719 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22720 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22721
22722 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22723 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22724 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22725 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22726 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22727 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22728
22729
22730
22731
22732
22733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22735
22736 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22737 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22738 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22739 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22740 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22741 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22742
22743 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22744 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22745 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22746 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22747 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22748 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22749 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22750
22751 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22752 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22753 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22754 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22755
22756
22757 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22758 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22759 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22760 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22761
22762 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22763 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22764 facility; you do not have to use it.
22765
22766 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22767 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22768 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22769 address to which it applies.
22770
22771 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22772 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22773 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22774 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22775 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22776 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22777 rules.
22778
22779 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22780 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22781 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22782 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22783
22784
22785 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22786 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22787 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22788 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22789 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22790 discouraged.
22791
22792 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22793 illustrated by these examples:
22794
22795 .ilist
22796 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22797 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22798 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22799 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22800 .next
22801 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22802 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22803 .endlist
22804
22805
22806
22807 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22808 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22809 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22810 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22811 message's processing.
22812
22813 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22814 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22815 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22816 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22817 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22818 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22819 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22820 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22821 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22822
22823 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22824 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22825 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22826 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22827 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22828 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22829 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22830 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22831 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22832 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22833
22834 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22835 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22836 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22837 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22838 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22839 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22840
22841 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22842 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22843 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22844
22845 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22846 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22847 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22848 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22849 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22850 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22851 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22852 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22853 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22854
22855 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22856 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22857 transport time.
22858
22859
22860
22861
22862 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22863 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22864 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22865 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22866 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22867 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22868 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22869 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22870 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22871 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22872 .code
22873 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22874 .endd
22875 might produce the output
22876 .code
22877 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22878 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22879 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22880 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22881 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22882 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22883 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22884 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22885 .endd
22886 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22887 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22888 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22889 set for a particular transport.
22890
22891
22892 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22893 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22894 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22895 rules in the form
22896 .display
22897 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22898 .endd
22899 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22900 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22901 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22902 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22903
22904 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22905 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22906 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22907 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22908 ignored.
22909
22910 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22911 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22912 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22913
22914 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22915 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22916 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22917 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22918 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22919 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22920 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22921
22922 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22923 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22924 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22925 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22926 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22927 .code
22928 *@* ${lookup ...
22929 .endd
22930 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22931 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22932
22933
22934 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22935 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22936 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22937 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22938 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22939 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22940 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22941 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22942 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22943
22944 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22945 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22946 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22947
22948 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22949 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22950 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22951 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22952 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22953 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22954 of pattern they are set as follows:
22955
22956 .ilist
22957 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22958 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22959 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22960 pattern
22961 .code
22962 *queen@*.fict.example
22963 .endd
22964 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22965 .code
22966 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22967 $1 = hearts-
22968 $2 = wonderland
22969 .endd
22970 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22971 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22972
22973 .next
22974 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22975 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22976 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22977 rewriting rule of the form
22978 .display
22979 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22980 .endd
22981 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22982 .code
22983 $1 = foo
22984 $2 = bar
22985 $3 = baz.example
22986 .endd
22987 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22988 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22989 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22990 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22991 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22992 .endlist
22993
22994
22995 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22996 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22997 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22998 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22999 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23000 .code
23001 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23002 .endd
23003 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23004 &'From:'& headers.
23005
23006 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23007 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23008 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23009 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23010 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23011 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23012 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23013 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23014 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23015 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23016 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23017 entry written to the panic log.
23018
23019
23020
23021 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23022 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23023
23024 .ilist
23025 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23026 c, f, h, r, s, t.
23027 .next
23028 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23029 .next
23030 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23031 .endlist
23032
23033 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23034 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23035
23036
23037
23038 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23039 "SECID154"
23040 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23041 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23042 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23043 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23044 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23045 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23046 .display
23047 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23048 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23049 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23050 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23051 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23052 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23053 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23054 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23055 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23056 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23057 .endd
23058 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23059 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23060 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23061
23062 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23063 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23064
23065
23066 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23067 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23068 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23069 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23070 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23071 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23072 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23073 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23074 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23075
23076 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23077 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23078 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23079 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23080 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23081 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23082 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23083 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23084
23085
23086 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23087 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23088 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23089 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23090
23091 .ilist
23092 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23093 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23094 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23095 .next
23096 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23097 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23098 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23099 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23100 .next
23101 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23102 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23103 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23104 .next
23105 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23106 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23107 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23108 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23109 .code
23110 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23111 .endd
23112 into
23113 .code
23114 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23115 .endd
23116 .cindex "RFC 2047"
23117 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23118 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23119 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23120 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23121 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23122 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23123 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23124 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23125
23126 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23127 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23128 .endlist
23129
23130
23131 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23132 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23133 .code
23134 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23135 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23136 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23137 .endd
23138 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23139 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23140 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23141 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23142 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23143 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23144 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23145 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23146
23147 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23148 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23149 .code
23150 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23151 .endd
23152 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23153 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23154
23155 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23156 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23157 messages that originate outside the local host:
23158 .code
23159 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23160 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23161 .endd
23162 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23163 space.
23164
23165 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23166 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23167 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23168 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23169 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23170 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23171 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23172 components. For example, the rule
23173 .code
23174 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23175 .endd
23176 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23177 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23178 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23179 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23180 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23181 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23182 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23183 .ecindex IIDaddrew
23184
23185
23186
23187
23188
23189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23191
23192 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23193 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23194 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23195 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23196 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23197 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23198 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23199 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23200 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23201 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23202 address, domain and error.
23203
23204 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23205 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23206 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23207 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23208 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23209 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23210 log selector is set, the message
23211 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23212 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23213 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23214 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23215
23216 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23217 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23218 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23219 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23220 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23221 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23222 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23223 domain are maintained independently.
23224
23225 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23226 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23227 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23228 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23229 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23230 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23231 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23232 the local address is reached.
23233
23234 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23235 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23236 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23237 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23238 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23239
23240 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23241 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23242 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23243 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23244 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23245 messages that it should now be retaining.
23246
23247
23248
23249 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23250 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23251 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23252 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23253 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23254 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23255 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23256 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23257 message's sender, respectively.
23258
23259
23260 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23261 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23262 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23263 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23264 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23265 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23266 example,
23267 .code
23268 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23269 .endd
23270 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23271 whereas
23272 .code
23273 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23274 .endd
23275 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23276 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23277 part.
23278
23279 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23280 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
23281 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23282 expressions work in address lists.
23283 .display
23284 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23285 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23286 .endd
23287
23288
23289 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23290 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23291 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23292 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23293 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23294 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23295 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23296 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23297 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23298
23299 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23300 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23301 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23302 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23303 local transports).
23304
23305 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23306 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23307 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23308 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23309 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23310 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23311 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23312 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23313 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23314 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23315 commands.
23316
23317
23318
23319 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23320 "SECID160"
23321 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23322 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23323 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23324 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23325 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23326 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23327 .code
23328 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23329 MX 6 p.q.r.example
23330 MX 7 m.n.o.example
23331 .endd
23332 and the retry rules are
23333 .code
23334 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23335 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23336 .endd
23337 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23338 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23339 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23340 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23341 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23342 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23343
23344 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23345 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23346 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23347 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23348
23349 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23350 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23351 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23352 .code
23353 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23354 .endd
23355 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23356 textual form of the IP address.
23357
23358 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23359 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23360 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23361 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23362
23363 .vlist
23364 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23365 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23366 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23367
23368 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23369 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23370 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23371
23372 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23373 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23374
23375 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23376 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23377 .endlist
23378
23379 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23380 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23381 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23382 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23383 retry rule of this form:
23384 .code
23385 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23386 .endd
23387 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23388 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23389
23390 .vlist
23391 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23392 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23393 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23394 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23395
23396 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23397 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23398
23399 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23400 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23401
23402 .vitem &%refused%&
23403 A connection was refused.
23404
23405 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23406 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23407
23408 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23409 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23410
23411 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23412 A connection attempt timed out.
23413
23414 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23415 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23416 obtained from an MX record.
23417
23418 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23419 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23420 obtained from an MX record.
23421
23422 .vitem &%timeout%&
23423 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23424
23425 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23426 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23427 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23428 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23429
23430 .vitem &%quota%&
23431 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23432 transport.
23433
23434 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23435 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23436 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23437 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23438 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23439 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23440 for four days.
23441 .endlist
23442
23443 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23444 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23445 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23446 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23447 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23448 heuristic rules:
23449
23450 .ilist
23451 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23452 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23453 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23454 .next
23455 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23456 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23457 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23458 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23459 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23460 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23461 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23462 .next
23463 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23464 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23465 .endlist
23466
23467 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23468 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23469 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23470 error).
23471
23472
23473
23474 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23475 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23476 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23477 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23478 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23479 form:
23480 .display
23481 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23482 .endd
23483 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23484 .code
23485 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23486 .endd
23487 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23488 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23489 For example:
23490 .code
23491 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23492 .endd
23493 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23494 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23495 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23496 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23497 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23498
23499 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23500 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23501 .code
23502 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23503 .endd
23504 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23505 list is never matched.
23506
23507
23508
23509
23510
23511 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23512 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23513 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23514 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23515 .display
23516 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23517 .endd
23518 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23519 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23520 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23521 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23522 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23523
23524 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23525 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23526 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23527 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23528 The available algorithms are:
23529
23530 .ilist
23531 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23532 the interval.
23533 .next
23534 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23535 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23536 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23537 .next
23538 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23539 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23540 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23541 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23542 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23543 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23544 queue processing times.
23545 .endlist
23546
23547 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23548 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23549 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23550 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23551 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23552 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23553 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23554 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23555 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23556 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23557 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23558 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23559
23560 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23561 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23562 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23563 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23564 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23565 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23566 time.
23567
23568 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23569 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23570 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23571 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23572 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23573 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23574 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23575 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23576 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23577 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23578 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23579 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23580
23581 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23582 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23583 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23584 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23585 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23586 deliveries that have been deferred.
23587
23588
23589 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23590 Here are some example retry rules:
23591 .code
23592 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23593 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23594 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23595 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23596 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23597 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23598 .endd
23599 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23600 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23601 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23602 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23603 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23604 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23605 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23606 days.
23607
23608 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23609 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23610 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23611 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23612 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23613
23614 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23615 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23616 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23617 were not obtained from an MX record.
23618
23619 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23620 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23621 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23622 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23623 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23624
23625
23626
23627 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23628 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23629 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23630 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23631 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23632 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23633 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23634 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23635 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23636 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23637 failing for the first time.
23638
23639 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23640 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23641 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23642 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23643
23644 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23645 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23646 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23647
23648
23649
23650
23651 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23652 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23653 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23654 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23655 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23656 default retry rule:
23657 .code
23658 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23659 .endd
23660 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23661 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23662 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23663
23664 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23665 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23666 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23667 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23668 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23669
23670 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23671 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23672 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23673
23674 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23675 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23676 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23677 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23678 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23679 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23680 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23681 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23682
23683 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23684 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23685 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23686 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23687 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23688 notice.
23689
23690 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23691 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23692 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23693 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23694 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23695 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23696 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23697 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23698 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23699 true.
23700
23701 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23702 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23703 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23704 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23705 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23706 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23707 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23708 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23709 reached.
23710
23711 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23712 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23713 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23714 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23715 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23716 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23717 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23718 time out the address.
23719
23720 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23721 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23722 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23723 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23724 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23725 considered immediately.
23726 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23727 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23728
23729
23730
23731
23732
23733
23734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23736
23737 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23738 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23739 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23740 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23741 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23742 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23743 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23744 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23745 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23746 other.
23747
23748 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23749 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23750
23751 .ilist
23752 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23753 the client's EHLO command.
23754 .next
23755 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23756 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23757 .next
23758 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23759 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23760 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23761 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23762 with the AUTH command.
23763 .next
23764 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23765 .next
23766 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23767 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23768 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23769 connection.
23770 .next
23771 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23772 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23773 unauthenticated connection.
23774 .endlist
23775
23776 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23777 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23778 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23779 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23780 .display
23781 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23782 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23783 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23784 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
23785 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23786 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23787 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23788 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23789 &`250-PIPELINING`&
23790 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23791 &`250 HELP`&
23792 .endd
23793 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23794 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23795 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23796 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23797 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23798 included by setting
23799 .code
23800 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23801 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23802 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
23803 AUTH_GSASL=yes
23804 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23805 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23806 AUTH_SPA=yes
23807 .endd
23808 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23809 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23810 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
23811 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
23812 work via a socket interface.
23813 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
23814 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
23815 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
23816 supporting setting a server keytab.
23817 The sixth can be configured to support
23818 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23819 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
23820 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23821
23822 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23823 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23824 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23825 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23826 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23827 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23828 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23829
23830 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23831 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23832 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23833 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23834 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23835 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23836 .code
23837 cram:
23838 driver = cram_md5
23839 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23840 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23841 client_name = ph10
23842 client_secret = secret2
23843 .endd
23844 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23845 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23846
23847 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23848 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23849 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23850 in Exim.
23851
23852 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
23853 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
23854 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
23855 authenticating data.
23856
23857 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
23858 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
23859 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
23860 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
23861 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
23862 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
23863 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
23864 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
23865 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
23866 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
23867 choose to honour.
23868
23869 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
23870 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
23871 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
23872 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
23873
23874
23875
23876 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23877 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23878 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23879
23880 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23881 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23882 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23883 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23884 encrypted by a setting such as:
23885 .code
23886 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23887 .endd
23888 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23889 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23890 cipher used for the delivery.)
23891
23892
23893 .option driver authenticators string unset
23894 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23895 authenticators is to be used.
23896
23897
23898 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23899 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23900 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23901 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23902 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23903 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23904
23905
23906 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23907 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23908 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23909 mechanism is not advertised.
23910 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23911 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23912 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23913
23914
23915 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23916 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23917 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23918 for details.
23919
23920 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
23921 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
23922
23923 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23924 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23925 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23926 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23927 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23928 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23929 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23930 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23931 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23932 the error text.
23933
23934
23935 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23936 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23937 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23938 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23939 out the values of variables.
23940 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23941 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23942
23943
23944 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23945 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23946 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23947 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23948 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23949 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23950 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23951 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23952 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23953
23954
23955 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23956 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23957 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23958 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23959 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23960 remembered for later use.
23961 How it is used is described in the following section.
23962
23963
23964
23965
23966
23967 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23968 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23969 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23970 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23971 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23972 message:
23973
23974 .ilist
23975 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23976 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23977 .next
23978 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23979 .next
23980 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23981 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23982 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23983 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23984 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23985 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23986 given for the MAIL command.
23987 .next
23988 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23989 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23990 authenticated.
23991 .next
23992 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23993 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23994 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23995 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23996 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23997 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23998 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23999 message.
24000 .endlist
24001
24002
24003 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24004 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24005 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24006 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24007
24008 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24009 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24010 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24011 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24012 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24013 ACL is run.
24014
24015
24016
24017 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24018 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24019 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24020 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24021 conditions:
24022
24023 .ilist
24024 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24025 .next
24026 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24027 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24028 .endlist
24029
24030 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24031 the mechanisms are advertised.
24032
24033 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24034 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24035 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24036 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24037 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24038 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24039 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24040 .code
24041 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24042 .endd
24043 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24044
24045 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24046 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24047 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24048 such as:
24049 .code
24050 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24051 .endd
24052 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24053 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24054 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24055
24056 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24057 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24058 command. This is the case if
24059
24060 .ilist
24061 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24062 .next
24063 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24064 .next
24065 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24066 server authenticators.
24067 .endlist
24068
24069
24070 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24071 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24072 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24073
24074 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24075 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24076 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24077 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24078 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24079 rejected with a 504 error.
24080
24081 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24082 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24083 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24084 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24085 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24086 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24087 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24088 no successful authentication.
24089
24090
24091
24092
24093 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24094 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24095 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24096 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24097 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24098 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24099 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24100 script:
24101 .code
24102 use MIME::Base64;
24103 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24104 .endd
24105 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24106 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24107 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24108 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24109 command line to run this script on such data might be
24110 .code
24111 encode '\0user\0password'
24112 .endd
24113 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24114 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24115 whose code value is zero.
24116
24117 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24118 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24119 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24120 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24121
24122 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24123 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24124 example, a command such as
24125 .code
24126 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24127 .endd
24128 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24129
24130 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24131 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24132 .code
24133 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24134 .endd
24135 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24136 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24137 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24138 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24139
24140
24141
24142 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24143 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24144 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24145 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24146 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24147 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24148
24149 .ilist
24150 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24151 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24152 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24153 of the authenticator.
24154 .next
24155 .vindex "&$host$&"
24156 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24157 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24158 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24159 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24160 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24161 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24162 delivery to be deferred.
24163 .next
24164 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24165 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24166 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24167 usual way.
24168 .next
24169 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24170 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24171 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24172 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24173 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24174 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24175 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24176 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24177 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24178 .endlist
24179
24180 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24181 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24182 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24183 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24184 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24185 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24186 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24187 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24188 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24189 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24190 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24191 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24192 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24193
24194
24195
24196
24197
24198
24199 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24200 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24201
24202 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24203 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24204 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24205 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24206 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24207 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24208 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24209 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24210 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24211 connections as you do for login accounts.
24212
24213 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24214 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24215 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24216
24217 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24218 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24219 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24220
24221 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24222 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24223 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24224 given.
24225
24226 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24227 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24228 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24229 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24230 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24231 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24232 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24233
24234 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24235 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24236 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24237 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24238 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24239 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24240 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24241
24242 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24243 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24244 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24245 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24246
24247 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24248 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24249 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24250
24251 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24252 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24253 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24254 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24255 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24256 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24257 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24258 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24259 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24260 string as the error text.
24261
24262 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24263 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24264 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24265
24266
24267
24268 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24269 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24270 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24271 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24272 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24273 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24274 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24275 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24276
24277 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24278 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24279 configured as follows:
24280 .code
24281 fixed_plain:
24282 driver = plaintext
24283 public_name = PLAIN
24284 server_prompts = :
24285 server_condition = \
24286 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24287 server_set_id = $auth2
24288 .endd
24289 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24290 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24291 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24292 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24293
24294 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24295 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24296 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24297 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24298 .code
24299 250-AUTH PLAIN
24300 .endd
24301 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24302 .code
24303 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24304 .endd
24305 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24306 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24307 .code
24308 AUTH PLAIN
24309 .endd
24310 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24311 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24312
24313 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24314 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24315 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24316 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24317 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24318
24319 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24320 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24321 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24322
24323 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24324 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24325 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24326 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24327 This is an incorrect example:
24328 .code
24329 server_condition = \
24330 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24331 .endd
24332 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24333 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24334 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24335 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24336 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24337 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24338 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24339 .code
24340 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24341 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24342 .endd
24343 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24344 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24345 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24346 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24347 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24348
24349
24350 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24351 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24352 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24353 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24354 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24355 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24356 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24357 .code
24358 fixed_login:
24359 driver = plaintext
24360 public_name = LOGIN
24361 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24362 server_condition = \
24363 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24364 server_set_id = $auth1
24365 .endd
24366 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24367 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24368 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24369 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24370
24371 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24372 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24373 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24374 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24375 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24376 .code
24377 login:
24378 driver = plaintext
24379 public_name = LOGIN
24380 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24381 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24382 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
24383 ldapauth{\
24384 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24385 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24386 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24387 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24388 .endd
24389 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24390 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24391 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24392 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24393 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24394 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24395 uninterpreted string.
24396
24397
24398 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24399 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24400 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24401 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24402 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24403 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
24404
24405
24406
24407
24408 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24409 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24410 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24411
24412 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24413 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24414 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24415 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24416 usual.
24417
24418 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24419 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24420 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24421 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24422 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24423 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24424 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24425 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24426 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24427 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24428 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24429 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24430
24431 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24432 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24433
24434 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24435 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24436 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24437 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24438 the string.
24439
24440 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24441 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24442 .code
24443 fixed_plain:
24444 driver = plaintext
24445 public_name = PLAIN
24446 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24447 .endd
24448 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24449 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24450 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24451 .code
24452 fixed_login:
24453 driver = plaintext
24454 public_name = LOGIN
24455 client_send = : username : mysecret
24456 .endd
24457 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24458 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24459 prompts.
24460 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24461 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24462
24463
24464
24465
24466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24468
24469 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24470 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24471 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24472 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24473 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24474 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24475 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24476 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24477 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24478 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24479 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24480 available in plain text at either end.
24481
24482
24483 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24484 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24485 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24486 authenticator as a server:
24487
24488 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24489 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24490 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24491 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24492 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24493 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24494 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24495 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24496 returned to the client.
24497
24498 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24499 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24500 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24501 numeric variables for other things.
24502
24503 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24504 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24505 user name, authentication fails.
24506 .code
24507 fixed_cram:
24508 driver = cram_md5
24509 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24510 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24511 server_set_id = $auth1
24512 .endd
24513 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24514 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24515 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24516 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24517 .code
24518 lookup_cram:
24519 driver = cram_md5
24520 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24521 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24522 {$value}fail}
24523 server_set_id = $auth1
24524 .endd
24525 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24526 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24527
24528 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24529 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24530 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24531 realm, with:
24532 .code
24533 cyrusless_crammd5:
24534 driver = cram_md5
24535 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24536 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24537 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24538 server_set_id = $auth1
24539 .endd
24540
24541 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24542 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24543 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24544
24545
24546
24547 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24548 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24549 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24550
24551
24552 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24553 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24554 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24555
24556
24557 .vindex "&$host$&"
24558 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24559 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24560 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24561 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24562 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24563 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24564 send the message to the current server.
24565
24566 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24567 strings, is:
24568 .code
24569 fixed_cram:
24570 driver = cram_md5
24571 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24572 client_name = ph10
24573 client_secret = secret
24574 .endd
24575 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24576 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24577
24578
24579
24580 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24582
24583 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24584 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24585 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24586 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24587 .cindex "Kerberos"
24588 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24589 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24590
24591 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24592 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24593 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24594 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24595 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24596
24597 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24598 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24599 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24600 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24601
24602 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24603 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24604 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24605 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24606 depending on the driver you are using.
24607
24608 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24609 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24610 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24611 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24612 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24613 implementation.
24614
24615 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24616 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24617 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24618 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24619 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24620 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24621 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24622 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24623
24624
24625 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24626 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24627 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24628 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24629 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24630 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24631 things.
24632
24633
24634 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24635 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24636 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24637 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24638
24639
24640 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24641 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24642 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24643 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24644 example:
24645 .code
24646 sasl:
24647 driver = cyrus_sasl
24648 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24649 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24650 server_set_id = $auth1
24651 .endd
24652
24653 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24654 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24655
24656
24657 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24658 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24659
24660
24661 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24662 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24663 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24664 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24665 .code
24666 sasl_cram_md5:
24667 driver = cyrus_sasl
24668 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24669 server_set_id = $auth1
24670
24671 sasl_plain:
24672 driver = cyrus_sasl
24673 public_name = PLAIN
24674 server_set_id = $auth2
24675 .endd
24676 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24677 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24678 but it is present in many binary distributions.
24679 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24680 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24681
24682
24683
24684
24685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24687 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24688 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24689 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24690 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24691 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24692 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24693 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24694 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24695
24696 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24697
24698 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24699 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24700 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24701 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24702 .code
24703 dovecot_plain:
24704 driver = dovecot
24705 public_name = PLAIN
24706 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24707 server_set_id = $auth2
24708
24709 dovecot_ntlm:
24710 driver = dovecot
24711 public_name = NTLM
24712 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24713 server_set_id = $auth1
24714 .endd
24715 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24716 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24717 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24718 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24719 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24720 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24721 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24722 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24723
24724
24725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24727 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24728 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24729 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24730 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24731 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24732 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24733 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24734 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24735 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24736 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24737 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24738 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24739 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24740 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
24741 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24742 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24743 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24744 without code changes in Exim.
24745
24746
24747 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
24748 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24749 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24750 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24751 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24752 context.
24753
24754 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24755 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24756 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24757
24758 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24759 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24760 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24761
24762 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24763 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24764 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24765
24766
24767 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24768 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24769 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24770 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24771
24772
24773 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24774 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24775 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24776 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24777 example:
24778 .code
24779 sasl:
24780 driver = gsasl
24781 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24782 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24783 server_set_id = $auth1
24784 .endd
24785
24786
24787 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24788 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24789 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24790 the password itself.
24791
24792 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24793 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24794 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24795 if available, else the empty string.
24796 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24797 else the empty string.
24798
24799 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24800
24801 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24802 option to be simply "true".
24803
24804
24805 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
24806 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24807 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24808
24809
24810 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
24811 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24812 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24813 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24814
24815
24816 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
24817 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24818 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24819 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24820
24821
24822 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
24823 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24824 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24825
24826
24827 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
24828 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24829 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
24830 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
24831
24832 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
24833 meanings for these variables:
24834
24835 .ilist
24836 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24837 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
24838 .next
24839 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24840 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
24841 .next
24842 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
24843 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
24844 .endlist
24845
24846 On a per-mechanism basis:
24847
24848 .ilist
24849 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24850 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
24851 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24852 .next
24853 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24854 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
24855 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24856 .next
24857 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24858 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
24859 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
24860 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24861 .endlist
24862
24863 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
24864 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
24865 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
24866
24867
24868 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
24869 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
24870 .code
24871 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
24872 driver = gsasl
24873 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24874 server_realm = imap.example.org
24875 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
24876 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
24877 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
24878 server_condition = yes
24879 .endd
24880
24881
24882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24884
24885 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
24886 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
24887 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
24888 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24889 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
24890 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
24891 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
24892 reliably.
24893
24894 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
24895 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
24896 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
24897 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24898
24899 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
24900 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
24901 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
24902 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
24903
24904 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
24905 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
24906 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
24907 from the keytab.
24908
24909
24910 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
24911 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
24912 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
24913 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
24914
24915 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
24916 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
24917 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
24918 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
24919
24920 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24921 .ilist
24922 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24923 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
24924 .next
24925 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24926 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
24927 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
24928 GSS Display Name.
24929 .endlist
24930
24931
24932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24933 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24934
24935 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24936 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24937 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24938 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24939 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24940 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24941 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
24942 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24943 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24944 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24945 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24946 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24947 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24948 follows:
24949
24950 .ilist
24951 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24952 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24953 .next
24954 The server sends back a challenge.
24955 .next
24956 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24957 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24958 .endlist
24959
24960 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24961
24962
24963
24964 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24965 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24966 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24967
24968 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
24969 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24970 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24971 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24972 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24973 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24974 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24975 for other things. For example:
24976 .code
24977 spa:
24978 driver = spa
24979 public_name = NTLM
24980 server_password = \
24981 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24982 .endd
24983 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24984 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24985
24986
24987
24988
24989
24990 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24991 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24992 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24993
24994
24995
24996 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24997 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24998
24999
25000 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25001 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25002
25003
25004 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25005 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25006 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25007 &'msn.com'&:
25008 .code
25009 msn:
25010 driver = spa
25011 public_name = MSN
25012 client_username = msn/msn_username
25013 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25014 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25015 .endd
25016 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25017 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25018
25019
25020
25021
25022
25023 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25024 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25025
25026 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25027 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25028 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25029 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25030 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25031 .cindex "OpenSSL"
25032 .cindex "GnuTLS"
25033 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25034 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25035 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25036 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25037 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25038 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25039 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25040 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25041 certificates are used.
25042
25043 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25044 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25045 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25046 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25047 between them is encrypted.
25048
25049 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25050 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25051 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25052 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25053 encryption state.
25054
25055 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25056 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25057 in order to get TLS to work.
25058
25059
25060
25061 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25062 "SECID284"
25063 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25064 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25065 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25066 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25067 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25068 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25069 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25070 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25071 allocated for this purpose.
25072
25073 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25074 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25075 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25076 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25077 .code
25078 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25079 .endd
25080 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25081 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25082 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25083 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25084 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25085 defined elsewhere.
25086
25087 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25088 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25089
25090
25091
25092
25093
25094
25095 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25096 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25097 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25098 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25099 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25100 .code
25101 USE_GNUTLS=yes
25102 .endd
25103 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25104 .code
25105 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
25106 .endd
25107 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25108 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25109
25110 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25111
25112 .ilist
25113 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25114 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25115 .next
25116 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25117 .next
25118 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25119 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25120 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25121 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
25122 .next
25123 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25124 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25125 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25126 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25127 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25128 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25129 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25130 option).
25131 .next
25132 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25133 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25134 .next
25135 .new
25136 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25137 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25138 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25139 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25140 .wen
25141 .next
25142 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25143 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25144 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25145 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25146 .endlist
25147
25148
25149 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25150 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25151 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25152 but not the chosen filename.
25153 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25154 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25155
25156 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25157 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25158 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25159 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25160 of bits requested.
25161 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25162 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25163 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25164 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25165 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25166 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25167 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25168
25169 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25170 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25171 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25172 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25173 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25174
25175 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25176 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25177 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25178 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25179 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25180 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25181
25182 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25183 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25184 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25185
25186 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25187 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25188 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25189 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25190 .code
25191 # ls
25192 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25193 # rm -f new-params
25194 # touch new-params
25195 # chown exim:exim new-params
25196 # chmod 0600 new-params
25197 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25198 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25199 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25200 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25201 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25202 # chmod 0400 new-params
25203 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25204 .endd
25205 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25206 stalling is removed.
25207
25208 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25209 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25210 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25211 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25212 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25213 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25214 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25215 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25216 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25217 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25218 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25219
25220 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25221 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25222 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25223 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25224
25225 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25226 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25227 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25228 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25229 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25230
25231
25232 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25233 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25234 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25235 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25236 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25237 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25238 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25239 directly to this function call.
25240 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25241 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25242 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25243 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25244
25245 .ilist
25246 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25247 .next
25248 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25249 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25250 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25251 SSL v3 algorithms.
25252 .next
25253 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25254 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25255 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25256 algorithms.
25257 .endlist
25258
25259 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25260 &`-`& or &`+`&.
25261 .ilist
25262 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25263 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25264 stated.
25265 .next
25266 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25267 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25268 .next
25269 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25270 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25271 .endlist
25272
25273 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25274 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25275 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25276 not be moved to the end of the list.
25277 .endlist
25278
25279 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25280 string:
25281 .code
25282 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25283 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25284 .endd
25285
25286 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25287 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25288 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25289 choice of clients used:
25290 .code
25291 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25292 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25293 {DEFAULT}\
25294 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
25295 .endd
25296
25297
25298
25299 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25300 "SECTreqciphgnu"
25301 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25302 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25303 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25304 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25305 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25306 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25307 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25308 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25309 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25310 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25311
25312 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25313
25314 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25315 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25316 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25317 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25318 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25319 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25320
25321 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25322 "Priority strings". This is online as
25323 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25324 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25325 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25326 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string.html, then the example code)
25327 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25328
25329 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25330 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25331 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25332
25333 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25334 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25335 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25336 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25337 used:
25338 .code
25339 # GnuTLS variant
25340 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25341 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
25342 {SECURE128}}
25343 .endd
25344
25345
25346 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25347 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25348 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25349 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25350 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25351 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25352 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25353 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25354
25355 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25356 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25357 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25358 with the error
25359 .code
25360 554 Security failure
25361 .endd
25362 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25363 rejected with a 554 error code.
25364
25365 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25366 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25367 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25368 without some further configuration at the server end.
25369
25370 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25371 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25372 .code
25373 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25374 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25375 .endd
25376 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25377 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25378 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25379 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25380 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25381 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25382 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25383 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25384 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25385 the server's certificate.
25386
25387 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25388 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25389 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25390
25391 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25392 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25393 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25394 transport.
25395
25396 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25397 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25398 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25399 .code
25400 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25401 .endd
25402 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25403 with the parameters contained in the file.
25404 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25405 available:
25406 .code
25407 tls_dhparam = none
25408 .endd
25409 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25410 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25411 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25412 documetnation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25413
25414 See the command
25415 .code
25416 openssl dhparam
25417 .endd
25418 for a way of generating file data.
25419
25420 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25421 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25422 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25423 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25424 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25425
25426 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25427 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25428 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
25429 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25430 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25431 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25432 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25433 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25434 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25435 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
25436 &<<SECID185>>&.)
25437
25438 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25439 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25440 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25441 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25442 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25443 documentation for more details.
25444
25445
25446 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25447 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25448 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25449 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25450 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25451 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25452 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25453 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25454 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25455 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25456 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25457 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25458
25459 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25460 directory is used
25461 (OpenSSL only),
25462 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25463 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25464 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25465 .code
25466 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25467 .endd
25468 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25469
25470 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25471 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25472 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25473 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25474 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25475 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25476 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25477 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25478 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25479 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25480
25481 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25482 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25483 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25484 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25485
25486 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25487 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25488 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25489 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25490 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25491 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
25492
25493
25494 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25495 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25496 .cindex "revocation list"
25497 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25498 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25499 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25500 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25501 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25502 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25503 CRL in PEM format.
25504
25505
25506 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25507 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25508 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25509 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25510 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25511 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25512 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25513 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25514 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25515
25516 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25517 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25518 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25519 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25520 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25521
25522 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25523 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25524 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25525 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25526 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25527 usual way.
25528
25529 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25530 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25531 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25532 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25533 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25534 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25535 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25536 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25537 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25538 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25539 unencrypted.
25540
25541 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25542 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25543 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25544 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25545
25546 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25547 must name a file or,
25548 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25549 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25550 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25551 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25552
25553 If
25554 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25555 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25556 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25557 alternative hosts, if any.
25558
25559 &*Note*&:
25560 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25561 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25562 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25563 client.
25564
25565 .vindex "&$host$&"
25566 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25567 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25568 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25569 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25570 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25571
25572 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25573 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25574 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25575 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25576 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25577 &$tls_bits$&, &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25578 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25579 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25580 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25581 outgoing connection.
25582
25583
25584
25585 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25586 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25587 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25588 .oindex "&%tls_sni%&"
25589 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25590 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25591 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25592 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25593 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25594 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25595 for this session.
25596
25597 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25598 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25599 address.
25600
25601 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25602 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25603 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25604 be of limited use in that environment.
25605
25606 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25607 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25608 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25609 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25610 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25611
25612 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25613 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25614 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25615 only point of caution. The &$tls_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25616 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25617
25618 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_sni$& is set then it is a string
25619 received from a client.
25620 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25621
25622 If the string &`tls_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25623 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25624 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25625
25626 .ilist
25627 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25628 &%tls_certificate%&
25629 .next
25630 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25631 &%tls_crl%&
25632 .next
25633 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25634 &%tls_privatekey%&
25635 .next
25636 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25637 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
25638 .endlist
25639
25640 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25641 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25642 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25643 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25644
25645 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25646 are re-expanded.
25647
25648 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25649 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25650 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25651 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25652
25653 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
25654 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25655 built, then you have SNI support).
25656
25657
25658
25659 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25660 "SECTmulmessam"
25661 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25662 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25663 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25664 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25665 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25666 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25667 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25668 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25669 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25670 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25671 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25672
25673 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25674 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25675 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25676 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25677 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25678 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25679 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25680 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25681 and delay other deliveries to that host.
25682
25683 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25684 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25685 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25686 information is recorded.
25687
25688 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25689 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25690 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25691
25692
25693
25694
25695 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25696 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25697 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25698 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25699 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25700 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25701 to Apache, currently at
25702 .display
25703 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25704 .endd
25705 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25706 links to further files.
25707 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
25708 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25709 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25710 .display
25711 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25712 .endd
25713
25714
25715 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25716 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25717 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25718 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25719 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25720 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25721 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25722 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25723 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25724 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25725 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25726 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25727 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25728
25729
25730 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25731 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25732 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25733 with OpenSSL, like this:
25734 .code
25735 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25736 -days 9999 -nodes
25737 .endd
25738 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25739 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25740 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25741 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25742 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25743 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25744 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25745
25746 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25747 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25748 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25749
25750 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25751 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25752 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25753 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25754 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25755 signed with that self-signed certificate.
25756
25757 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25758 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25759 Open-source PKI book, available online at
25760 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25761 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25762 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25763
25764
25765
25766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25768
25769 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25770 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25771 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
25772 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25773 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25774 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25775 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25776 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25777 one very small ACL:
25778 .code
25779 begin acl
25780 small_acl:
25781 accept hosts = one.host.only
25782 .endd
25783 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25784 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
25785
25786 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
25787 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
25788 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
25789 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
25790 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
25791 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
25792 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
25793 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
25794
25795
25796 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
25797 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
25798 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
25799 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
25800 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
25801
25802
25803
25804 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
25805 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
25806 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
25807 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
25808 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
25809 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25810 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
25811 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
25812 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25813 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25814 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
25815 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25816 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25817 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25818 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25819 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25820 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25821 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25822
25823 .table2 140pt
25824 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25825 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25826 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25827 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25828 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25829 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25830 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25831 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25832 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25833 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25834 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25835 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25836 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25837 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25838 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25839 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25840 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25841 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25842 .endtable
25843
25844 For example, if you set
25845 .code
25846 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25847 .endd
25848 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25849 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25850 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25851 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25852 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25853 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25854 testing as possible at RCPT time.
25855
25856
25857 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25858 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25859 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25860 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25861 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25862 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25863 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25864 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
25865 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
25866 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
25867 in any of these ACLs.
25868
25869 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
25870 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
25871 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
25872 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
25873 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
25874 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
25875 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
25876 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
25877 .code
25878 control = suppress_local_fixups
25879 .endd
25880 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
25881 run, it is too late.
25882
25883 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25884 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25885
25886 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
25887 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
25888 temporary error for these kinds of message.
25889
25890
25891 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
25892 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25893 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
25894 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
25895 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
25896 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
25897 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
25898 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
25899 &%smtp_banner%& option.
25900
25901
25902 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
25903 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25904 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25905 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
25906 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
25907 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
25908 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
25909 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
25910 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
25911
25912 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
25913 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
25914 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
25915 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
25916 an EHLO response.
25917
25918
25919 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
25920 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25921 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
25922 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
25923 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
25924 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
25925 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
25926 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
25927 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
25928 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
25929
25930 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
25931 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
25932 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
25933 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
25934 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
25935 associated with the DATA command.
25936
25937 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
25938 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
25939 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
25940 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
25941 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
25942 your resources.
25943
25944
25945 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
25946 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
25947 enabled (which is the default).
25948
25949 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
25950 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
25951 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
25952
25953 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
25954
25955
25956 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
25957 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25958 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25959
25960
25961 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
25962 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25963 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
25964 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
25965 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
25966 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
25967
25968 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
25969 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
25970 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
25971 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
25972
25973 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
25974 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
25975
25976 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
25977 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
25978 response to QUIT.
25979
25980 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
25981 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
25982 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
25983 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
25984 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
25985
25986
25987 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
25988 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
25989 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
25990 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
25991 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
25992 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
25993 situation even worse.
25994
25995 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
25996 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
25997 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
25998 and &%warn%&.
25999
26000 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26001 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26002 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26003 connection. The possible values are:
26004 .table2
26005 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26006 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26007 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26008 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26009 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26010 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26011 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26012 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26013 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26014 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26015 .endtable
26016 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26017 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26018 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26019 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26020 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26021 used.
26022
26023
26024 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26025 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26026 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26027 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26028 .code
26029 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26030 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26031 .endd
26032 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26033 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26034 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26035 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26036 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26037
26038 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26039 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26040 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26041
26042 .ilist
26043 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26044 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26045 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26046 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26047 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26048 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26049 .code
26050 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26051 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26052 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26053 .endd
26054 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26055 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26056 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26057 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26058 .next
26059 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26060 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26061 matches the string.
26062 .next
26063 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26064 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26065 want to have something like
26066 .code
26067 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26068 .endd
26069 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26070 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26071 .endlist
26072
26073
26074
26075
26076 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26077 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26078 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26079 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26080 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26081 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26082 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26083 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26084 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26085
26086 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26087 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26088 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26089
26090
26091 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26092 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26093 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26094 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26095
26096 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26097 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26098 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26099 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26100 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26101 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26102 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26103
26104
26105 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26106 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26107 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26108
26109
26110
26111 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26112 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26113 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26114 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26115 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26116 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26117
26118 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26119 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26120 used to accept or reject anything.
26121
26122 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26123 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26124 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26125 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26126
26127 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26128 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26129 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26130 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26131 configuration file.
26132
26133
26134
26135
26136 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26137 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26138 .vindex &$domain$&
26139 .vindex &$local_part$&
26140 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26141 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26142 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26143 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26144 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26145 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26146 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26147 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26148 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26149
26150 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26151 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26152 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26153 how it is used.
26154
26155 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26156 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26157 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26158 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26159 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26160 received).
26161
26162 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26163 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26164 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26165 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26166 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26167 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26168 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26169 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26170
26171
26172
26173
26174
26175 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26176 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26177 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26178 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26179 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26180 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26181 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26182 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26183 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26184 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26185 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26186 unencrypted connections.
26187 .code
26188 acl_check_auth:
26189 accept encrypted = *
26190 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26191 {CRAM-MD5}}
26192 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26193 .endd
26194 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26195 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26196 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26197 option to do this.)
26198
26199
26200
26201 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26202 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26203 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26204 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26205 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26206 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26207 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26208
26209 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26210 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26211 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26212 example:
26213 .code
26214 deny dnslists = list1.example
26215 dnslists = list2.example
26216 .endd
26217 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26218 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26219 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26220 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26221 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26222
26223
26224 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26225 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26226
26227 .ilist
26228 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26229 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26230 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26231 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26232 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26233 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26234 check a RCPT command:
26235 .code
26236 accept domains = +local_domains
26237 endpass
26238 verify = recipient
26239 .endd
26240 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26241 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26242 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26243 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26244 &%endpass%&.
26245
26246 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26247 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26248 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26249 configuration.
26250
26251 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26252 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26253 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26254 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26255 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26256 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26257 .display
26258 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26259 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26260 .endd
26261 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26262 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26263 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26264
26265 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26266 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26267 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26268 of &%endpass%&.
26269
26270
26271 .next
26272 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26273 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26274 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26275 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26276 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26277 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26278 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26279
26280
26281 .next
26282 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26283 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26284 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26285 example,
26286 .code
26287 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26288 .endd
26289 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26290
26291
26292 .next
26293 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26294 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26295 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26296 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26297 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26298 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26299 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26300 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26301 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26302
26303 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26304 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26305 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26306
26307
26308 .next
26309 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26310 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26311 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26312 .code
26313 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26314 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26315 .endd
26316 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26317 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26318
26319 .next
26320 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26321 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26322 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26323 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26324 .code
26325 require message = Sender did not verify
26326 verify = sender
26327 .endd
26328 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26329 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26330 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26331 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26332
26333 .next
26334 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26335 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26336 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26337 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26338 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26339 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26340 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26341
26342 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26343 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26344 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
26345 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26346 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26347
26348 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26349 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26350 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26351 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26352 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26353 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26354 onwards.
26355
26356
26357 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26358 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26359 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26360 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26361 .code
26362 warn !verify = sender
26363 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26364 .endd
26365 .endlist
26366
26367 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26368
26369 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26370 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26371 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26372 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26373 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26374
26375
26376
26377 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26378 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26379 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26380 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26381 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26382 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26383 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26384 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26385 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26386 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26387 .ilist
26388 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26389 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26390 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26391 on the same SMTP connection.
26392 .next
26393 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26394 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26395 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26396 .endlist
26397
26398 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26399 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26400 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26401 .code
26402 accept hosts = whatever
26403 set acl_m4 = some value
26404 accept authenticated = *
26405 set acl_c_auth = yes
26406 .endd
26407 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26408 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26409 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26410
26411 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26412 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26413 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26414 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26415 error is generated.
26416
26417 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26418 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26419
26420
26421 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26422 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26423 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26424 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26425 .code
26426 deny domains = *.dom.example
26427 !verify = recipient
26428 .endd
26429 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26430 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26431 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26432 two statements are equivalent:
26433 .code
26434 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26435 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26436 .endd
26437 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26438 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26439
26440 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26441 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26442 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26443 .code
26444 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26445 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26446 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26447 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26448 .endd
26449 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26450 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26451 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26452 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26453 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26454 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26455 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26456
26457 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26458 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26459 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26460 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26461 message is handled.
26462
26463 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
26464 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26465 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26466 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26467 .code
26468 require message = Can't verify sender
26469 verify = sender
26470 message = Can't verify recipient
26471 verify = recipient
26472 message = This message cannot be used
26473 .endd
26474 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26475 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26476 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26477 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26478 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26479 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26480
26481 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26482 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26483 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26484 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26485 .code
26486 deny hosts = ...
26487 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26488 message = Invalid sender from client host
26489 .endd
26490 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26491 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26492
26493
26494
26495 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26496 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26497 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26498
26499 .vlist
26500 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26501 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26502 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26503 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26504
26505 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26506 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26507 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26508 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26509 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26510 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26511 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26512 write rather ugly lines like this:
26513 .display
26514 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26515 .endd
26516 Instead, all you need is
26517 .display
26518 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26519 .endd
26520
26521 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26522 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26523 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26524 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26525 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26526 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26527 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26528 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26529
26530 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26531 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26532 in several different ways. For example:
26533
26534 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26535 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26536 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26537 . ==== way.
26538
26539 .ilist
26540 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26541 .code
26542 accept ...some conditions
26543 control = queue_only
26544 .endd
26545 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26546 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26547
26548 .next
26549 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26550 .code
26551 accept ...some conditions...
26552 control = queue_only
26553 ...some more conditions...
26554 .endd
26555 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26556 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26557 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26558 to be relevant.
26559
26560 .next
26561 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26562 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26563 example:
26564 .code
26565 warn ...some conditions...
26566 control = freeze
26567 accept ...
26568 .endd
26569 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26570 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26571 log entry.
26572
26573 .next
26574 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26575 &%require%& verb. For example:
26576 .code
26577 require control = no_multiline_responses
26578 .endd
26579 .endlist
26580
26581 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26582 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26583 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
26584 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
26585 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
26586 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
26587 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
26588 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
26589 flushed before the delay is imposed.
26590
26591 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26592 example:
26593 .code
26594 deny ...some conditions...
26595 delay = 30s
26596 .endd
26597 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26598 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26599 .code
26600 deny delay = 30s
26601 ...some conditions...
26602 .endd
26603 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26604 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26605 .code
26606 warn ...some conditions...
26607 delay = 2m
26608 control = freeze
26609 accept ...
26610 .endd
26611
26612 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26613 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26614 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26615 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26616 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26617 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26618 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26619
26620
26621 .vitem &*endpass*&
26622 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26623 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26624 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26625 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26626 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26627 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26628 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26629
26630
26631 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26632 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26633 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26634 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26635 .code
26636 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
26637 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26638 .endd
26639 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26640 example:
26641 .display
26642 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26643 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26644 .endd
26645 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26646 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26647 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26648 message.
26649
26650 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26651 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26652 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26653 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26654 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26655 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26656 ignored.
26657
26658 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26659 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26660 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26661 error message.
26662
26663 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26664 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26665 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26666 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26667 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26668 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26669
26670 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26671 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26672 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26673 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26674 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26675 logging rejections.
26676
26677
26678 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26679 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26680 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26681 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26682 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26683 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26684 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26685 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26686 .display
26687 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26688 &` log_reject_target =`&
26689 .endd
26690 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26691 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26692 current ACL.
26693
26694
26695 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26696 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26697 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26698 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26699 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26700 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26701 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26702 ACLs. For example:
26703 .display
26704 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26705 &` control = freeze`&
26706 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26707 .endd
26708 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26709 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26710 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26711 example:
26712 .code
26713 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26714 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26715 .endd
26716
26717
26718 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26719 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26720 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26721 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26722 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26723 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26724 &%accept%& for details.)
26725
26726 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26727 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26728 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26729 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26730 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26731 .code
26732 require message = Host not recognized
26733 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
26734 .endd
26735 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26736 processed.)
26737
26738 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26739 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26740 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26741 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26742 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26743 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26744 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26745 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26746 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26747 EHLO options.
26748
26749 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26750 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26751 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26752 .code
26753 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26754 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26755 .endd
26756 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26757 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26758 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
26759 2&'xx'&.
26760
26761 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26762 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26763
26764 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26765 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26766 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26767 response.
26768
26769 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26770 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26771 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26772 However, the original message is available in the variable
26773 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26774 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26775 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26776 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26777
26778 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
26779 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
26780 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
26781 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
26782 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
26783 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
26784 effect.
26785
26786
26787 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
26788 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
26789 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
26790 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
26791 .endlist
26792
26793
26794
26795
26796
26797 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
26798 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26799 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
26800
26801 .vlist
26802 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
26803 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
26804 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
26805 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
26806 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
26807 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
26808 not work without it. For example:
26809 .code
26810 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
26811 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
26812 .endd
26813 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
26814 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
26815 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26816 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26817 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26818
26819
26820 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26821 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26822 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26823 .cindex "case of local parts"
26824 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26825 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26826 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26827 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26828 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26829 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26830 is encountered.
26831
26832 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26833 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26834 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26835 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26836 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26837
26838 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26839 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26840 spam score:
26841 .code
26842 warn control = caseful_local_part
26843 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26844 $acl_m4 + \
26845 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26846 }
26847 control = caselower_local_part
26848 .endd
26849 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26850 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26851
26852
26853 .new
26854 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
26855 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
26856 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
26857 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
26858 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
26859 strings or to numeric value.
26860 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
26861 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
26862 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
26863
26864 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
26865 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
26866 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
26867 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
26868 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
26869 .wen
26870
26871
26872 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
26873 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
26874 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
26875 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
26876 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
26877 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
26878 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
26879 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
26880 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
26881 contexts):
26882 .code
26883 control = debug
26884 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
26885 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
26886 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
26887 .endd
26888
26889
26890 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
26891 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
26892 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
26893 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
26894 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
26895 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
26896 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
26897 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
26898
26899 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26900 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
26901 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
26902 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
26903 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
26904 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
26905 work with.
26906
26907
26908 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
26909 .cindex "fake defer"
26910 .cindex "defer, fake"
26911 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
26912 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
26913 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
26914 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
26915 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
26916
26917 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
26918 .cindex "fake rejection"
26919 .cindex "rejection, fake"
26920 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
26921 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
26922 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
26923 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
26924 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26925 the same SMTP connection.
26926
26927 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
26928 message is supplied, the following is used:
26929 .code
26930 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
26931 550-kept for evaluation.
26932 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
26933 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
26934 .endd
26935 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
26936
26937 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
26938 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
26939 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26940 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26941 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
26942 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
26943 SMTP connection.
26944
26945 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
26946 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
26947 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
26948 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
26949
26950 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
26951 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
26952 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
26953 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26954 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
26955 disables such output flushing.
26956
26957 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
26958 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
26959 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
26960 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26961 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
26962 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
26963
26964 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
26965 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
26966 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
26967 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
26968 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
26969 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
26970 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26971 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
26972 to be useful in production.
26973
26974 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
26975 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
26976 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
26977 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
26978 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
26979
26980 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
26981 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
26982 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
26983 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
26984 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
26985 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
26986
26987 .ilist
26988 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
26989 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
26990 verification failed"&) is sent.
26991 .next
26992 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
26993 line is output.
26994 .endlist
26995
26996 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
26997 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
26998
26999 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27000 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27001 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27002 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27003 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27004 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27005 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27006
27007 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27008 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27009 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27010 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27011 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27012 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27013 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27014 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27015 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27016 same SMTP connection.
27017
27018 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27019 .cindex "message" "submission"
27020 .cindex "submission mode"
27021 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27022 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27023 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27024 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27025 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27026 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27027 late (the message has already been created).
27028
27029 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27030 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27031 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27032 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27033 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27034
27035 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27036 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27037 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27038 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27039 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27040
27041 .ilist
27042 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27043 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27044 .next
27045 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27046 .next
27047 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27048 .endlist ilist
27049
27050 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27051 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27052 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27053 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27054 data is read.
27055
27056 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27057 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27058 .endlist vlist
27059
27060
27061 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27062 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27063
27064 .ilist
27065 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27066 .next
27067 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27068 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27069 .next
27070 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27071 .next
27072 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27073 .endlist
27074
27075
27076
27077 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27078 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27079 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27080 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27081 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27082 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27083 .code
27084 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27085 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27086 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27087 .endd
27088 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27089 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27090 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27091 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27092 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27093 RCPT ACL).
27094
27095 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
27096 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27097 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27098 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27099
27100 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27101 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27102 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27103 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27104 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27105 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27106 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27107 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27108 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27109 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27110 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27111
27112 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27113 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
27114 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27115 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27116 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27117 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27118 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27119 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27120 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27121
27122 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
27123 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27124 .display
27125 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27126 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27127
27128 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27129 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27130 .endd
27131 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27132 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27133 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27134 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27135 honoured.
27136
27137 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27138 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27139 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27140 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27141 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27142 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27143 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27144 specifications.
27145
27146 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27147 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27148 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27149 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27150 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27151
27152 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27153 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27154 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27155 to be a header name first.) For example:
27156 .code
27157 warn add_header = \
27158 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27159 .endd
27160 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27161 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27162 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27163 up in reverse order.
27164
27165 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27166 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27167 system filter or in a router or transport.
27168
27169
27170
27171
27172 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27173 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27174 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27175 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27176 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27177 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27178
27179 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27180 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27181 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27182 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27183 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27184 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27185 The conditions are as follows:
27186
27187
27188 .vlist
27189 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27190 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27191 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27192 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27193 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27194 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27195 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27196 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27197 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27198 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27199 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27200
27201 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27202 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27203 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27204 conditions are tested.
27205
27206 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27207 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27208 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27209 for different local users or different local domains.
27210
27211 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27212 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27213 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27214 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27215 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27216 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27217 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27218 .code
27219 authenticated = *
27220 .endd
27221
27222 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27223 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27224 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27225 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27226 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27227 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27228 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27229 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27230 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27231 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27232 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27233 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27234 negative.
27235
27236 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27237 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27238 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27239 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27240 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27241 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27242 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27243 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27244
27245 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27246 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27247 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27248 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27249 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27250
27251 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27252 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27253 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27254 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27255 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27256 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27257 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27258 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27259 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27260 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27261
27262 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27263 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27264 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27265 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27266 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27267 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27268 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27269 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27270 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27271 &%domains%& test.
27272
27273 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27274 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27275
27276
27277 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27278 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27279 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27280 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27281 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27282 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27283 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27284 .code
27285 encrypted = *
27286 .endd
27287
27288
27289 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
27290 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27291 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27292 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27293 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27294 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27295 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27296 .code
27297 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27298 .endd
27299 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27300 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27301 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27302
27303 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27304 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27305 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27306 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27307 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27308 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27309
27310 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27311 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27312 .code
27313 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27314 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27315 .endd
27316 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27317 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27318 statement can then check the IP address.
27319
27320 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27321 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27322 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27323 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27324 .code
27325 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27326 message = $host_data
27327 .endd
27328 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27329
27330 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27331 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27332 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27333 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27334 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27335 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27336 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27337 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27338 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27339 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27340
27341 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27342 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27343 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27344 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27345 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27346 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27347 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27348
27349 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27350 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27351 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27352 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27353 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27354 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27355 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27356 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27357
27358 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27359 .cindex "rate limiting"
27360 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27361 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27362
27363 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27364 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27365 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27366 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27367 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27368 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27369
27370 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27371 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27372 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27373 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27374 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27375 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27376 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27377
27378 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27379 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27380 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27381 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27382 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27383 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27384 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27385 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27386 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27387 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27388 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27389 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27390 influence the sender checking.
27391
27392 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27393 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27394
27395 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27396 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27397 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27398 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27399 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27400 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27401 .code
27402 senders = :
27403 .endd
27404 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27405 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27406
27407 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27408 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27409 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27410 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27411 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27412 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27413
27414 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27415 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27416 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27417 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27418 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27419 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27420 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27421 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27422 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27423 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27424
27425 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27426 .cindex "CSA verification"
27427 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27428 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27429 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27430
27431 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27432 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27433 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27434 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27435 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27436 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27437 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27438 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27439 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27440 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27441 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27442 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27443 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27444 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27445 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27446
27447 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27448 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27449 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27450 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27451 .code
27452 deny senders = :
27453 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27454 !verify = header_sender
27455 .endd
27456
27457 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27458 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27459 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27460 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27461 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27462 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27463 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27464 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27465 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27466 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27467 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27468 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27469 appropriate.
27470
27471 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27472 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27473 .code
27474 To: @
27475 .endd
27476 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27477 common as they used to be.
27478
27479 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27480 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27481 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27482 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27483 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27484 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27485 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27486 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27487 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27488 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27489 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27490 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27491 independently of this condition.
27492
27493 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27494 option), this condition is always true.
27495
27496
27497 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27498 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27499 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27500 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27501 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27502 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27503 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27504 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27505 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27506
27507 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27508 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27509
27510
27511 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27512 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27513 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27514 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27515 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27516 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27517 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27518 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27519 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27520 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27521 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27522 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27523 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27524 value for the child address.
27525
27526 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27527 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27528 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27529 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27530 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27531 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27532 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27533 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27534 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27535 original IP address.
27536
27537 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27538 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27539
27540 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27541 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27542 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27543 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
27544 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
27545 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27546 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27547 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27548 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27549
27550 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27551 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27552 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27553 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27554 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27555 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27556 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27557
27558 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27559 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27560 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27561
27562 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27563 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27564 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27565 verified as a sender.
27566 .endlist
27567
27568
27569
27570 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27571 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27572 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27573 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27574 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27575 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27576 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27577 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27578 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27579 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27580 .code
27581 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27582 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27583 .endd
27584 the following records are looked up:
27585 .code
27586 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27587 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27588 .endd
27589 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27590 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27591 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27592 use two separate conditions:
27593 .code
27594 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27595 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27596 .endd
27597 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27598 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27599 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27600 processed.
27601
27602 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27603 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27604 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27605 following special items in the list:
27606 .display
27607 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27608 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27609 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27610 .endd
27611 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27612 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27613 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27614 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27615 .code
27616 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27617 .endd
27618 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27619 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27620 .code
27621 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27622 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27623 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27624 .endd
27625 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27626 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27627 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27628 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27629
27630
27631
27632 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27633 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27634 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27635 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27636 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27637 .code
27638 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27639 .endd
27640 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27641 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27642 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27643 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27644
27645
27646
27647
27648 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27649 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27650 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27651 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27652 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27653 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27654 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
27655 .code
27656 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
27657 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27658 .endd
27659 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
27660 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
27661 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
27662 up by this example is
27663 .code
27664 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
27665 .endd
27666 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
27667 addresses. For example:
27668 .code
27669 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27670 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27671 .endd
27672 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
27673 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
27674
27675
27676
27677
27678 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
27679 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
27680 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
27681 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
27682 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
27683 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
27684 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
27685 either to double the separators like this:
27686 .code
27687 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
27688 .endd
27689 or to change the separator character, like this:
27690 .code
27691 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
27692 .endd
27693 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
27694 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
27695 occurs. Consider this condition:
27696 .code
27697 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
27698 .endd
27699 The DNS lookups that occur are:
27700 .code
27701 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
27702 a.domain.black.list.tld
27703 .endd
27704 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
27705 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
27706 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
27707 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
27708 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
27709 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
27710 error for a previous item.
27711
27712 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
27713 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
27714 .code
27715 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
27716 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
27717 .endd
27718 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
27719 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
27720 .code
27721 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
27722 $sender_address_domain \
27723 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
27724 see $dnslist_text.
27725 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
27726 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
27727 $sender_address_domain} }} }
27728 .endd
27729 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
27730 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
27731 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
27732 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
27733 .code
27734 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
27735 .endd
27736 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
27737 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
27738
27739 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
27740 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
27741
27742
27743
27744
27745 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
27746 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
27747 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
27748 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
27749 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
27750 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
27751 .display
27752 127.1.0.1 RBL
27753 127.1.0.2 DUL
27754 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
27755 127.1.0.4 RSS
27756 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
27757 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
27758 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
27759 .endd
27760 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
27761 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
27762 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
27763
27764
27765 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
27766 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
27767 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
27768 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
27769 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
27770 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
27771 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
27772 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
27773 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
27774 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
27775 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
27776 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
27777 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
27778 cases, for example:
27779 .code
27780 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
27781 .endd
27782 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
27783 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
27784 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
27785 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
27786 .code
27787 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
27788 .endd
27789 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
27790 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
27791
27792 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
27793 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
27794 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
27795 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
27796 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
27797 information.
27798
27799 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
27800 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
27801 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
27802 .code
27803 deny hosts = !+local_networks
27804 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
27805 at $dnslist_domain
27806 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
27807 .endd
27808
27809
27810
27811 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
27812 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
27813 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
27814 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
27815 For example,
27816 .code
27817 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
27818 .endd
27819 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
27820 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
27821 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
27822 describes how multiple records are handled.
27823
27824 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
27825 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
27826 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
27827 .code
27828 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27829 .endd
27830 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
27831 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
27832 first. For example:
27833 .code
27834 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27835 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27836 .endd
27837
27838 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
27839 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
27840 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
27841 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
27842 tested. For example:
27843 .code
27844 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
27845 .endd
27846 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
27847 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
27848 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
27849 .code
27850 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27851 .endd
27852 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
27853 an odd number.
27854
27855
27856
27857 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
27858 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
27859 condition. Whereas
27860 .code
27861 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27862 .endd
27863 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27864 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
27865 .code
27866 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27867 .endd
27868 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27869 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
27870 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
27871 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
27872
27873 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
27874 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
27875
27876 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
27877 previous example is precisely equivalent to
27878 .code
27879 deny dnslists = a.b.c
27880 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27881 .endd
27882 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
27883 Consider this example:
27884 .code
27885 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27886 list.dsbl.org : \
27887 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
27888 relays.ordb.org
27889 .endd
27890 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
27891 .code
27892 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27893 list.dsbl.org
27894 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
27895 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
27896 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
27897 .endd
27898 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
27899
27900
27901
27902
27903 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
27904 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
27905 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
27906 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
27907 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
27908 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
27909 .code
27910 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
27911 .endd
27912 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
27913 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
27914 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
27915 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
27916 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
27917 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
27918
27919 .ilist
27920 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
27921 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
27922 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27923 .next
27924 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
27925 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
27926 changed to:
27927 .code
27928 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
27929 .endd
27930 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27931 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
27932 .code
27933 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
27934 .endd
27935 for the condition to be true.
27936 .endlist
27937
27938 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
27939 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
27940 .ilist
27941 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
27942 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
27943 .code
27944 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
27945 .endd
27946 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27947 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27948 .next
27949 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
27950 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
27951 .code
27952 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
27953 .endd
27954 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27955 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
27956 .code
27957 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27958 .endd
27959 for the condition to be false.
27960 .endlist
27961 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
27962 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
27963
27964
27965
27966
27967 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
27968 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
27969 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
27970 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
27971 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
27972 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
27973 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
27974 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
27975 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
27976 lists.
27977
27978 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
27979 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
27980 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
27981 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
27982 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
27983 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
27984 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
27985 .code
27986 reject message = \
27987 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
27988 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
27989 dnslists = \
27990 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
27991 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27992 .endd
27993 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
27994 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
27995 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
27996 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
27997 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
27998 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
27999
28000 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28001 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28002 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28003 .code
28004 reject dnslists = \
28005 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28006 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28007 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28008 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28009 .endd
28010 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28011 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28012 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28013
28014
28015
28016 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28017 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28018 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28019 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28020 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28021 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28022 .code
28023 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28024 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28025 .endd
28026 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28027 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28028 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28029 .code
28030 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28031 .endd
28032 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28033 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28034
28035 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28036 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28037 .code
28038 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28039 dnslists = some.list.example
28040 .endd
28041
28042 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28043 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28044 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28045 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28046 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28047 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28048 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28049 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28050 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28051 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28052 .display
28053 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28054 .endd
28055 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28056 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28057
28058 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28059 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28060 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28061 of &'p'&.
28062
28063 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28064 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28065 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28066 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28067 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28068 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28069 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28070 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28071 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28072
28073 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28074 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28075 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28076 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28077
28078 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28079 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28080 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28081 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28082 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28083 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28084 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28085 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28086 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28087 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28088
28089 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28090 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28091 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28092 ACL.
28093
28094 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28095 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28096 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28097 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28098 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28099 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28100
28101 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28102 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28103 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28104 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28105 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28106 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28107 the &%count=%& option.
28108
28109
28110 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28111 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28112 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28113 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28114 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28115
28116 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28117 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28118 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28119 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28120
28121 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28122 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28123 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28124 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28125 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28126 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28127 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28128
28129 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28130 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28131 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28132 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28133 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28134 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28135 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28136
28137 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28138 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28139 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28140 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28141 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
28142
28143 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28144 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28145 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28146 multiple different commands.
28147
28148 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28149 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28150 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28151 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28152 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28153
28154 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28155
28156
28157 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28158 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28159 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28160 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28161 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28162
28163 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28164 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28165
28166 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28167 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28168 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28169 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28170 new rate.
28171 .code
28172 acl_check_connect:
28173 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28174 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28175 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28176 # ...
28177 acl_check_mail:
28178 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28179 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28180 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28181 .endd
28182
28183 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28184 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28185 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28186 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28187 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28188 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28189 checks.
28190
28191 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28192 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28193 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28194 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28195 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28196
28197
28198 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28199 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28200 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28201 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28202 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28203 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28204 rest of the ACL.
28205
28206 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28207 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28208 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28209 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28210 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28211 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28212 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28213 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28214 from getting any email through.
28215
28216 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28217 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28218 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28219 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28220 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28221 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28222 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28223 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28224 .code
28225 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28226 .endd
28227
28228
28229 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28230 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28231 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28232 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28233 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28234 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28235 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28236 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28237 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28238
28239 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28240 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28241 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28242 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28243 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28244 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28245
28246 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28247 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28248 rate.
28249
28250 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28251 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28252 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28253 required increases with larger limits.
28254
28255 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28256 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28257 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28258 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28259 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28260 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28261 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28262 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28263 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28264 as intended.
28265
28266
28267 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28268 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28269 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28270 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28271 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28272 message. For example:
28273 .code
28274 # Log all senders' rates
28275 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28276 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28277
28278 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28279 # at the decimal point.
28280 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28281 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28282 $sender_rate_limit }s
28283
28284 # Keep authenticated users under control
28285 deny authenticated = *
28286 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28287
28288 # System-wide rate limit
28289 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28290 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28291
28292 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28293 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28294 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28295 messages per $sender_rate_period
28296 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28297 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28298 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28299 .endd
28300 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28301 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28302 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28303 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28304 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28305 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28306 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28307
28308
28309
28310 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28311 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28312 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28313 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28314 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28315 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28316 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28317 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28318 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28319 .code
28320 verify = sender/callout
28321 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28322 .endd
28323 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28324 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28325 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28326 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28327 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28328 The available options are as follows:
28329
28330 .ilist
28331 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28332 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28333 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28334 .next
28335 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28336 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28337 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28338 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28339 .next
28340 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28341 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28342 .next
28343 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28344 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28345 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28346 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28347 .endlist
28348
28349 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28350 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28351 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28352 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28353 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28354 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28355 coding like this:
28356 .code
28357 warn !verify = sender
28358 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28359 .endd
28360 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28361 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28362 verification failure.
28363
28364 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28365 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28366
28367 .ilist
28368 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28369 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28370 .next
28371 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28372 .next
28373 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28374 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28375 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28376 .next
28377 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28378 .next
28379 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28380 .endlist
28381
28382 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28383 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28384
28385
28386
28387
28388 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28389 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28390 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28391 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28392 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28393 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28394 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28395 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28396 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28397 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28398 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28399 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28400 sender's domain.
28401
28402 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28403 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28404 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28405 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28406 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28407 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28408
28409 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28410 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28411 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28412 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28413 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28414
28415 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28416 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28417 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28418 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28419 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28420 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28421 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28422 supplies a host list.
28423
28424 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28425 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28426 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28427 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28428 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28429 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28430 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28431
28432 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28433 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28434 following SMTP commands are sent:
28435 .display
28436 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28437 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
28438 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28439 &`QUIT`&
28440 .endd
28441 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28442 set to &"lmtp"&.
28443
28444 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28445 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28446 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28447 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28448 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28449 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28450
28451 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28452 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28453 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28454 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28455 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28456
28457 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28458 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28459 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28460 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28461 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28462
28463
28464
28465
28466 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28467 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28468 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28469 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28470 .code
28471 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28472 .endd
28473 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28474 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28475 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28476
28477
28478 .vlist
28479 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28480 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28481 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28482 For example:
28483 .code
28484 verify = sender/callout=5s
28485 .endd
28486 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28487 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28488 the &%connect%& parameter.
28489
28490
28491 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28492 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28493 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28494 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28495 .code
28496 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28497 .endd
28498 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28499
28500 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28501 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28502 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28503 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28504 updated in this circumstance.
28505
28506 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28507 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28508 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28509 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28510 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28511 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28512
28513
28514 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28515 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28516 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28517 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28518 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28519 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28520 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28521 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28522 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28523 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28524 .code
28525 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28526 .endd
28527 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28528
28529
28530 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28531 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28532 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28533 For example:
28534 .code
28535 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28536 .endd
28537 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28538 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28539 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28540 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28541 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
28542
28543
28544 .vitem &*no_cache*&
28545 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28546 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28547 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28548
28549 .vitem &*postmaster*&
28550 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28551 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28552 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28553 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28554 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28555 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28556 made, until the cache record expires.
28557
28558 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28559 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28560 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28561 For example:
28562 .code
28563 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28564 .endd
28565 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28566 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28567 .code
28568 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28569 .endd
28570 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28571 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28572 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28573 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28574
28575
28576 .vitem &*random*&
28577 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28578 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28579 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28580 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28581 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28582 .code
28583 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28584 .endd
28585 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28586 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28587 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28588 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28589 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28590
28591 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28592 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28593 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28594 .code
28595 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28596 .endd
28597 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28598 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28599 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28600 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28601 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28602
28603 .vitem &*use_sender*&
28604 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28605 .code
28606 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28607 .endd
28608 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28609 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28610 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28611 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28612 usefulness of callout caching.
28613 .endlist
28614
28615 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28616 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28617 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28618 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28619 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28620 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28621 these circumstances.
28622
28623 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28624 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28625 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28626 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28627 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28628 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28629 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28630
28631 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28632 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28633 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28634 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28635
28636
28637
28638
28639 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28640 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28641 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28642 .cindex "caching" "callout"
28643 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28644 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28645 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28646 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28647 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28648 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28649
28650 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28651 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28652 is not available.
28653
28654 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
28655 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
28656 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
28657
28658 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
28659 commands up to and including
28660 .code
28661 MAIL FROM:<>
28662 .endd
28663 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
28664 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
28665 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
28666 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
28667 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
28668 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
28669 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
28670
28671 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
28672 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
28673 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
28674 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
28675 will eventually be noticed.
28676
28677 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
28678 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
28679 behaviour will be the same.
28680
28681
28682
28683 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
28684 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
28685 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
28686 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
28687 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
28688 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
28689 you might see:
28690 .code
28691 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
28692 250 OK
28693 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
28694 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
28695 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
28696 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
28697 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
28698 550 Sender verification failed
28699 .endd
28700 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
28701 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
28702 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
28703 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
28704 example:
28705 .code
28706 verify = sender/no_details
28707 .endd
28708
28709 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
28710 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
28711 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
28712 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
28713 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
28714 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
28715 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
28716
28717 .ilist
28718 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
28719 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
28720 verification also fails.
28721 .next
28722 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
28723 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
28724 .endlist
28725
28726 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
28727 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
28728 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
28729 .code
28730 A.Wol: aw123
28731 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
28732 .endd
28733 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
28734 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
28735 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
28736 verification to succeed.
28737
28738 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
28739 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
28740 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
28741 option. For example:
28742 .code
28743 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
28744 .endd
28745 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
28746 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
28747
28748 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
28749 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
28750 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
28751 address and a report is output for each of them.
28752
28753
28754
28755 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
28756 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
28757 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
28758 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
28759 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
28760 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
28761 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
28762 .code
28763 verify = csa
28764 .endd
28765 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
28766 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
28767 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
28768 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
28769 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
28770 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
28771
28772 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
28773 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
28774 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
28775 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
28776
28777 .ilist
28778 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
28779 .next
28780 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
28781 .next
28782 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
28783 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
28784 .next
28785 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
28786 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
28787 .endlist
28788
28789 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
28790 use for the DNS query. The default is:
28791 .code
28792 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
28793 .endd
28794 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
28795 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
28796 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
28797 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
28798 meaningful to say:
28799 .code
28800 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
28801 .endd
28802 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
28803 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
28804 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
28805
28806 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
28807 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
28808 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
28809 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
28810 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
28811 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
28812 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
28813 of legitimate HELO domains.
28814
28815 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
28816 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
28817 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
28818 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
28819 lookup such as:
28820 .code
28821 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
28822 .endd
28823 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
28824 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
28825 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
28826
28827
28828
28829
28830 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
28831 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
28832 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
28833 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
28834 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28835 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28836 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28837 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
28838
28839 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
28840 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
28841 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
28842 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
28843 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
28844 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
28845 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
28846
28847 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
28848 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
28849 like this:
28850 .code
28851 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
28852 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
28853 }{$value}}
28854 .endd
28855 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
28856 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
28857 use this:
28858 .code
28859 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
28860 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
28861 senders = :
28862 recipients = +batv_senders
28863
28864 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
28865 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
28866 senders = :
28867 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
28868 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
28869 !condition = $prvscheck_result
28870 .endd
28871 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
28872 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
28873 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
28874 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
28875 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
28876
28877 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
28878 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
28879 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
28880 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
28881 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
28882 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
28883 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
28884
28885 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
28886 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
28887 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
28888 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
28889 .code
28890 batv_redirect:
28891 driver = redirect
28892 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
28893 .endd
28894 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
28895 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
28896 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
28897 local addresses.
28898
28899 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
28900 can be used:
28901 .code
28902 external_smtp_batv:
28903 driver = smtp
28904 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
28905 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
28906 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
28907 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
28908 {$value}fail}}}
28909 .endd
28910 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
28911
28912
28913
28914 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
28915 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
28916 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
28917 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
28918 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
28919 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
28920 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
28921 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
28922 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
28923 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
28924
28925 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
28926 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
28927 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
28928 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
28929 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
28930 same host is fulfilling both functions,
28931 . ///
28932 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
28933 . ///
28934 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
28935 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
28936 system to arbitrary domains.
28937
28938
28939 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
28940 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
28941 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
28942 example, suppose you want to do the following:
28943
28944 .ilist
28945 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
28946 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
28947 &'my.dom2.example'&.
28948 .next
28949 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
28950 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
28951 .next
28952 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
28953 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
28954 .endlist
28955
28956
28957 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
28958 .code
28959 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
28960 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
28961 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
28962 .endd
28963 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
28964 command:
28965 .code
28966 acl_check_rcpt:
28967 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
28968 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
28969 .endd
28970 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
28971 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
28972 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
28973 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
28974 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
28975 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
28976 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28977
28978
28979
28980 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
28981 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
28982 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
28983 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
28984 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28985
28986 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
28987 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
28988 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
28989 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
28990 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
28991 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
28992 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
28993 .ecindex IIDacl
28994
28995
28996
28997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28999
29000 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29001 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29002 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29003 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29004 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29005 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29006 specification.
29007
29008 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29009 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29010 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29011 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29012 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29013
29014 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29015 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29016 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29017
29018 .ilist
29019 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29020 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29021 .next
29022 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29023 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29024 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29025 .next
29026 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29027 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29028 .next
29029 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29030 conditions.
29031 .next
29032 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29033 .endlist
29034
29035 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29036 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29037 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29038
29039 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29040 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29041 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29042 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29043 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29044 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29045
29046 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29047 temporarily created in a file called:
29048 .display
29049 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29050 .endd
29051 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29052 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29053 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29054 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29055 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29056 .code
29057 control = no_mbox_unspool
29058 .endd
29059 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29060 same directory by default.
29061
29062
29063
29064 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29065 .cindex "virus scanning"
29066 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29067 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29068 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29069 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29070 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29071 in memory and thus are much faster.
29072
29073
29074 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29075 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29076 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29077 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29078 .display
29079 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29080 .endd
29081 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29082 .code
29083 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29084 .endd
29085 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29086 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29087
29088 .vlist
29089 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29090 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29091 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29092 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29093 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29094 example:
29095 .code
29096 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29097 .endd
29098
29099
29100 .vitem &%clamd%&
29101 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29102 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29103 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29104 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29105 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29106 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29107 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29108 .code
29109 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29110 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29111 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29112 .endd
29113 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29114 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29115 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29116 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29117 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29118 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29119 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29120 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29121 contributing the code for this scanner.
29122
29123 .vitem &%cmdline%&
29124 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29125 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29126 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29127 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29128
29129 .olist
29130 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29131 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29132
29133 .next
29134 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29135 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29136 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29137 the &"trigger"& expression.
29138
29139 .next
29140 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29141 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29142 &"name"& expression.
29143 .endlist olist
29144
29145 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29146 .code
29147 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29148 .endd
29149 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29150 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29151 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29152 configuration setting:
29153 .code
29154 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29155 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29156 found in file:'(.+)'
29157 .endd
29158 .vitem &%drweb%&
29159 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29160 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29161 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29162 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29163 .code
29164 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29165 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29166 .endd
29167 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29168 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29169
29170 .vitem &%fsecure%&
29171 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29172 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29173 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29174 .code
29175 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29176 .endd
29177 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29178 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29179
29180 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29181 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29182 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29183 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29184 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29185 For example:
29186 .code
29187 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29188 .endd
29189 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29190
29191 .vitem &%mksd%&
29192 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29193 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29194 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29195 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29196 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29197 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29198 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29199 .code
29200 av_scanner = mksd:2
29201 .endd
29202 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29203
29204 .vitem &%sophie%&
29205 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29206 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29207 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29208 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29209 client communication. For example:
29210 .code
29211 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29212 .endd
29213 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29214 the option.
29215 .endlist
29216
29217 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29218 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29219 ACL.
29220
29221 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29222 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29223 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29224 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29225 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29226 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29227 message.
29228
29229 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29230 use. It can then be one of
29231
29232 .ilist
29233 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29234 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29235 recommended usage.
29236 .next
29237 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29238 the condition fails immediately.
29239 .next
29240 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29241 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29242 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29243 .endlist
29244
29245 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29246 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29247 causes the ACL to defer.
29248
29249 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29250 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29251 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29252 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29253 logging data.
29254
29255 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29256 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29257 &%malware%& condition.
29258
29259 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29260 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29261
29262 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29263 .code
29264 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29265 demime = *
29266 malware = *
29267 .endd
29268 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29269 .code
29270 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29271 demime = *
29272 malware = */defer_ok
29273 .endd
29274 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29275 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29276 .code
29277 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29278 .endd
29279 in the main Exim configuration.
29280 .code
29281 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29282 set acl_m0 = sophie
29283 malware = *
29284
29285 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29286 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29287 malware = *
29288 .endd
29289
29290
29291 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29292 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29293 .cindex "spam scanning"
29294 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29295 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29296 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29297 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29298 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29299 .code
29300 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29301 .endd
29302 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29303 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29304 nicely, however.
29305
29306 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29307 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29308 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29309 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29310 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29311 .code
29312 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29313 .endd
29314 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29315 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29316 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29317 address/port pair:
29318 .code
29319 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29320 .endd
29321 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29322 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29323 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29324 option, separated with colons:
29325 .code
29326 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29327 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29328 192.168.2.12 783
29329 .endd
29330 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29331 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29332 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29333 condition defers.
29334
29335 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29336 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29337
29338 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29339 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29340 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29341 expansion.
29342
29343 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29344 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29345 .code
29346 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29347 spam = joe
29348 .endd
29349 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29350 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29351 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29352 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29353 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29354
29355 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29356 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29357 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29358 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29359 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29360 are not set.
29361
29362 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29363 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29364 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29365
29366
29367 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29368 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29369 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29370 example:
29371 .code
29372 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29373 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29374 spam = nobody
29375 .endd
29376
29377 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29378 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29379 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29380 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29381
29382 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29383 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29384 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29385 available for use at delivery time.
29386
29387 .vlist
29388 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29389 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29390 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29391
29392 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29393 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29394 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29395 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29396 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29397
29398 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29399 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29400 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29401 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29402 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29403
29404 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29405 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29406 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29407 .endlist
29408
29409 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29410 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29411 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29412
29413 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29414 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29415 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29416 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29417 spam condition, like this:
29418 .code
29419 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29420 spam = joe/defer_ok
29421 .endd
29422 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29423
29424 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29425 condition:
29426 .code
29427 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29428 warn spam = nobody:true
29429 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29430 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29431
29432 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29433 # is over threshold
29434 warn spam = nobody
29435 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29436
29437 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29438 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29439 spam = nobody:true
29440 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29441 .endd
29442
29443
29444
29445 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29446 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29447 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29448 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29449 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29450 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29451 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29452 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29453 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29454 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29455 cases.
29456
29457 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29458 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29459 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29460 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29461 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29462 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29463 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29464
29465 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29466 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29467 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29468 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29469 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29470
29471 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29472 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29473 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29474 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29475 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29476 syntax is:
29477 .display
29478 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29479 .endd
29480 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29481 the value can be:
29482
29483 .olist
29484 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29485 .next
29486 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29487 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29488 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29489 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29490 .next
29491 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29492 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29493 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29494 the full path and file name.
29495 .next
29496 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29497 filename, and the default path is then used.
29498 .endlist
29499 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29500 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29501 a file with its original, proposed filename using
29502 .code
29503 decode = $mime_filename
29504 .endd
29505 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29506 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29507 automatically unlinked.
29508
29509 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29510 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29511 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29512 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29513 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29514
29515 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29516 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29517 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29518
29519 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29520 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29521 available in the MIME ACL:
29522
29523 .vlist
29524 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29525 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29526 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29527 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29528 contains the empty string.
29529
29530 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
29531 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29532 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29533 .code
29534 us-ascii
29535 gb2312 (Chinese)
29536 iso-8859-1
29537 .endd
29538 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29539 case-insensitively.
29540
29541 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29542 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29543 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29544 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29545 only used for display purposes.
29546
29547 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29548 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29549 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29550
29551 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29552 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29553 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29554
29555 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29556 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29557 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29558 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29559 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29560
29561 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29562 This variable contains the normalized content of the
29563 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29564 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29565
29566 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29567 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29568 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29569 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29570 .code
29571 text/plain
29572 text/html
29573 application/octet-stream
29574 image/jpeg
29575 audio/midi
29576 .endd
29577 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29578 empty string.
29579
29580 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29581 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29582 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29583 containing the decoded data.
29584 .endlist
29585
29586 .cindex "RFC 2047"
29587 .vlist
29588 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
29589 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29590 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29591 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29592 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29593 found, this variable contains the empty string.
29594
29595 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29596 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29597 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29598 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29599
29600 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29601 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29602 follows:
29603
29604 .olist
29605 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29606
29607 .next
29608 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29609 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29610
29611 .next
29612 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29613 and the rest are attachments.
29614
29615 .next
29616 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29617 .endlist olist
29618
29619 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29620 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29621 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29622 .code
29623 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29624 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29625 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29626 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29627 .endd
29628 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29629 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29630 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29631 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29632 want to carry out specific actions on them.
29633
29634 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29635 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29636 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29637 decoding is fully recursive.
29638
29639 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29640 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29641 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29642 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29643 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29644 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29645 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29646 .endlist
29647
29648
29649
29650 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29651 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29652 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29653 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29654 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
29655
29656 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
29657 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
29658 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
29659 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
29660 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
29661
29662 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
29663 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
29664 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
29665 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
29666 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
29667 32K characters are checked.
29668
29669 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
29670 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
29671 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
29672 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
29673 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
29674 .code
29675 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
29676 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
29677 .endd
29678 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
29679 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
29680 matching regular expression.
29681
29682 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
29683 CPU-intensive.
29684
29685
29686
29687
29688 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
29689 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
29690 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29691 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
29692 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
29693 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
29694 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
29695 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
29696 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
29697 use the &%demime%& condition.
29698
29699 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
29700 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
29701 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
29702 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
29703 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
29704 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
29705
29706 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
29707 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
29708 example:
29709 .code
29710 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
29711 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
29712 .endd
29713 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
29714 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
29715 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
29716 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
29717
29718 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
29719 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
29720 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
29721
29722 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
29723
29724 .vlist
29725 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
29726 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
29727 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
29728 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
29729 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
29730 zero, no error occurred.
29731
29732 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
29733 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
29734 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
29735 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
29736 .endlist
29737
29738 .vlist
29739 .vitem &$found_extension$&
29740 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
29741 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
29742 extension it found.
29743 .endlist
29744
29745 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
29746 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
29747
29748 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
29749 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
29750 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
29751 facility:
29752 .code
29753 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
29754 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
29755 demime = *
29756 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
29757
29758 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
29759 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
29760 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
29761 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
29762
29763 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
29764 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
29765 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
29766 demime = exe:doc
29767 control = freeze
29768 .endd
29769 .ecindex IIDcosca
29770
29771
29772
29773
29774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29776
29777 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
29778 "Local scan function"
29779 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
29780 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
29781 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
29782 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
29783 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
29784
29785 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
29786 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
29787 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
29788 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
29789 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
29790
29791 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
29792 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
29793 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
29794 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
29795
29796 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
29797 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
29798 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
29799 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
29800
29801 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
29802 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
29803 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
29804 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
29805 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
29806 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
29807 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
29808 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
29809 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
29810
29811
29812
29813 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
29814 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
29815 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
29816 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
29817 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
29818 directory, so you might set
29819 .code
29820 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
29821 .endd
29822 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
29823 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
29824 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
29825 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
29826 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
29827 _src/local_scan.c_.
29828
29829 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
29830 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
29831 .code
29832 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29833 .endd
29834 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
29835
29836
29837
29838
29839 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
29840 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
29841 You must include this line near the start of your code:
29842 .code
29843 #include "local_scan.h"
29844 .endd
29845 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
29846 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
29847 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
29848 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
29849 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
29850 strings and pointers to character strings:
29851 .code
29852 #define CS (char *)
29853 #define CCS (const char *)
29854 #define CSS (char **)
29855 #define US (unsigned char *)
29856 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
29857 #define USS (unsigned char **)
29858 .endd
29859 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
29860 .code
29861 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
29862 .endd
29863 The arguments are as follows:
29864
29865 .ilist
29866 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
29867 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
29868 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
29869
29870 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
29871 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
29872 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
29873 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
29874 case this changes in some future version.
29875 .next
29876 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
29877 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
29878 .endlist
29879
29880 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
29881
29882 .vlist
29883 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
29884 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
29885 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
29886 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
29887 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
29888 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
29889
29890 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
29891 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29892 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
29893
29894 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
29895 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29896 queued without immediate delivery.
29897
29898 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
29899 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
29900 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
29901 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
29902 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
29903 used.
29904
29905 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
29906 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
29907 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
29908 problem"& is used.
29909
29910 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29911 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
29912 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
29913 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
29914 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
29915 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
29916 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29917
29918 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29919 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
29920 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29921 .endlist
29922
29923 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
29924 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
29925 &%-oe%& command line options.
29926
29927
29928
29929 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
29930 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
29931 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
29932 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
29933 want to do this, you must have the line
29934 .code
29935 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29936 .endd
29937 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
29938 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
29939 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
29940 to define them.
29941
29942 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
29943 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
29944 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
29945 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
29946 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
29947 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
29948 .code
29949 static int my_integer_option = 42;
29950 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
29951
29952 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
29953 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
29954 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
29955 };
29956
29957 int local_scan_options_count =
29958 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
29959 .endd
29960 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
29961 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
29962 .code
29963 begin local_scan
29964 my_integer = 99
29965 my_string = some string of text...
29966 .endd
29967 The available types of option data are as follows:
29968
29969 .vlist
29970 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
29971 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
29972 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
29973 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
29974 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
29975 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
29976 values.)
29977
29978 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
29979 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
29980 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
29981 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
29982
29983 .vitem &*opt_int*&
29984 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
29985 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
29986 Exim.
29987
29988 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
29989 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
29990 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
29991 printed with the suffix K or M.
29992
29993 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
29994 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
29995 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
29996 always output in octal.
29997
29998 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
29999 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30000 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30001
30002 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30003 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30004 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30005 .endlist
30006
30007 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30008 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30009
30010
30011
30012 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30013 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30014 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30015 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30016 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30017 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30018 C variables are as follows:
30019
30020 .vlist
30021 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30022 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30023
30024 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30025 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30026
30027 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30028 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30029 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30030 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30031
30032 .ilist
30033 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30034 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30035 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30036
30037 .next
30038 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30039 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30040 of debugging bits.
30041 .endlist ilist
30042
30043 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30044 selected, you should use code like this:
30045 .code
30046 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30047 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30048 .endd
30049 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30050 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30051 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30052
30053 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30054 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30055 discussed below.
30056
30057 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30058 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30059
30060 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30061 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30062
30063 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30064 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30065 &%-bh%& command line option.
30066
30067 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30068 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30069 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30070
30071 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30072 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30073 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30074 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30075
30076 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30077 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30078 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30079
30080 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30081 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30082
30083 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30084 The number of accepted recipients.
30085
30086 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30087 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30088 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30089 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30090 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30091 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30092 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30093 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30094 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30095 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30096 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30097 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30098
30099 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30100 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30101
30102 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30103 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30104 locally-submitted messages.
30105
30106 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30107 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30108 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30109
30110 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30111 The name of the sending host, if known.
30112
30113 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30114 The port on the sending host.
30115
30116 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30117 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30118
30119 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30120 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30121
30122 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30123 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30124 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30125 .endlist
30126
30127
30128 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30129 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30130 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30131 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30132 their type to *.
30133
30134
30135 .vlist
30136 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30137 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30138
30139 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30140 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30141 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30142 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30143 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30144 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30145 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30146
30147 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30148 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30149 internal newlines.
30150
30151 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30152 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30153 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30154 .endlist
30155
30156
30157
30158 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30159 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30160
30161 .vlist
30162 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30163 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30164
30165 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30166 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30167 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30168 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30169
30170 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30171 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30172 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30173 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30174 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30175 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30176 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30177 is NULL for all recipients.
30178 .endlist
30179
30180
30181
30182 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30183 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30184 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30185 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30186 release:
30187
30188 .vlist
30189 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30190 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30191
30192 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30193 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30194 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30195 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30196
30197 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30198 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30199 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30200 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30201 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30202
30203 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30204
30205 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30206 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30207 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30208 return value is as follows:
30209
30210 .ilist
30211 >= 0
30212
30213 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30214 ending status.
30215
30216 .next
30217 < 0 and > &--256
30218
30219 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30220 signal number.
30221
30222 .next
30223 &--256
30224
30225 The process timed out.
30226 .next
30227 &--257
30228
30229 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30230 .endlist
30231
30232 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30233 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30234 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30235 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30236 forks a subprocess that is running
30237 .code
30238 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30239 .endd
30240 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30241 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30242 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30243 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30244
30245 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30246 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30247 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30248 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30249
30250
30251 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30252 *sender_authentication)*&
30253 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30254 that it runs is:
30255 .display
30256 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30257 .endd
30258 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30259
30260
30261 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30262 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30263 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30264 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30265 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30266 .code
30267 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30268 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30269 .endd
30270
30271 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30272 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30273 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30274 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30275 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30276 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30277 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30278 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30279
30280 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30281 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30282 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30283 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30284 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30285 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30286
30287 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30288 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30289 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30290 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30291
30292 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30293 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30294 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30295 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30296 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30297 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30298 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30299 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30300 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30301 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30302 .code
30303 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30304 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30305 .endd
30306 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30307 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30308
30309
30310 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30311 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30312 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30313 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30314 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30315
30316
30317 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30318 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30319 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30320 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30321 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30322 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30323 .code
30324 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30325 .endd
30326 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30327 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30328 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30329 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30330 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30331 zero-terminated.
30332
30333 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30334 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30335 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30336 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30337 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30338 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30339 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30340 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30341
30342 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30343 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30344 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30345 .display
30346 &`OK `& match succeeded
30347 &`FAIL `& match failed
30348 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30349 .endd
30350 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30351 inability to contact a database.
30352
30353 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30354 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30355 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30356 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30357 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30358
30359 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30360 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30361 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30362 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30363 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30364
30365 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30366 uschar&~*list)*&"
30367 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30368 expected to be
30369 .code
30370 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30371 .endd
30372 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30373 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30374 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30375 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30376 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30377 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30378 failed.
30379
30380 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30381 *format,&~...)*&"
30382 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30383 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30384 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30385 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30386 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30387 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30388
30389
30390 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30391 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30392 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30393 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30394
30395 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30396 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30397 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30398 value afterwards. For example:
30399 .code
30400 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30401 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30402 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30403 .endd
30404
30405 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30406 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30407 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30408 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30409 address.
30410 .endlist
30411
30412
30413 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30414 .vlist
30415 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30416 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30417 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30418 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30419 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30420 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30421 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30422 binary string is returned with an error message.
30423
30424 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30425 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30426 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30427
30428 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30429 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30430 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30431 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30432 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30433
30434 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30435 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30436 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30437
30438 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30439 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30440 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30441 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30442 with translation.
30443
30444
30445 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30446 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30447 below.
30448
30449 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30450 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30451 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30452 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30453 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30454 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30455 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30456 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30457 is involved.
30458
30459 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30460 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30461
30462 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30463 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30464 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30465 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30466 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30467 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30468 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30469 .code
30470 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30471 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30472 .endd
30473 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30474 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30475 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30476 multiple output lines.
30477
30478 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30479 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30480 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30481 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30482 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30483 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30484 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30485 is an error.
30486
30487 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30488 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30489 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30490 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30491
30492 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30493 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30494 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30495
30496 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30497 See below.
30498
30499 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30500 See below.
30501
30502 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30503 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30504 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30505 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30506 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30507 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30508 more discussion.
30509 .endlist
30510
30511
30512
30513 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30514 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30515 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30516 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30517 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30518 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30519 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30520 terminates.
30521
30522 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30523 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30524 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30525 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30526
30527 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30528 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30529 .code
30530 store_pool = POOL_PERM
30531 .endd
30532 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30533 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30534 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30535 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30536
30537 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30538 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30539 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30540 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30541 &%store_pool%&.
30542 .ecindex IIDlosca
30543
30544
30545
30546
30547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30549
30550 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30551 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30552 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30553 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30554 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30555 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30556 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30557 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30558
30559 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30560 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30561 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30562 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30563 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30564
30565 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30566 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30567 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30568 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30569 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30570 prevent it happening on retries.
30571
30572 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30573 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30574 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30575 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30576 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30577 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30578 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30579 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30580
30581
30582 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30583 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30584 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30585 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30586 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30587 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30588 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30589 .code
30590 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30591 system_filter_user = exim
30592 .endd
30593 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30594 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30595 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30596 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30597 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30598 by the &%reply%& command.
30599
30600
30601 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30602 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30603 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30604 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30605
30606 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30607 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30608
30609
30610
30611 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30612 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30613 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30614 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30615 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30616 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30617 they cause errors.
30618
30619 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30620 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30621 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30622 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30623 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30624 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30625 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30626
30627 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30628 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30629 succeed, it will not be tried again.
30630 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30631 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30632
30633 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30634 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30635 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30636 to which users' filter files can refer.
30637
30638
30639
30640 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30641 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
30642 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30643 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30644 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30645
30646
30647
30648 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30649 .cindex "freezing messages"
30650 .cindex "message" "freezing"
30651 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
30652 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30653 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30654 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
30655 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
30656 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
30657 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
30658 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
30659 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
30660 .code
30661 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
30662 .endd
30663 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
30664
30665 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
30666 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
30667 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
30668 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
30669 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
30670 run.
30671
30672 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
30673 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
30674 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
30675 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
30676
30677 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
30678 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
30679 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
30680 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
30681 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
30682 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
30683 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
30684 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
30685 message. For example:
30686 .code
30687 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
30688 because it contains attachments that we are \
30689 not prepared to receive."
30690 .endd
30691
30692 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
30693 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
30694 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
30695 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
30696 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
30697 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
30698 use, for example
30699 .code
30700 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
30701 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
30702 .endd
30703 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
30704 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
30705 generated by the filter.
30706
30707 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
30708 &%defer%&,
30709 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
30710 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
30711 as
30712 .code
30713 mail ...
30714 freeze
30715 .endd
30716 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
30717 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
30718 take place.
30719
30720
30721
30722 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
30723 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
30724 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
30725 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
30726 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
30727 .code
30728 headers add <string>
30729 headers remove <string>
30730 .endd
30731 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
30732 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
30733 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
30734 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
30735 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
30736
30737 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
30738 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
30739 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
30740 example:
30741 .code
30742 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
30743 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
30744 X-header-2: ...."
30745 .endd
30746 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
30747 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
30748 space after input continuations is ignored.
30749
30750 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
30751 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
30752 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
30753 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
30754 header with the same name, they are all removed.
30755
30756 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
30757 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
30758 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
30759 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
30760 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
30761 used for all recipients of the message.
30762
30763 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
30764 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
30765 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
30766 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
30767 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
30768 until the message is actually being written (see section
30769 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
30770
30771 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
30772 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
30773 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
30774 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
30775 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
30776 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
30777 modified more than once.
30778
30779 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
30780 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
30781 For example:
30782 .code
30783 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
30784 headers remove "Subject"
30785 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
30786 headers remove "Old-Subject"
30787 .endd
30788
30789
30790
30791 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
30792 .cindex "envelope sender"
30793 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
30794 .code
30795 errors_to <some address>
30796 .endd
30797 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
30798 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
30799 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
30800 might use
30801 .code
30802 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
30803 .endd
30804 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
30805 address if its delivery failed.
30806
30807
30808
30809 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
30810 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30811 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30812 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
30813 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
30814 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
30815 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
30816 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
30817 which implements such a filter:
30818 .code
30819 central_filter:
30820 check_local_user
30821 driver = redirect
30822 domains = +local_domains
30823 file = /central/filters/$local_part
30824 no_verify
30825 allow_filter
30826 allow_freeze
30827 .endd
30828 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
30829 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
30830 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
30831 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
30832
30833 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
30834 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30835 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30836 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30837 normal way.
30838 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
30839 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
30840 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
30841
30842
30843
30844
30845
30846
30847 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30848 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30849
30850 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
30851 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
30852 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
30853 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
30854 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
30855 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
30856 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
30857 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
30858
30859 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
30860 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
30861 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
30862 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
30863 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
30864
30865 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
30866 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
30867 loopback interface specially in any way.
30868
30869 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
30870 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
30871
30872
30873
30874
30875 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
30876 .cindex "message" "submission"
30877 .cindex "submission mode"
30878 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
30879 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
30880 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
30881 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
30882 .code
30883 control = submission
30884 .endd
30885 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
30886 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
30887 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
30888 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
30889 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
30890 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
30891 .code
30892 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
30893 control = submission
30894 .endd
30895 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
30896 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
30897 is used to separate options. For example:
30898 .code
30899 control = submission/sender_retain
30900 .endd
30901 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
30902 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
30903 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
30904 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
30905 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
30906 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
30907 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
30908
30909 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
30910 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
30911 example:
30912 .code
30913 control = submission/domain=some.domain
30914 .endd
30915 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
30916 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
30917 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
30918 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
30919 .code
30920 accept authenticated = *
30921 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
30922 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
30923 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
30924 .endd
30925 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
30926 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
30927 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
30928 .code
30929 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
30930 .endd
30931 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
30932 line would be:
30933 .code
30934 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
30935 .endd
30936 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
30937 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
30938 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
30939 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
30940
30941 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
30942 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
30943 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
30944 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
30945 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
30946 spoof another's address.
30947
30948 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
30949 .cindex "line endings"
30950 .cindex "carriage return"
30951 .cindex "linefeed"
30952 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
30953 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
30954 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
30955 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
30956 use CRLF or just CR.
30957
30958 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
30959 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
30960 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
30961 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
30962 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
30963 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
30964 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
30965 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
30966 follows:
30967
30968 .ilist
30969 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
30970 .next
30971 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
30972 is ignored.
30973 .next
30974 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
30975 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
30976 terminator.
30977 .next
30978 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
30979 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
30980 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
30981 people trying to play silly games.
30982 .next
30983 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
30984 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
30985 line.
30986 .endlist
30987
30988
30989
30990
30991
30992 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
30993 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
30994 .cindex "address" "qualification"
30995 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
30996 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
30997 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
30998 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
30999 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31000
31001 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31002 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31003 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31004 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31005 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31006
31007 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31008 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31009 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31010 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31011 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31012 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31013 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31014 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31015
31016
31017
31018
31019 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31020 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31021 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31022 .cindex "sender" "address"
31023 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31024 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31025 .cindex "envelope sender"
31026 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31027 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31028 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31029 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31030 .code
31031 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31032 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31033 .endd
31034 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31035 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31036 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31037 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31038 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31039 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31040 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31041 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31042 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31043
31044 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31045 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31046 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31047 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31048 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31049 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31050 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31051
31052 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31053 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31054 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31055
31056 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31057 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31058 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31059 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31060
31061
31062
31063 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31064 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31065 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31066 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31067 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31068 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31069 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31070
31071 .blockquote
31072 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31073 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31074 .endblockquote
31075
31076 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31077 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31078 follows:
31079
31080 .ilist
31081 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31082 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31083 .next
31084 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31085 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31086 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31087 .next
31088 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31089 also removed.
31090 .next
31091 For a locally-submitted message,
31092 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31093 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31094 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31095 included in log lines in this case.
31096 .next
31097 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31098 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31099 .endlist
31100
31101
31102
31103
31104 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31105 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31106 includes the header line:
31107 .code
31108 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31109 .endd
31110
31111 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31112 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31113 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31114 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31115 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31116 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31117
31118
31119 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31120 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31121 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31122 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31123 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31124
31125 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31126 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31127 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31128 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31129 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31130 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31131 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31132 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31133 messages.
31134
31135
31136 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31137 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31138 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31139 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31140 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31141 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31142 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31143 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31144 messages.
31145
31146
31147 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31148 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31149 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31150 .cindex "message" "submission"
31151 .cindex "submission mode"
31152 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31153 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31154
31155 .ilist
31156 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31157 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31158 .next
31159 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31160 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31161 .olist
31162 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31163 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31164 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31165 .next
31166 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31167 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31168 .next
31169 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31170 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31171 .endlist
31172 .endlist
31173
31174 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31175
31176 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31177 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31178 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31179 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31180 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31181 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31182 &%qualify_domain%&.
31183
31184 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31185 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31186 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31187 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31188
31189
31190 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31191 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31192 .cindex "message" "submission"
31193 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31194 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31195 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31196 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31197 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31198 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31199 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31200 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31201 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31202 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31203
31204
31205 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31206 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31207 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31208 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31209 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31210
31211 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31212 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31213 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31214 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31215
31216 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31217 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31218 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31219
31220
31221 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31222 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31223 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31224 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31225 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31226 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31227 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31228 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31229 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31230 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31231 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31232
31233
31234
31235 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31236 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31237 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31238 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31239 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31240 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31241 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31242 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31243
31244
31245
31246 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31247 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31248 .cindex "message" "submission"
31249 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31250 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31251 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31252 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31253 control setting.
31254
31255 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31256 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31257 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31258 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31259 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31260 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31261 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31262 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31263 line is added to the message.
31264
31265 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31266 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31267 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31268 options true at the same time.
31269
31270 .cindex "submission mode"
31271 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31272 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31273 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31274 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31275
31276 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31277 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31278 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31279 created as follows:
31280
31281 .ilist
31282 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31283 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31284 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31285 .next
31286 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31287 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31288 .next
31289 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31290 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31291 .endlist
31292
31293 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31294 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31295 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31296 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31297
31298 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31299 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31300 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31301 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31302
31303
31304
31305 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31306 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31307 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31308 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31309 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31310 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31311 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31312 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31313 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31314
31315 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31316 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31317 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31318 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31319 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31320 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31321
31322 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31323 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31324 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31325
31326 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31327 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31328 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31329 .code
31330 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31331 X-added-second: another added header line
31332 .endd
31333 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31334
31335 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31336 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31337 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31338 not part of the names. For example:
31339 .code
31340 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31341 .endd
31342 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31343 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31344 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31345 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31346 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31347
31348 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31349 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31350 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31351 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31352
31353 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31354 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31355 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31356 requirements.
31357
31358 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31359 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31360 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31361 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31362 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31363 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31364 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31365
31366 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31367 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31368 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31369 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31370
31371 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31372 the following consequences:
31373
31374 .ilist
31375 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31376 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31377 to it, at all times.
31378 .next
31379 Header lines that are added by a router's
31380 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31381 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31382 .next
31383 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31384 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31385 .next
31386 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31387 a later router or by a transport.
31388 .next
31389 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31390 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31391 .code
31392 headers_remove = subject
31393 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31394 .endd
31395 .endlist
31396
31397 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31398 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31399
31400
31401
31402
31403
31404 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31405 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31406 .cindex "constructed address"
31407 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31408 the form
31409 .display
31410 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31411 .endd
31412 For example:
31413 .code
31414 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31415 .endd
31416 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31417 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31418 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31419 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31420 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31421 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31422 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31423 there is no password file entry.
31424
31425 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31426 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31427 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31428 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31429 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31430 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31431 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31432 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31433 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31434
31435
31436
31437 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31438 .cindex "case of local parts"
31439 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31440 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31441 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31442 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31443 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31444 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31445 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31446 router option.
31447
31448 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31449 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31450 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31451 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31452 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31453 .code
31454 correct_case:
31455 driver = redirect
31456 domains = +local_domains
31457 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31458 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31459 @$domain
31460 .endd
31461 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31462 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31463 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31464 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31465 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31466
31467
31468
31469 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31470 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31471 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31472 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31473 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31474 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31475 empty components for compatibility.
31476
31477
31478
31479 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31480 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31481 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31482 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31483 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31484 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31485
31486 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31487 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31488 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31489 example, a header such as
31490 .code
31491 To: hare@teaparty
31492 .endd
31493 might get rewritten as
31494 .code
31495 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31496 .endd
31497 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31498 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31499 been routed.
31500
31501 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31502 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31503 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31504 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31505 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31506 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31507 .ecindex IIDmesproc
31508
31509
31510
31511 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31512 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31513
31514 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31515 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31516 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31517 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31518 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31519 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31520 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31521
31522 .ilist
31523 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31524 .next
31525 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31526 .next
31527 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31528 .endlist
31529
31530 For mail delivery, the following are available:
31531
31532 .ilist
31533 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31534 .next
31535 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31536 &"lmtp"&);
31537 .next
31538 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31539 transport);
31540 .next
31541 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31542 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31543 .endlist
31544
31545 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31546 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31547 used to contain the envelope information.
31548
31549
31550
31551 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31552 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31553 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31554 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31555 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31556 .cindex "EHLO"
31557 .cindex "HELO"
31558 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31559 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31560 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31561 processing is the same in both cases.
31562
31563 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31564 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31565 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31566 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31567 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31568 .cindex "transport" "filter"
31569 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31570 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31571 suppressed.
31572
31573 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31574 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31575 required for the transaction.
31576
31577 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31578 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31579 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31580
31581 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31582 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31583 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31584
31585 .cindex "carriage return"
31586 .cindex "linefeed"
31587 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31588 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31589 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31590 line terminator.
31591
31592 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31593 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31594 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31595 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31596 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31597 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31598 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31599 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31600 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31601
31602 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31603 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31604 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31605 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31606
31607 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31608 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31609 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31610 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31611
31612 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31613 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31614 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31615 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31616 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31617 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31618 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31619 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31620 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31621 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31622
31623 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31624 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31625
31626 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31627 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31628 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31629 square bracket of the IP address.
31630
31631
31632
31633
31634 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31635 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31636 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31637 .cindex "host" "error"
31638 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31639 message errors, and recipient errors.
31640
31641 .vlist
31642 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31643 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
31644 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
31645
31646 .ilist
31647 Connection refused or timed out,
31648 .next
31649 Any error response code on connection,
31650 .next
31651 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
31652 .next
31653 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
31654 .next
31655 I/O errors at any time,
31656 .next
31657 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
31658 the &"."& at the end of the data.
31659 .endlist ilist
31660
31661 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
31662 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
31663 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
31664 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
31665 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
31666 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
31667 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
31668 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
31669
31670 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
31671 .cindex "message" "error"
31672 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
31673 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
31674 message errors are:
31675
31676 .ilist
31677 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
31678 the data,
31679 .next
31680 Timeout after MAIL,
31681 .next
31682 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
31683 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
31684 connection at any other time.
31685 .endlist ilist
31686
31687 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
31688 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
31689 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
31690 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
31691 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
31692 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
31693 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
31694 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
31695 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
31696 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
31697
31698 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
31699 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
31700 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
31701 response to MAIL.
31702
31703 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
31704 .cindex "recipient" "error"
31705 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
31706 recipient errors are:
31707
31708 .ilist
31709 Any error response to RCPT,
31710 .next
31711 Timeout after RCPT.
31712 .endlist
31713
31714 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
31715 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
31716 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
31717 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
31718 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
31719 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
31720 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
31721 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
31722 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
31723 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
31724 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
31725 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
31726 the retry clock is reset.
31727
31728 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
31729 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
31730 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
31731 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
31732 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
31733 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
31734 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
31735 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
31736 recipient's retry time.
31737 .endlist
31738
31739 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
31740 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
31741 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
31742 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
31743 until the next delivery attempt.
31744
31745 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
31746 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
31747 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
31748 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
31749 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
31750 is created.
31751
31752 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
31753 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
31754 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
31755 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
31756 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
31757 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
31758 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
31759
31760 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
31761 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
31762 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
31763 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
31764 then to be treated as a host error.
31765
31766 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
31767 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
31768 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
31769 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
31770 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
31771
31772
31773
31774
31775 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
31776 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
31777 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
31778 .cindex "inetd"
31779 .cindex "daemon"
31780 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
31781 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
31782 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
31783 .code
31784 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
31785 .endd
31786 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
31787 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
31788 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
31789 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
31790 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
31791 stream and exits with an error code.
31792
31793 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
31794 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
31795 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
31796 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
31797
31798 .cindex "carriage return"
31799 .cindex "linefeed"
31800 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31801 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
31802 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31803 line terminator.
31804 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
31805 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
31806 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
31807
31808 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
31809 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
31810 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
31811 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
31812 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
31813 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
31814 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
31815 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
31816
31817 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31818 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
31819 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
31820 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
31821 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
31822 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
31823 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
31824 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
31825 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
31826
31827 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
31828 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
31829 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
31830
31831 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
31832 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
31833 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
31834 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
31835 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
31836
31837 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
31838 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
31839 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
31840 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
31841 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
31842 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
31843 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
31844
31845 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
31846 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
31847 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
31848 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
31849 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
31850
31851 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
31852 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
31853 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
31854 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
31855 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
31856 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
31857 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
31858 a delivery process.
31859
31860 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
31861 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
31862 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
31863 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
31864 however, available with &'inetd'&.
31865
31866 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
31867 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
31868 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
31869 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
31870
31871 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
31872 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
31873 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
31874
31875
31876
31877 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
31878 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
31879 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
31880 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
31881 the error response to the last command. The default value for
31882 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
31883 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
31884 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
31885
31886
31887 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
31888 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
31889 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
31890 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
31891 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
31892 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
31893 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
31894 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
31895 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
31896 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
31897 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
31898
31899
31900
31901 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
31902 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
31903 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
31904 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
31905 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
31906 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
31907 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
31908 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
31909
31910 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
31911 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
31912 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
31913 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
31914 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
31915 counted.
31916
31917 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
31918 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
31919 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
31920
31921 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
31922 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
31923 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
31924 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
31925 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
31926
31927
31928
31929
31930 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
31931 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
31932 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
31933 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
31934 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31935
31936 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
31937 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
31938 called with the &%-bv%& option.
31939
31940 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
31941 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
31942 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
31943 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
31944 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
31945 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
31946 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
31947 RCPT failures.
31948
31949
31950
31951 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
31952 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
31953 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
31954 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
31955 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
31956 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
31957 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31958
31959 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
31960 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
31961 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
31962 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
31963 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
31964 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
31965 argument. For example,
31966 .code
31967 ETRN #brigadoon
31968 .endd
31969 runs the command
31970 .code
31971 exim -R brigadoon
31972 .endd
31973 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
31974 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
31975 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
31976 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
31977 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
31978
31979 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
31980 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
31981 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
31982 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
31983 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
31984 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
31985 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
31986 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
31987
31988 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
31989 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
31990 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
31991 whatever the form of its argument. For
31992 example:
31993 .code
31994 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
31995 $sender_host_address
31996 .endd
31997 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31998 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
31999 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32000 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32001 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32002 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32003 for it to change them before running the command.
32004
32005
32006
32007 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32008 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32009 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32010 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32011 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32012 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32013 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32014 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32015 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32016 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32017 runs for RCPT commands:
32018 .code
32019 accept hosts = :
32020 .endd
32021 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32022
32023
32024
32025 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32026 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32027 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32028 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32029 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32030 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32031 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32032 envelope along with the message.
32033
32034 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32035 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32036 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32037 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32038 can be used to specify it.
32039
32040 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32041 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32042 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32043 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32044 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32045
32046 .vindex "&$host$&"
32047 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32048 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32049 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32050 router:
32051 .code
32052 begin routers
32053 route_append:
32054 driver = manualroute
32055 transport = smtp_appendfile
32056 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32057
32058 begin transports
32059 smtp_appendfile:
32060 driver = appendfile
32061 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32062 batch_max = 1000
32063 use_bsmtp
32064 user = exim
32065 .endd
32066 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32067 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32068 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32069
32070
32071
32072 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32073 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32074 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32075 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32076 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32077 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32078 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32079 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32080 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32081 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32082
32083 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32084 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32085
32086 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32087 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32088 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32089 make some use of automatically, for example:
32090 .code
32091 554 Unexpected end of file
32092 Transaction started in line 10
32093 Error detected in line 14
32094 .endd
32095 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32096 file, for example:
32097 .code
32098 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32099 The error message was:
32100
32101 501 '>' missing at end of address
32102
32103 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32104 The error was detected in line 12.
32105 The SMTP command at fault was:
32106
32107 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32108
32109 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32110 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32111 .endd
32112 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32113 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32114 accepted.
32115 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32116 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32117
32118
32119
32120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32121 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32122
32123 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32124 "Customizing messages"
32125 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32126 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32127 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32128 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32129 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32130
32131 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32132 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32133 option. Exim also adds the line
32134 .code
32135 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32136 .endd
32137 to all warning and bounce messages,
32138
32139
32140 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32141 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32142 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32143 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32144 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32145 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32146 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32147
32148 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32149 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32150 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32151 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32152 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32153 item.
32154
32155 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32156 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32157 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32158 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32159 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32160 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32161 option, rounded to a whole number.
32162
32163 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32164
32165 .ilist
32166 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32167 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32168 .next
32169 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32170 failing addresses with their error messages.
32171 .next
32172 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32173 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32174 .next
32175 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32176 as part of the error report.
32177 .next
32178 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32179 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32180 .next
32181 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32182 .endlist
32183
32184 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32185 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32186 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32187 .code
32188 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32189 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32190 {: returning message to sender}}
32191 ****
32192 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32193
32194 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32195 {that you sent }{sent by
32196
32197 <$sender_address>
32198
32199 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32200 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32201 ****
32202 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32203 ****
32204 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32205 ------
32206 ****
32207 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32208 only the first
32209 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32210 ****
32211 .endd
32212 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32213 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32214 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32215 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32216 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32217 text sections:
32218
32219 .ilist
32220 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32221 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32222 .next
32223 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32224 the delayed addresses.
32225 .next
32226 The third item then ends the message.
32227 .endlist
32228
32229 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32230 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32231 .code
32232 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32233 $warn_message_delay
32234 ****
32235 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32236
32237 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32238 {that you sent }{sent by
32239
32240 <$sender_address>
32241
32242 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32243 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32244
32245 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32246 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32247 The date of the message is: $h_date
32248
32249 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32250 ****
32251 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32252 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32253 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32254 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32255 the message will be returned to you.
32256 .endd
32257 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32258 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32259 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32260 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32261 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32262 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32263 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32264 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32265 handled them.
32266
32267
32268
32269
32270 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32272
32273 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32274 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32275 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32276
32277
32278
32279 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32280 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32281 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32282 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32283 routing explicitly:
32284 .code
32285 send_to_smart_host:
32286 driver = manualroute
32287 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32288 transport = remote_smtp
32289 .endd
32290 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32291 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32292 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32293 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32294 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32295
32296
32297
32298
32299 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32300 .cindex "mailing lists"
32301 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32302 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32303 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32304
32305 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32306 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32307 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32308 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32309 .code
32310 lists:
32311 driver = redirect
32312 domains = lists.example
32313 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32314 forbid_pipe
32315 forbid_file
32316 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32317 no_more
32318 .endd
32319 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32320 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32321 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32322 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32323
32324 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32325 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32326 a mailing list.
32327
32328 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32329 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32330 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32331 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32332 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32333
32334 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32335 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32336 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32337 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32338 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32339 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32340 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32341 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32342 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32343
32344
32345
32346 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32347 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32348 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32349 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32350 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32351 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32352 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32353
32354 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32355 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32356 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32357 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32358 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32359
32360
32361
32362 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32363 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32364 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32365 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32366 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32367 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32368 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32369 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32370 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32371 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32372
32373 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32374 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32375 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32376 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32377 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32378 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32379 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32380 pre-existing messages.
32381
32382 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32383 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32384 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32385 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32386 one level of expansion anyway.
32387
32388
32389
32390 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32391 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32392 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32393 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32394 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32395 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32396
32397 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32398 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32399 .code
32400 lists_request:
32401 driver = redirect
32402 domains = lists.example
32403 local_part_suffix = -request
32404 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32405 no_more
32406
32407 lists_post:
32408 driver = redirect
32409 domains = lists.example
32410 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32411 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32412 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32413 forbid_pipe
32414 forbid_file
32415 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32416 no_more
32417
32418 lists_closed:
32419 driver = redirect
32420 domains = lists.example
32421 allow_fail
32422 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32423 .endd
32424 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32425 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32426 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32427 mailing list.
32428
32429 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32430 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32431 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32432 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32433 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32434 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32435 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32436 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32437 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32438
32439 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32440 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32441 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32442
32443
32444
32445
32446 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32447 .cindex "VERP"
32448 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32449 .cindex "envelope sender"
32450 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32451 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32452 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32453 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32454 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32455 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32456
32457 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32458 .oindex &%return_path%&
32459 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32460 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32461 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32462 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32463 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32464 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32465 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32466 .code
32467 verp_smtp:
32468 driver = smtp
32469 max_rcpt = 1
32470 return_path = \
32471 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32472 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32473 .endd
32474 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32475 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32476 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32477 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32478 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32479 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32480 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32481 rewritten as
32482 .code
32483 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32484 .endd
32485 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32486 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32487 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32488 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32489 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32490 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32491
32492 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32493 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32494 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32495 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32496 .code
32497 dnslookup:
32498 driver = dnslookup
32499 domains = ! +local_domains
32500 transport = \
32501 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32502 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32503 no_more
32504 .endd
32505 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32506 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32507 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32508 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32509 address.
32510
32511 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32512 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32513 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32514 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32515 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32516 .code
32517 verp_dnslookup:
32518 driver = dnslookup
32519 domains = ! +local_domains
32520 transport = remote_smtp
32521 errors_to = \
32522 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32523 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32524 no_more
32525 .endd
32526 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32527 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32528 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32529 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32530 them.
32531
32532 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32533 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32534 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32535 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32536 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32537 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32538 used).
32539
32540
32541
32542
32543
32544
32545 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32546 .cindex "virtual domains"
32547 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
32548 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32549 meanings:
32550
32551 .ilist
32552 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32553 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32554 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32555 .next
32556 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32557 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32558 have login accounts on that host.
32559 .endlist
32560
32561 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32562 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32563 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32564 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32565 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32566 to a router of this form:
32567 .code
32568 virtual:
32569 driver = redirect
32570 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32571 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32572 no_more
32573 .endd
32574 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32575 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32576 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32577 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32578 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32579 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32580
32581 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32582 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32583 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32584 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32585
32586 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32587 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32588 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32589 .code
32590 my_domains:
32591 driver = accept
32592 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32593 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32594 transport = my_mailboxes
32595 .endd
32596 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32597 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32598 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32599 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32600 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32601 follows:
32602 .code
32603 my_mailboxes:
32604 driver = appendfile
32605 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32606 user = mail
32607 .endd
32608 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32609 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32610
32611 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32612 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32613 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32614 information about the domains.
32615
32616
32617
32618 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32619 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32620 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32621 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
32622 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
32623 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32624 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32625 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32626 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32627 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32628 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32629 example, consider this router:
32630 .code
32631 userforward:
32632 driver = redirect
32633 check_local_user
32634 file = $home/.forward
32635 local_part_suffix = -*
32636 local_part_suffix_optional
32637 allow_filter
32638 .endd
32639 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32640 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32641 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32642 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32643 .code
32644 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
32645 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
32646 endif
32647 .endd
32648 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
32649 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
32650 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
32651 control over which suffixes are valid.
32652
32653 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
32654 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
32655 another MTA:
32656 .code
32657 userforward:
32658 driver = redirect
32659 check_local_user
32660 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
32661 local_part_suffix = -*
32662 local_part_suffix_optional
32663 allow_filter
32664 .endd
32665 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
32666 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
32667 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
32668 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
32669 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
32670
32671
32672
32673 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
32674 .cindex "vacation processing"
32675 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
32676 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
32677 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
32678 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
32679 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
32680
32681 .ilist
32682 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
32683 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
32684 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
32685 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
32686 .code
32687 spqr, vacation-spqr
32688 .endd
32689 .next
32690 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
32691 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
32692 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
32693 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
32694 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
32695 message.
32696 .endlist
32697
32698 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
32699 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
32700
32701
32702
32703 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
32704 .cindex "message" "copying every"
32705 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
32706 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
32707 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
32708 each day's messages.
32709
32710 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
32711 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
32712 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
32713 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
32714
32715
32716
32717 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
32718 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
32719 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
32720 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
32721 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
32722 permanently connected.
32723
32724 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
32725 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
32726 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
32727
32728
32729 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
32730 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
32731 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
32732 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
32733 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
32734 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
32735 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
32736 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
32737
32738 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
32739 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
32740 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
32741 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
32742 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
32743 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
32744 if required.
32745
32746 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
32747 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
32748 intermittent host. For example:
32749 .code
32750 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
32751 .endd
32752 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
32753 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
32754 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
32755 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
32756 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
32757 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
32758 immediately.
32759
32760 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
32761 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
32762 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
32763 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
32764 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
32765 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
32766 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
32767
32768
32769
32770 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
32771 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
32772 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
32773 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
32774 delivered immediately.
32775
32776 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32777 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
32778 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
32779 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
32780 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
32781 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
32782 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
32783 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
32784 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
32785 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
32786 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
32787 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
32788 single SMTP connection.
32789
32790
32791
32792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32794
32795 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
32796 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
32797 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
32798 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
32799 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
32800 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
32801 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
32802 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
32803 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
32804 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
32805 messages this way.
32806
32807 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
32808 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
32809 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
32810 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
32811 email is not desirable.
32812
32813 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
32814 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
32815 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
32816 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
32817 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
32818 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
32819 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
32820
32821 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
32822 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
32823 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
32824 before sending a message to the smart host.
32825
32826 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
32827 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
32828 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
32829
32830 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
32831 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
32832 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
32833 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
32834 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
32835 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
32836 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
32837
32838 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
32839 following ways:
32840
32841 .ilist
32842 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
32843 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
32844 .next
32845 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
32846 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
32847 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
32848 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
32849 successful, a zero return code is given.
32850 .next
32851 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
32852 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
32853 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
32854 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
32855 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
32856 are.
32857 .next
32858 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
32859 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
32860 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
32861 .next
32862 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
32863 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
32864 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
32865 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
32866 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
32867 .next
32868 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
32869 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
32870 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
32871 .next
32872 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
32873 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
32874 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
32875 are ever generated.
32876 .next
32877 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
32878 .next
32879 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
32880 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
32881 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
32882 .endlist
32883
32884 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
32885 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
32886 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
32887 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
32888 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
32889 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
32890
32891
32892
32893
32894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32896
32897 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
32898 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
32899 .cindex "log" "types of"
32900 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
32901 and the panic log:
32902
32903 .ilist
32904 .cindex "main log"
32905 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
32906 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
32907 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
32908 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
32909 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
32910 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
32911 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
32912 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
32913 .next
32914 .cindex "reject log"
32915 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
32916 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
32917 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
32918 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
32919 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
32920 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
32921 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
32922 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
32923 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
32924 false.
32925 .next
32926 .cindex "panic log"
32927 .cindex "system log"
32928 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
32929 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
32930 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
32931 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
32932 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
32933 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
32934 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
32935 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
32936 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
32937 .endlist
32938
32939 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
32940 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
32941 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
32942 .code
32943 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
32944 by QUIT
32945 .endd
32946 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
32947 ways of changing this:
32948
32949 .ilist
32950 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
32951 you set
32952 .code
32953 timezone = UTC
32954 .endd
32955 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
32956 .next
32957 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
32958 example:
32959 .code
32960 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
32961 .endd
32962 .endlist
32963
32964 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32965 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32966 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
32967 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
32968 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
32969 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
32970
32971
32972
32973
32974 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
32975 .cindex "log" "destination"
32976 .cindex "log" "to file"
32977 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
32978 .cindex "syslog"
32979 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
32980 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
32981 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
32982 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
32983 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
32984 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
32985 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
32986
32987 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
32988 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
32989 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
32990 references to the host name:
32991 .code
32992 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
32993 .endd
32994 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
32995 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
32996 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
32997 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
32998 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
32999 log at all.
33000
33001 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33002 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33003 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33004 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33005 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33006 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33007 implying the use of a default path.
33008
33009 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33010 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33011 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33012 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33013 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33014 equivalent to the setting:
33015 .code
33016 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33017 .endd
33018 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33019 logs are written.
33020
33021 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33022 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33023
33024 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33025 .display
33026 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33027 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33028 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33029 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33030 .endd
33031 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33032 error is logged.
33033
33034
33035
33036 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33037 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33038 .cindex "cycling logs"
33039 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33040 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33041 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33042 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33043 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33044 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33045 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33046
33047 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33048 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33049 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33050 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33051 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33052 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33053 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33054 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33055 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33056 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33057 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33058 renamed.
33059
33060
33061
33062 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33063 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33064 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33065 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33066 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33067 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33068 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33069 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33070 .code
33071 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33072 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33073 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33074 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33075 .endd
33076 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33077 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33078 .code
33079 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33080 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33081 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33082 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33083 .endd
33084 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33085 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33086 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33087 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33088
33089 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33090 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33091 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33092 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33093 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33094 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33095 log names:
33096 .code
33097 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33098 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33099 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33100 /var/log/exim/panic
33101 .endd
33102
33103
33104 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33105 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33106 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33107 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33108 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33109 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33110 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33111 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33112 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33113 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33114 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33115 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33116 the time and host name to each line.
33117 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33118
33119 .ilist
33120 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33121 .next
33122 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33123 .next
33124 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33125 .endlist
33126
33127 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33128 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33129 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33130 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33131
33132 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33133 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33134 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33135 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33136 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33137 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33138 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33139 RFC 3164, you should set
33140 .code
33141 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33142 .endd
33143 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33144 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33145
33146 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33147 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33148 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33149 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33150 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33151 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33152 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33153 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33154 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33155 .code
33156 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33157 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33158 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33159 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33160 [5/5] mple>)
33161 .endd
33162 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33163 (LOG_NOTICE):
33164 .code
33165 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33166 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33167 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33168 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33169 [5\18] .example>)
33170 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33171 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33172 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33173 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33174 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33175 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33176 [12\18] F From: <>
33177 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33178 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33179 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33180 [16\18] le>
33181 [17\18] B Bcc:
33182 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33183 .endd
33184 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33185 without modification.
33186
33187 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33188 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33189 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33190 where it is.
33191
33192
33193
33194 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33195 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33196 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33197 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33198 timestamp. The flags are:
33199 .display
33200 &`<=`& message arrival
33201 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33202 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33203 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33204 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33205 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33206 .endd
33207
33208
33209 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33210 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33211 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33212 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33213 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33214 .code
33215 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33216 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33217 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33218 .endd
33219 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33220 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33221 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33222 .code
33223 R=<message id>
33224 .endd
33225 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33226
33227 .cindex "HELO"
33228 .cindex "EHLO"
33229 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33230 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33231 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33232 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33233 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33234 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33235 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33236 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33237 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33238 name in parentheses.
33239
33240 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33241 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33242 the log containing text like these examples:
33243 .code
33244 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33245 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33246 .endd
33247 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33248 on.
33249
33250 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33251 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33252 of Exim.
33253
33254 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33255 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33256 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33257 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33258 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33259 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33260 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33261 suite that was used.
33262
33263 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33264 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33265 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33266 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33267 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33268 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33269 authenticator name.
33270
33271 .cindex "size" "of message"
33272 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33273 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33274 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33275 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33276 other).
33277
33278 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33279 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33280
33281
33282
33283 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33284 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33285 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33286 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33287 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33288 to fit it on the page:
33289 .code
33290 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33291 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33292 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33293 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33294 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33295 .endd
33296 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33297 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33298 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33299 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33300 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33301
33302 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33303 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33304 .display
33305 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33306 .endd
33307 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33308 parentheses afterwards.
33309
33310 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33311 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33312 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33313 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33314 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33315 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33316
33317 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33318 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33319
33320 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33321 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33322
33323
33324 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33325 .cindex "discarded messages"
33326 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33327 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33328 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33329 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33330 .code
33331 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33332 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33333 .endd
33334 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33335 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33336 .code
33337 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33338 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33339 .endd
33340
33341
33342 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33343 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33344 .code
33345 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33346 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33347 .endd
33348 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33349 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33350 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33351 .code
33352 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33353 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33354 .endd
33355 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33356 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33357 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33358
33359
33360
33361 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33362 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33363 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33364 following form is logged:
33365 .code
33366 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33367 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33368 .endd
33369 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33370 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33371 .code
33372 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33373 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33374 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33375 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33376 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33377 .endd
33378 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33379 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33380 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33381 flagged with &`**`&.
33382
33383
33384
33385 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33386 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33387 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33388 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33389 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33390
33391
33392
33393 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33394 A line of the form
33395 .code
33396 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33397 .endd
33398 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33399 at the end of its processing.
33400
33401
33402
33403
33404 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33405 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33406 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33407 the following table:
33408 .display
33409 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
33410 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33411 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33412 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33413 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33414 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33415 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33416 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33417 &`H `& host name and IP address
33418 &`I `& local interface used
33419 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33420 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33421 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33422 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33423 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33424 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33425 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33426 &`S `& size of message
33427 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33428 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33429 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33430 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33431 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33432 .endd
33433
33434
33435 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33436 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33437 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33438
33439 .ilist
33440 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33441 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33442 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33443 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33444 during the first delivery attempt.
33445 .next
33446 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33447 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33448 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33449 .next
33450 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33451 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33452 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33453 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33454 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33455 doing.
33456 .next
33457 .cindex "error" "ignored"
33458 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33459 message:
33460 .olist
33461 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33462 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33463 .next
33464 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33465 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33466 .next
33467 A delivery set up by a router configured with
33468 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33469 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33470 .code
33471 errors_to = <>
33472 .endd
33473 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33474 .endlist olist
33475 .endlist ilist
33476
33477
33478
33479
33480
33481 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33482 .cindex "log" "selectors"
33483 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33484 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33485 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33486 example:
33487 .code
33488 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33489 .endd
33490 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33491 selection marked by asterisks:
33492 .display
33493 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33494 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33495 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33496 &` arguments `& command line arguments
33497 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33498 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33499 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33500 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33501 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33502 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33503 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33504 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33505 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33506 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33507 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33508 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33509 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33510 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33511 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33512 &` pid `& Exim process id
33513 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33514 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33515 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33516 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33517 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33518 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33519 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33520 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33521 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33522 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33523 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33524 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33525 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33526 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33527 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33528 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33529 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33530 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33531 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33532 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
33533 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33534
33535 &` all `& all of the above
33536 .endd
33537 More details on each of these items follows:
33538
33539 .ilist
33540 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33541 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33542 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33543 this log selector is set.
33544 .next
33545 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
33546 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33547 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33548 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33549 such users cannot access the log).
33550 .next
33551 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
33552 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33553 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33554 parentheses between them.
33555 .next
33556 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33557 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33558 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33559 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33560 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33561 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33562 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33563 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33564 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33565 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33566 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33567 between the caller and Exim.
33568 .next
33569 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33570 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33571 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33572 .next
33573 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33574 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33575 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33576 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33577 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33578 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33579 .next
33580 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33581 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33582 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33583 .next
33584 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33585 .cindex "size" "of message"
33586 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33587 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33588 .next
33589 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33590 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33591 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33592 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33593 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33594 .next
33595 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33596 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33597 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33598 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33599 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33600 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33601 .next
33602 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33603 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33604 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33605 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33606 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33607 .next
33608 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33609 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33610 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33611 client's ident port times out.
33612 .next
33613 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33614 .cindex "interface" "logging"
33615 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33616 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33617 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33618 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33619 rejection lines.
33620 .next
33621 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
33622 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
33623 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
33624 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
33625 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
33626 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
33627 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
33628 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
33629 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
33630 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
33631 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
33632 .next
33633 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
33634 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
33635 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
33636 .next
33637 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
33638 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
33639 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
33640 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
33641 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
33642 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
33643 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
33644 .next
33645 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33646 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33647 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
33648 immediately after the time and date.
33649 .next
33650 .cindex "log" "queue run"
33651 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
33652 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
33653 .next
33654 .cindex "log" "queue time"
33655 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
33656 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
33657 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
33658 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
33659 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
33660 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
33661 message has been successfully received.
33662 .next
33663 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
33664 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
33665 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
33666 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
33667 .next
33668 .cindex "log" "recipients"
33669 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
33670 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
33671 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
33672 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
33673 has taken place.
33674 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
33675 in the list.
33676 .next
33677 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
33678 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
33679 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
33680 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
33681 .next
33682 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
33683 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
33684 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
33685 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
33686 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
33687 .next
33688 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
33689 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
33690 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
33691 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
33692 attempt.
33693 .next
33694 .cindex "log" "return path"
33695 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
33696 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
33697 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
33698 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
33699 .next
33700 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
33701 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
33702 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
33703 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
33704 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
33705 .next
33706 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
33707 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
33708 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
33709 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
33710 detail is lost.
33711 .next
33712 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
33713 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
33714 it is too big.
33715 .next
33716 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
33717 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
33718 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
33719 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
33720 it.
33721 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
33722 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
33723 .next
33724 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
33725 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
33726 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
33727 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
33728 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
33729 response.
33730 .next
33731 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
33732 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
33733 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
33734 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
33735 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
33736 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
33737 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
33738 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
33739 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
33740 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
33741
33742 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
33743 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
33744 reset if the daemon is restarted.
33745 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
33746 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
33747 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
33748 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
33749 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
33750 .next
33751 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
33752 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
33753 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
33754 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
33755 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
33756 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
33757 .next
33758 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
33759 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
33760 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
33761 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
33762 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
33763 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
33764 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
33765 already have their own log lines.
33766
33767 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
33768 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
33769 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
33770 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
33771 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
33772 the same logging options.
33773
33774 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
33775 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
33776 .code
33777 C=EHLO,QUIT
33778 .endd
33779 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
33780 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
33781 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
33782 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
33783 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
33784 .next
33785 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
33786 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
33787 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
33788 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
33789 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
33790 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
33791 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
33792 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
33793 .next
33794 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
33795 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
33796 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
33797 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
33798 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
33799 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
33800 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
33801 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
33802 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
33803 .next
33804 .cindex "log" "subject"
33805 .cindex "subject, logging"
33806 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
33807 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
33808 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
33809 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
33810 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
33811 .next
33812 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
33813 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
33814 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
33815 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
33816 .next
33817 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
33818 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
33819 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33820 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
33821 .next
33822 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
33823 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
33824 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33825 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
33826 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
33827 .next
33828 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
33829 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
33830 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
33831 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
33832 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
33833 .next
33834 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
33835 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
33836 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
33837 .endlist
33838
33839
33840 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
33841 .cindex "message" "log file for"
33842 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
33843 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
33844 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
33845 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
33846 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
33847 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
33848 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
33849 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
33850 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
33851 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
33852 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
33853
33854 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
33855 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
33856 &%message_logs%& option false.
33857 .ecindex IIDloggen
33858
33859
33860
33861
33862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33864
33865 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
33866 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
33867 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
33868 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
33869 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
33870
33871 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
33872 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
33873 "list what Exim processes are doing"
33874 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
33875 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
33876 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
33877 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
33878 various criteria"
33879 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
33880 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
33881 "extract statistics from the log"
33882 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
33883 "check address acceptance from given IP"
33884 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
33885 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
33886 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
33887 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
33888 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
33889 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
33890 .endtable
33891
33892 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
33893 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
33894 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
33895
33896
33897
33898
33899 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
33900 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
33901 .cindex "process, querying"
33902 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
33903 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
33904 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
33905 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
33906 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
33907 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
33908 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
33909 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
33910 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
33911
33912 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
33913 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
33914 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
33915
33916
33917 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
33918 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
33919 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
33920 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
33921 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
33922 options:
33923 .display
33924 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
33925 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
33926 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
33927 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
33928 .endd
33929 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
33930 .code
33931 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
33932 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
33933 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
33934 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
33935 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
33936 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
33937 .endd
33938 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
33939 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
33940
33941
33942
33943 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
33944 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
33945 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
33946 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
33947 .code
33948 exim -bpu
33949 .endd
33950 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
33951 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
33952 options are available:
33953
33954 .vlist
33955 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
33956 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
33957 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
33958 .code
33959 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
33960 .endd
33961 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
33962 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
33963 brackets.
33964
33965 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
33966 Match against the size field.
33967
33968 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33969 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
33970
33971 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33972 Match messages that are older than the given time.
33973
33974 .vitem &*-z*&
33975 Match only frozen messages.
33976
33977 .vitem &*-x*&
33978 Match only non-frozen messages.
33979 .endlist
33980
33981 The following options control the format of the output:
33982
33983 .vlist
33984 .vitem &*-c*&
33985 Display only the count of matching messages.
33986
33987 .vitem &*-l*&
33988 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
33989 the default.
33990
33991 .vitem &*-i*&
33992 Display message ids only.
33993
33994 .vitem &*-b*&
33995 Brief format &-- one line per message.
33996
33997 .vitem &*-R*&
33998 Display messages in reverse order.
33999 .endlist
34000
34001 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34002
34003
34004
34005 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34006 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34007 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34008 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34009 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34010 running a command such as
34011 .code
34012 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34013 .endd
34014 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34015 it, as in the following example:
34016 .code
34017 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34018 .endd
34019 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34020 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34021 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34022 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34023
34024 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34025 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34026 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34027 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34028 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34029 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34030 sender.
34031
34032 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34033 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34034 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34035 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34036 level"& addresses).
34037
34038
34039
34040
34041 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34042 "SECTextspeinf"
34043 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34044 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34045 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34046 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34047 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34048 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34049 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34050 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34051 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34052 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34053 .display
34054 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34055 .endd
34056 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34057
34058 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34059 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34060 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34061
34062 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34063 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34064 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34065 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34066 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34067
34068 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34069 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34070 regular expression.
34071
34072 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34073 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34074
34075 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34076 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34077 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34078
34079
34080 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34081 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34082 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34083 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34084 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34085 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34086 the &%--help%& option.
34087
34088
34089 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34090 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34091 .cindex "cycling logs"
34092 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34093 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34094 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34095 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34096 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34097 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34098 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34099 .ilist
34100 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34101 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34102 .next
34103 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34104 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34105 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34106 configuration.
34107 .endlist
34108
34109 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34110 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34111 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34112 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34113 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34114 logs are handled similarly.
34115
34116 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34117 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34118 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34119 any existing log files.
34120
34121 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34122 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34123 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34124 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34125 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34126 .code
34127 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34128 .endd
34129 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34130 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34131
34132
34133
34134 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34135 .cindex "statistics"
34136 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34137 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34138 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34139 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34140 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34141
34142 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34143 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34144 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34145 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34146 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34147 .code
34148 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34149 .endd
34150 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34151 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34152 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34153 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34154 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34155 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34156 also produced per user.
34157
34158 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34159 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34160 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34161 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34162 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34163
34164 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34165 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34166 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34167 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34168 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34169 an entirely separate message.
34170
34171 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34172 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34173 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34174 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34175 least one address that failed.
34176
34177 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34178 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34179 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34180 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34181 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34182 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34183 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34184
34185 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34186 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34187 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34188
34189 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34190 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34191 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34192 .code
34193 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34194 .endd
34195
34196 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34197 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34198 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34199 .cindex "checking access"
34200 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34201 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34202 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34203 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34204 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34205 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34206
34207 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34208 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34209 .code
34210 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34211 .endd
34212 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34213 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34214 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34215 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34216 .code
34217 Rejected:
34218 550 Relay not permitted
34219 .endd
34220 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34221 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34222 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34223 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34224 you can use:
34225 .code
34226 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34227 -f himself@there.example
34228 .endd
34229 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34230 mandatory arguments.
34231
34232 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34233 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34234 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34235
34236
34237
34238 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34239 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34240 .cindex "building DBM files"
34241 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34242 .cindex "lower casing"
34243 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34244 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34245 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34246 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34247 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34248 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34249
34250 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34251 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34252 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34253 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34254 files.
34255
34256 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34257 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34258 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34259 well.
34260
34261 .cindex "USE_DB"
34262 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34263 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34264 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34265 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34266 .code
34267 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34268 .endd
34269 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34270 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34271
34272 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34273 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34274 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34275 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34276 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34277 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34278
34279 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34280 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34281 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34282 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34283 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34284 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34285 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34286 return code is 2.
34287
34288
34289
34290
34291 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34292 .cindex "retry" "times"
34293 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34294 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34295 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34296 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34297 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34298 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34299 output. For example:
34300 .code
34301 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34302 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34303 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34304 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34305 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34306 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34307 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34308 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34309 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34310 past final cutoff time
34311 .endd
34312 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34313 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34314 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34315 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34316 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34317 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34318 run very often.
34319
34320 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34321 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34322 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34323 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34324 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34325 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34326
34327
34328
34329 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34330 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34331 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34332 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34333 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34334 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34335 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34336
34337 .ilist
34338 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34339 .next
34340 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34341 for remote hosts
34342 .next
34343 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34344 .next
34345 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34346 .next
34347 &'misc'&: other hints data
34348 .endlist
34349
34350 The &'misc'& database is used for
34351
34352 .ilist
34353 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34354 .next
34355 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34356 &(smtp)& transport)
34357 .endlist
34358
34359
34360
34361 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34362 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34363 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34364 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34365 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34366 .code
34367 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34368 .endd
34369 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34370 .code
34371 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34372 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34373 .endd
34374 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34375 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34376 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34377 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34378 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34379 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34380 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34381 and a textual description of the error.
34382
34383 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34384 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34385 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34386 exceeded.
34387
34388 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34389 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34390 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34391 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34392 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34393 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34394 cross-references.
34395
34396
34397
34398 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34399 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34400 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34401 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34402 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34403 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34404 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34405 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34406 updated sufficiently often.
34407
34408 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34409 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34410 the retry database:
34411 .code
34412 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34413 .endd
34414 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34415 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34416 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34417 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34418 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34419 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34420 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34421 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34422 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34423 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34424 whenever it removes information from the database.
34425
34426 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34427 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34428 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34429 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34430 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34431
34432 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34433 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34434 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34435 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34436 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34437 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34438 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34439 tidied.
34440
34441 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34442 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34443
34444
34445
34446
34447 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34448 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34449 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
34450 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
34451 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
34452 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
34453 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
34454 displayed.
34455
34456 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
34457 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
34458 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
34459 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
34460 by new data, for example:
34461 .code
34462 > 4 951102:1000
34463 .endd
34464 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
34465 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
34466 used as optional separators.
34467
34468
34469
34470
34471 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34472 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34473 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34474 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
34475 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34476 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34477 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34478 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34479 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34480 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34481 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34482 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34483 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34484
34485 .vlist
34486 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
34487 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34488
34489 .vitem &%-flock%&
34490 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34491 supports it.
34492
34493 .vitem &%-interval%&
34494 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34495 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34496
34497 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
34498 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34499
34500 .vitem &%-mbx%&
34501 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34502
34503 .vitem &%-q%&
34504 Suppress verification output.
34505
34506 .vitem &%-retries%&
34507 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34508 the lock (default 10).
34509
34510 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
34511 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34512 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34513 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34514 subsequently sees.
34515
34516 .vitem &%-timeout%&
34517 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34518 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34519 default), a non-blocking call is used.
34520
34521 .vitem &%-v%&
34522 Generate verbose output.
34523 .endlist
34524
34525 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34526 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34527 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34528 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34529 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34530 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34531 more than 30 minutes old.
34532
34533 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34534 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34535 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34536 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34537 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34538 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34539
34540 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34541 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34542 suppresses all output except error messages.
34543
34544 A command such as
34545 .code
34546 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34547 .endd
34548 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34549 .display
34550 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34551 <&'some commands'&>
34552 &`End`&
34553 .endd
34554 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34555 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34556 such as
34557 .code
34558 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34559 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34560 .endd
34561 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34562 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34563 .ecindex IIDutils
34564
34565
34566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34568
34569 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34570 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34571 .cindex "X-windows"
34572 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
34573 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34574 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34575 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34576 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34577 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34578 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34579 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34580
34581
34582
34583 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34584 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34585 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34586 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34587 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34588 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34589 parameters are for.
34590
34591 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34592 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34593 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34594 .code
34595 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34596 .endd
34597 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34598 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34599 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34600 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34601 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34602
34603 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34604 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34605 .code
34606 Eximon*background: gray94
34607 .endd
34608 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34609 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34610 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34611 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34612 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34613 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34614 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34615 .code
34616 xrdb -merge <<End
34617 Eximon*highlight: gray
34618 End
34619 .endd
34620 .cindex "admin user"
34621 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
34622 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
34623
34624 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
34625 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
34626 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
34627 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
34628 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
34629
34630 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
34631 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
34632 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
34633 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
34634 different parts of the display.
34635
34636
34637
34638
34639 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
34640 .cindex "stripchart"
34641 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
34642 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34643 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
34644 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
34645 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
34646 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
34647 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
34648 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
34649 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34650
34651 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
34652 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
34653 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
34654 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
34655
34656 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
34657 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
34658 to a single partition.
34659
34660 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
34661 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
34662 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
34663 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
34664 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
34665 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34666 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34667
34668
34669
34670
34671 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
34672 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
34673 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
34674 .cindex "window size"
34675 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
34676 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
34677 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
34678 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
34679 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
34680 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
34681
34682 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
34683 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
34684 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
34685 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
34686
34687 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
34688 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
34689 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
34690 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
34691 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
34692 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34693
34694 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
34695 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
34696 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34697
34698
34699
34700 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
34701 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
34702 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
34703 the main log is maintained.
34704 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
34705 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
34706 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
34707 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
34708 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
34709
34710 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
34711 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
34712 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
34713 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
34714 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
34715 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
34716 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
34717 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
34718 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
34719 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
34720 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34721
34722 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
34723 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
34724 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
34725 It cannot go further back up the log.
34726
34727 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
34728 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
34729 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
34730 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
34731 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
34732 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
34733
34734 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
34735 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
34736 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
34737 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
34738 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
34739 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
34740
34741 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
34742 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
34743 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
34744 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
34745 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
34746 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
34747 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
34748 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
34749 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
34750 window.
34751
34752
34753
34754 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
34755 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
34756 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
34757 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
34758 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
34759 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
34760 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
34761 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
34762 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
34763 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
34764
34765 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
34766 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
34767 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
34768 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
34769 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
34770 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
34771 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
34772
34773 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
34774 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
34775 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
34776 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
34777 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
34778 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
34779 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
34780
34781 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
34782 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
34783 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
34784 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
34785
34786 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
34787 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
34788 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
34789 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
34790 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
34791 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
34792 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
34793 not shown.
34794
34795 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
34796 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
34797
34798 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
34799 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
34800 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
34801 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
34802 display is updated.
34803
34804
34805
34806 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
34807 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
34808 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
34809 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
34810 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
34811 any selected text.
34812
34813 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
34814 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
34815 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
34816 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
34817 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
34818 .code
34819 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
34820 .endd
34821 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
34822 follows:
34823
34824 .ilist
34825 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
34826 in a new text window.
34827 .next
34828 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
34829 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
34830 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
34831 .next
34832 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
34833 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
34834 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
34835 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
34836 .next
34837 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
34838 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
34839 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
34840 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
34841 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
34842 .next
34843 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
34844 that the message be frozen.
34845 .next
34846 .cindex "thawing messages"
34847 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
34848 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
34849 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
34850 that the message be thawed.
34851 .next
34852 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
34853 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
34854 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
34855 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
34856 .next
34857 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
34858 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
34859 message.
34860 .next
34861 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
34862 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34863 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34864 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34865 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
34866 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
34867 which case no action is taken.
34868 .next
34869 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
34870 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34871 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34872 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34873 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
34874 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
34875 case no action is taken.
34876 .next
34877 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
34878 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
34879 .next
34880 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
34881 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
34882 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
34883 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
34884 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
34885 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
34886 the address is qualified with that domain.
34887 .endlist
34888
34889 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
34890 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
34891 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
34892 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
34893 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
34894 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
34895 if no output is generated.
34896
34897 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
34898 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
34899 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
34900 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
34901
34902 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
34903 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
34904 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
34905 .ecindex IIDeximon
34906
34907
34908
34909
34910
34911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34913
34914 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
34915 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
34916 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
34917 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
34918
34919 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
34920 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
34921 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
34922 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
34923 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
34924 its security as compared with other MTAs.
34925
34926 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
34927 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
34928 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
34929 as soon as possible.
34930
34931
34932 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
34933 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
34934 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
34935 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
34936 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
34937 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
34938
34939 .ilist
34940 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
34941 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
34942 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
34943 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
34944 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
34945 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
34946
34947 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
34948 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
34949 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
34950 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
34951 .next
34952
34953 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
34954 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
34955 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
34956 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
34957 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
34958 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
34959 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
34960 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
34961 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
34962 separate commands.
34963
34964 .next
34965 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
34966 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
34967 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
34968 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
34969 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
34970 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
34971 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
34972 .next
34973 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
34974 is disabled.
34975 .next
34976 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
34977 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
34978 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
34979 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
34980 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
34981 .endlist
34982
34983
34984
34985 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
34986 .cindex "setuid"
34987 .cindex "root privilege"
34988 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
34989 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
34990 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
34991 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
34992 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
34993 is required for two things:
34994
34995 .ilist
34996 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
34997 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
34998 not required.
34999 .next
35000 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35001 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35002 configuration.
35003 .endlist
35004
35005 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35006 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35007 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35008 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35009 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35010 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35011 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35012 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35013
35014 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35015 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35016 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35017
35018 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35019 uid and gid in the following cases:
35020
35021 .ilist
35022 .oindex "&%-C%&"
35023 .oindex "&%-D%&"
35024 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35025 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35026 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35027 the calling process.
35028 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35029 option may not be used at all.
35030 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35031 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35032 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35033 .next
35034 .oindex "&%-be%&"
35035 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
35036 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
35037 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35038 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35039 calling process.
35040 .next
35041 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35042 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35043 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35044 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35045 testing address verification
35046 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
35047 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
35048 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35049 option).
35050 .next
35051 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35052 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35053 .endlist
35054
35055 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35056
35057 .ilist
35058 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35059 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35060 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35061 will be used during message reception.
35062 .next
35063 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35064 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35065 .next
35066 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35067 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35068 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35069 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35070 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35071 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35072 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35073 generating bounce and warning messages.
35074
35075 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35076 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35077 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35078 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35079 .next
35080 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35081 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35082 .endlist
35083
35084
35085
35086
35087 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35088 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35089 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35090 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35091 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35092 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35093 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35094 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35095 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35096 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35097 to any other uid.
35098
35099 .cindex SIGHUP
35100 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35101 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35102 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35103 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35104
35105 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35106 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35107 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35108 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35109 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35110
35111 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35112 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35113 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35114 effect.
35115
35116 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35117 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35118 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35119
35120 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35121 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35122 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35123 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35124 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35125 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35126 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35127 address this problem at this time.
35128
35129 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35130 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35131 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35132 be used in the most straightforward way.
35133
35134 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35135 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35136
35137 .ilist
35138 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35139 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35140 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35141 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35142 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35143 .next
35144 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35145 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35146 .next
35147 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35148 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35149 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35150 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35151 .next
35152 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35153 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35154
35155 .olist
35156 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35157 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35158 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35159 .next
35160 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35161 owned by the Exim user.
35162 .next
35163 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35164 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35165 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35166 .endlist olist
35167 .endlist ilist
35168
35169
35170 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35171 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35172 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35173 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35174
35175 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35176 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35177
35178
35179
35180
35181 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35182 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35183 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35184
35185
35186
35187 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35188 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35189 .cindex "IP source routing"
35190 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35191 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35192 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35193 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35194
35195
35196
35197 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35198 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35199 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35200
35201
35202
35203
35204 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35205 .cindex "trusted users"
35206 .cindex "admin user"
35207 .cindex "privileged user"
35208 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35209 .cindex "user" "admin"
35210 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35211 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35212 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35213 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35214 permit a remote host to be specified.
35215
35216 .oindex "&%-f%&"
35217 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35218 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35219 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35220 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35221 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35222 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35223
35224 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35225 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35226 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35227 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35228 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35229
35230 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35231 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35232 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35233 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35234 includes the contents of files on the spool.
35235
35236 .oindex "&%-M%&"
35237 .oindex "&%-q%&"
35238 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35239 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35240 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35241 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35242 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35243 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35244
35245 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35246 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35247 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35248 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35249 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35250 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35251 files.
35252
35253
35254
35255 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35256 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
35257 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35258 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35259 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35260 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35261
35262
35263
35264 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35265 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35266 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35267 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35268 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35269 this.
35270
35271
35272
35273 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35274 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35275 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35276 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35277 converted output.
35278
35279
35280
35281 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35282 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35283 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35284 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35285 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35286
35287
35288
35289 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35290 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35291 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35292 loading it.
35293
35294
35295 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35296 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35297 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35298 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35299 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35300 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35301 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35302
35303 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35304 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35305 string.
35306
35307
35308
35309 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35310 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35311 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35312 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35313
35314
35315
35316 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35317 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35318 enough to hold the result.
35319 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35320
35321
35322
35323
35324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35326
35327 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35328 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35329 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35330 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35331 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35332 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35333 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35334 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35335 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35336 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35337 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35338 themselves are recoverable.
35339
35340 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35341 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35342 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35343
35344 .ilist
35345 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35346 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35347 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35348 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35349 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35350 .next
35351 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35352 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35353 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35354 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35355 will always be the case.
35356 .next
35357 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35358 .next
35359 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35360 signature.
35361 .endlist
35362 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35363
35364 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35365 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35366 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35367 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35368 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35369 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35370 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35371 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35372 attempt.
35373
35374 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35375 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35376 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35377 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35378 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35379 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35380 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35381 normally the Exim user.
35382
35383 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35384 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35385 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35386 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35387 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35388 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35389 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
35390 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
35391
35392 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
35393 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
35394 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
35395 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
35396
35397 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
35398 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
35399
35400 .vlist
35401 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35402 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
35403 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
35404 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
35405 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
35406 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
35407 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
35408 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
35409 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
35410 newlines.
35411
35412 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35413 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
35414 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
35415 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35416 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35417 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35418
35419 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35420 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
35421 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
35422 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35423 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35424 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35425
35426 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
35427 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
35428 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
35429
35430 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
35431 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
35432 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
35433 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
35434 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35435
35436 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
35437 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
35438 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
35439 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
35440 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35441
35442 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
35443 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
35444 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
35445
35446 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
35447 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
35448 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
35449
35450 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35451 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
35452 present.
35453
35454 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35455 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
35456 present if the number is greater than zero.
35457
35458 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
35459 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
35460 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
35461
35462 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
35463 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
35464 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
35465
35466 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35467 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
35468 command.
35469
35470 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35471 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
35472 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35473 messages.
35474
35475 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35476 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35477 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35478 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35479
35480 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35481 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35482 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35483
35484 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35485 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35486 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35487 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35488 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35489 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35490
35491 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35492 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35493 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35494 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35495 supplied by the remote host, if any.
35496
35497 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35498 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35499 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35500 generated messages.
35501
35502 .vitem &%-local%&
35503 The message is from a local sender.
35504
35505 .vitem &%-localerror%&
35506 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35507
35508 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35509 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35510 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35511 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35512
35513 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35514 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35515 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35516
35517 .vitem &%-N%&
35518 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35519 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35520 &%-N%& is assumed.
35521
35522 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35523 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35524 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35525
35526 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35527 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35528 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35529
35530 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35531 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35532 of &$spam_score_int$&.
35533
35534 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35535 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35536 certificate was verified by the server.
35537
35538 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35539 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35540 name of the cipher suite that was used.
35541
35542 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35543 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35544 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35545 certificate.
35546 .endlist
35547
35548 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35549 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35550 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35551 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35552 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35553 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35554 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35555 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35556 addresses are complete.
35557
35558 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35559 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35560 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35561 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35562 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35563 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35564 .code
35565 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35566 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35567 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35568 .endd
35569 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35570 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35571 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35572 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35573 example:
35574 .code
35575 4
35576 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35577 darcy@austen.fict.example
35578 rdo@foundation
35579 alice@wonderland.fict.example
35580 .endd
35581 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35582 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35583 line is of the following form:
35584 .display
35585 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35586 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35587 .endd
35588 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35589 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35590 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35591 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35592 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35593 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35594 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35595 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35596
35597
35598 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35599 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35600 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35601 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35602 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35603 following:
35604
35605 .table2 50pt
35606 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35607 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35608 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35609 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35610 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35611 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35612 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35613 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35614 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35615 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35616 .endtable
35617
35618 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
35619 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
35620 typical set of headers:
35621 .code
35622 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
35623 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35624 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
35625 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
35626 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
35627 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
35628 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
35629 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35630 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
35631 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35632 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35633 .endd
35634 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
35635 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
35636 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
35637 .ecindex IIDforspo1
35638 .ecindex IIDforspo2
35639 .ecindex IIDforspo3
35640
35641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35642 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35643
35644 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHID12" &&&
35645 "DKIM Support"
35646 .cindex "DKIM"
35647
35648 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
35649 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
35650 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
35651 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
35652
35653 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
35654 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
35655
35656 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
35657 .olist
35658 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
35659 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
35660 .next
35661 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
35662 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
35663 different signature contexts.
35664 .endlist
35665
35666 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
35667 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
35668 Exim's standard controls.
35669
35670 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
35671 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
35672 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
35673 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
35674 .code
35675 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
35676 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
35677 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
35678 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
35679 .endd
35680 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
35681 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
35682 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
35683 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
35684 senders).
35685
35686
35687 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
35688 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
35689
35690 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
35691 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
35692
35693 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
35694 MANDATORY:
35695 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
35696 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
35697
35698 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
35699 MANDATORY:
35700 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
35701 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
35702 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
35703 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
35704
35705 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
35706 MANDATORY:
35707 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
35708 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
35709 The result can either
35710 .ilist
35711 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
35712 .next
35713 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
35714 the private key.
35715 .next
35716 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
35717 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
35718 is set.
35719 .endlist
35720
35721 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
35722 OPTIONAL:
35723 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
35724 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
35725 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
35726 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
35727
35728 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
35729 OPTIONAL:
35730 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
35731 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
35732 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
35733 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
35734 variables here.
35735
35736 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
35737 OPTIONAL:
35738 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
35739 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
35740 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
35741 used.
35742
35743
35744 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
35745 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
35746
35747 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
35748 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
35749 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
35750
35751 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
35752 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
35753 runtime of the ACL.
35754
35755 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
35756 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
35757 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
35758 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
35759
35760 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
35761 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
35762 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
35763 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
35764 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
35765 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
35766 it defaults as:
35767 .code
35768 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
35769 .endd
35770 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
35771 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
35772 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
35773 .code
35774 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
35775 .endd
35776 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
35777 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
35778 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
35779 .code
35780 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
35781 .endd
35782
35783 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
35784 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
35785
35786
35787 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
35788 available (from most to least important):
35789
35790
35791 .vlist
35792 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
35793 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
35794 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
35795 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
35796 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
35797 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
35798 .ilist
35799 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
35800 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35801 .next
35802 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
35803 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35804 .next
35805 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
35806 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35807 .next
35808 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
35809 .endlist
35810 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
35811 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
35812 "fail" or "invalid". One of
35813 .ilist
35814 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
35815 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
35816 .next
35817 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
35818 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
35819 .next
35820 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
35821 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
35822 means that the message body was modified in transit.
35823 .next
35824 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
35825 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
35826 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
35827 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
35828 .endlist
35829 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
35830 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
35831 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
35832 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35833 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
35834 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
35835 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
35836 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35837 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
35838 The key record selector string.
35839 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
35840 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
35841 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
35842 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35843 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
35844 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35845 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
35846 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
35847 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
35848 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
35849 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
35850 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
35851 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
35852 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
35853 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
35854 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
35855 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
35856 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
35857 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
35858 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
35859 integer size comparisons against this value.
35860 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
35861 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
35862 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
35863 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
35864 .vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
35865 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
35866 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
35867 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35868 in the key record.
35869 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
35870 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35871 in the key record.
35872 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
35873 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
35874 .endlist
35875
35876 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
35877
35878 .vlist
35879 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
35880 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
35881 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
35882 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
35883 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
35884
35885 .code
35886 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
35887 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
35888 sender_domains = gmail.com
35889 dkim_signers = gmail.com
35890 dkim_status = none
35891 .endd
35892
35893 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
35894 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
35895 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
35896 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
35897
35898 .code
35899 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
35900 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
35901 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
35902 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
35903 .endd
35904
35905 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
35906 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
35907 for more information of what they mean.
35908 .endlist
35909
35910 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35912
35913 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
35914 "Adding drivers or lookups"
35915 .cindex "adding drivers"
35916 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
35917 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
35918 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
35919 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
35920
35921 .olist
35922 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
35923 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
35924 .next
35925 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
35926 .display
35927 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
35928 .endd
35929 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
35930 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
35931 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
35932 .next
35933 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
35934 .code
35935 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
35936 .endd
35937 .next
35938 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
35939 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
35940 .next
35941 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
35942 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
35943 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
35944 .next
35945 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
35946 &_src_&.
35947 .next
35948 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
35949 as for other drivers and lookups.
35950 .endlist
35951
35952 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
35953 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
35954 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
35955 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
35956 searched using a binary chop procedure.
35957
35958 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
35959 the interface that is expected.
35960
35961
35962
35963
35964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35966
35967 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35968 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
35969 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
35970 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
35971 . processors.
35972 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35973
35974 .literal xml
35975 <?sdop
35976 format="newpage"
35977 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
35978 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
35979 ?>
35980 .literal off
35981
35982 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
35983 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
35984 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
35985
35986
35987 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35988 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////